PIC16C923-04/CL [MICROCHIP]
8-Bit CMOS Microcontroller with LCD Driver; 8位CMOS微控制器与LCD驱动器型号: | PIC16C923-04/CL |
厂家: | MICROCHIP |
描述: | 8-Bit CMOS Microcontroller with LCD Driver |
文件: | 总189页 (文件大小:1493K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
PIC16C9XX
8-Bit CMOS Microcontroller with LCD Driver
Devices included in this data sheet:
Available in Die Form
• PIC16C923
• PIC16C924
Microcontroller Core Features:
• High performance RISC CPU
• Only 35 single word instructions to learn
• 4K x 14 on-chip EPROM program memory
• 176 x 8 general purpose registers (SRAM)
• All single cycle instructions (500 ns) except for
program branches which are two-cycle
• Operating speed: DC - 8 MHz clock input
DC - 500 ns instruction cycle
• Interrupt capability
• Eight level deep hardware stack
• Direct, indirect and relative addressing modes
Peripheral Features:
• 25 I/O pins with individual direction control
• 25-27 input only pins
• Synchronous Serial Port (SSP) with SPI
and I C
• Timer0: 8-bit timer/counter with 8-bit prescaler
2
• Timer1: 16-bit timer/counter, can be incremented
during sleep via external crystal/clock
• 8-bit multi-channel Analog to Digital converter
(PIC16C924 only)
• Timer2: 8-bit timer/counter with 8-bit period regis-
ter, prescaler and postscaler
Special Microcontroller Features:
• One pin that can be configured a capture input,
PWM output, or compare output
• Power-on Reset (POR)
• Power-up Timer (PWRT) and Oscillator Start-up
Timer (OST)
- Capture is 16-bit, max. resolution 31.25 ns
- Compare is 16-bit, max. resolution 500 ns
• Watchdog Timer (WDT) with its own on-chip RC
oscillator for reliable operation
- PWM max resolution is 10-bits.
Maximum PWM frequency @ 8-bit resolution
= 32 kHz, @ 10-bit resolution = 8 kHz
• Programmable code-protection
• Power saving SLEEP mode
• Programmable LCD timing module
- Multiple LCD timing sources available
- Can drive LCD panel while in Sleep mode
- Static, 1/2, 1/3, 1/4 multiplex
• Selectable oscillator options
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (via two pins)
CMOS Technology
- Static drive and 1/3 bias capability
- 16 bytes of dedicated LCD RAM
• Low-power, high-speed CMOS EPROM
technology
- Up to 32 segments, up to 4 commons
• Fully static design
Common
Segment
Pixels
• Wide operating voltage range: 2.5V to 6.0V
• Commercial and Industrial temperature ranges
• Low-power consumption:
1
2
3
4
32
31
30
29
32
62
90
- < 2 mA @ 5.5V, 4 MHz
116
- 22.5 µA typical @ 4V, 32 kHz
- < 1 µA typical standby current @ 3.0V
2
ICSP is a trademark of Microchip Technology Inc. I C is a trademark of Philips Corporation. SPI is a trademark of Motorola Corporation.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 1
PIC16C9XX
Pin Diagrams
PLCC
RD5/SEG29/COM3
RG6/SEG26
RG5/SEG25
RG4/SEG24
RG3/SEG23
RG2/SEG22
RG1/SEG21
RG0/SEG20
RG7/SEG28
RF7/SEG19
RF6/SEG18
RF5/SEG17
RF4/SEG16
RF3/SEG15
RF2/SEG14
RF1/SEG13
RF0/SEG12
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
RA4/T0CKI
RA5/SS
RB1
RB0/INT
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
C1
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
PIC16C923
C2
VLCD2
VLCD3
VDD
VDD
VSS
OSC1/CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
Shrink PDIP (750 mil)
MCLR/VPP
RB3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
RB4
RB5
RB2
RA0
RB7
RB6
VDD
COM0
RA1
VSS
RA2
RD7/SEG31/COM1
RD6/SEG30/COM2
RD5/SEG29/COM3
RG6/SEG26
RG5/SEG25
RG4/SEG24
RG3/SEG23
RG2/SEG22
RA3
RA4/T0CKI
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
RA5/SS
RB1
RB0/INT
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
C1
RG1/SEG21
RG0/SEG20
RF7/SEG19
C2
VLCD2
VLCD3
RF6/SEG18
RF5/SEG17
RF4/SEG16
VDD
VSS
OSC1/CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
RC1/T1OSI
RF3/SEG15
RF2/SEG14
RF1/SEG13
RF0/SEG12
RE6/SEG11
RE5/SEG10
RE4/SEG09
RC2/CCP1
VLCD1
VLCDADJ
RD0/SEG00
TQFP
RE3/SEG08
RE2/SEG07
RD1/SEG01
RD2/SEG02
RD3/SEG03
RE1/SEG06
RE0/SEG05
RD4/SEG04
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
RD5/SEG29/COM3
RG6/SEG26
RG5/SEG25
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
RA4/T0CKI
RA5/SS
RB1
RB0/INT
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
C1
RG4/SEG24
RG3/SEG23
RG2/SEG22
RG1/SEG21
RG0/SEG20
RF7/SEG19
RF6/SEG18
RF5/SEG17
RF4/SEG16
RF3/SEG15
RF2/SEG14
RF1/SEG13
RF0/SEG12
PIC16C923
9
C2
VLCD2
VLCD3
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
VDD
VSS
OSC1/CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
LEGEND:
Input Pin
Output Pin
Input/Output Pin
Digital Input/LCD Output Pin
LCD Output Pin
DS30444E - page 2
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
Pin Diagrams (Cont.’d)
PLCC
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
RA4/T0CKI
RA5/AN4/SS
RB1
RB0/INT
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
C1
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
RD5/SEG29/COM3
RG6/SEG26
RG5/SEG25
RG4/SEG24
RG3/SEG23
RG2/SEG22
RG1/SEG21
RG0/SEG20
RG7/SEG28
RF7/SEG19
RF6/SEG18
RF5/SEG17
RF4/SEG16
RF3/SEG15
RF2/SEG14
RF1/SEG13
RF0/SEG12
PIC16C924
C2
VLCD2
VLCD3
AVDD
VDD
VSS
OSC1/CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
Shrink PDIP (750 mil)
MCLR/VPP
RB3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
RB4
RB5
RB2
RA0/AN0
RB7
RB6
VDD
COM0
RA1/AN1
VSS
RA2/AN2
RD7/SEG31/COM1
RD6/SEG30/COM2
RD5/SEG29/COM3
RG6/SEG26
RG5/SEG25
RG4/SEG24
RG3/SEG23
RG2/SEG22
RA3/AN3/VREF
RA4/T0CKI
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
RA5/AN4/SS
RB1
RB0/INT
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
C1
RG1/SEG21
RG0/SEG20
RF7/SEG19
C2
VLCD2
VLCD3
RF6/SEG18
RF5/SEG17
RF4/SEG16
VDD
VSS
OSC1/CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
RC1/T1OSI
RF3/SEG15
RF2/SEG14
RF1/SEG13
RF0/SEG12
RE6/SEG11
RE5/SEG10
RE4/SEG09
RC2/CCP1
VLCD1
VLCDADJ
RD0/SEG00
RE3/SEG08
RE2/SEG07
RD1/SEG01
RD2/SEG02
RD3/SEG03
RE1/SEG06
RE0/SEG05
RD4/SEG04
TQFP
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
RD5/SEG29/COM3
RG6/SEG26
RG5/SEG25
RA4/T0CKI
RA5/AN4/SS
RB1
RB0/INT
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
C1
RG4/SEG24
RG3/SEG23
RG2/SEG22
RG1/SEG21
RG0/SEG20
RF7/SEG19
RF6/SEG18
RF5/SEG17
RF4/SEG16
RF3/SEG15
RF2/SEG14
RF1/SEG13
RF0/SEG12
PIC16C924
9
C2
VLCD2
VLCD3
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
VDD
VSS
OSC1/CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
LEGEND:
Input Pin
Output Pin
Input/Output Pin
Digital Input/LCD Output Pin
LCD Output Pin
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 3
PIC16C9XX
Table of Contents
1.0
2.0
3.0
4.0
5.0
6.0
7.0
8.0
9.0
General Description..................................................................................................................................................................... 5
PIC16C9XX Device Varieties...................................................................................................................................................... 7
Architectural Overview ................................................................................................................................................................ 9
Memory Organization................................................................................................................................................................ 17
Ports.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 31
Overview of Timer Modules....................................................................................................................................................... 43
Timer0 Module .......................................................................................................................................................................... 45
Timer1 Module .......................................................................................................................................................................... 51
Timer2 Module .......................................................................................................................................................................... 55
10.0 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) Module .................................................................................................................................... 57
11.0 Synchronous Serial Port (SSP) Module .................................................................................................................................... 63
12.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (A/D) Module................................................................................................................................. 79
13.0 LCD Module .............................................................................................................................................................................. 89
14.0 Special Features of the CPU................................................................................................................................................... 103
15.0 Instruction Set Summary......................................................................................................................................................... 119
16.0 Development Support.............................................................................................................................................................. 137
17.0 Electrical Characteristics......................................................................................................................................................... 141
18.0 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Tables...................................................................................................................... 161
19.0 Packaging Information............................................................................................................................................................. 171
Appendix A: ................................................................................................................................................................................... 175
Appendix B:
Compatibility ............................................................................................................................................................. 175
Appendix C: What’s New................................................................................................................................................................ 176
Appendix D: What’s Changed ........................................................................................................................................................ 176
Index .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 177
List of Equations And Examples ........................................................................................................................................................ 181
List of Figures..................................................................................................................................................................................... 181
List of Tables...................................................................................................................................................................................... 182
Reader Response .............................................................................................................................................................................. 186
PIC16C9XX Product Identification System ........................................................................................................................................ 187
To Our Valued Customers
We constantly strive to improve the quality of all our products and documentation. We have spent an exceptional
amount of time to ensure that these documents are correct. However, we realize that we may have missed a few
things. If you find any information that is missing or appears in error, please use the reader response form in the
back of this data sheet to inform us. We appreciate your assistance in making this a better document.
DS30444E - page 4
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
mode. The user can wake up the chip from SLEEP
through several external and internal interrupts and
reset(s).
1.0
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The PIC16C9XX is a family of low-cost, high-perfor-
mance, CMOS, fully-static, 8-bit microcontrollers with
an integrated LCD Driver module, in the PIC16CXXX
mid-range family.
A highly reliable Watchdog Timer with its own on-chip
RC oscillator provides recovery in the event of a soft-
ware lock-up.
All PICmicro™ microcontrollers employ an advanced
RISC architecture. The PIC16CXXX microcontroller
family has enhanced core features, eight-level deep
stack, and multiple internal and external interrupt
sources.The separate instruction and data buses of the
Harvard architecture allow a 14-bit wide instruction
word with the separate 8-bit wide data. The two stage
instruction pipeline allows all instructions to execute in
a single cycle, except for program branches (which
require two cycles). A total of 35 instructions (reduced
instruction set) are available. Additionally, a large regis-
ter set gives some of the architectural innovations used
to achieve a very high performance.
A UV erasable CERQUAD (compatible with PLCC)
packaged version is ideal for code development while
the cost-effective One-Time-Programmable (OTP) ver-
sion is suitable for production in any volume.
The PIC16C9XX family fits perfectly in applications
ranging from handheld meters, thermostats, to home
security products.The EPROM technology makes cus-
tomization of application programs (LCD panels, cali-
bration constants, sensor interfaces, etc.) extremely
fast and convenient.The small footprint packages make
this microcontroller series perfect for all applications
with space limitations. Low cost, low power, high perfor-
mance, ease of use and I/O flexibility make the
PIC16C9XX very versatile even in areas where no
microcontroller use has been considered before (e.g.
timer functions, capture and compare, PWM functions
and coprocessor applications).
PIC16CXXX microcontrollers typically achieve a 2:1
code compression and a 4:1 speed improvement over
other 8-bit microcontrollers in their class.
The PIC16C923 devices have 176 bytes of RAM and
25 I/O pins. In addition several peripheral features are
available including: three timer/counters, one Cap-
ture/Compare/PWM module, one serial port and one
LCD module.The Synchronous Serial Port can be con-
figured as either a 3-wire Serial Peripheral Interface
1.1
Family and Upward Compatibility
Users familiar with the PIC16C5X microcontroller family
will realize that this is an enhanced version of the
PIC16C5X architecture. Please refer to Appendix A for
a detailed list of enhancements. Code written for the
PIC16C5X can be easily ported to the PIC16CXXX
family of devices (Appendix B).
2
(SPI) or the two-wire Inter-Integrated Circuit (I C) bus.
The LCD module features programmable multiplex
mode (static, 1/2, 1/3 and 1/4) and drive bias (static and
1/3). It is capable of driving up to 32 segments and up
to 4 commons. It can also drive the LCD panel while in
SLEEP mode.
1.2
Development Support
PIC16C9XX devices are supported by the complete
line of Microchip Development tools.
The PIC16C924 devices have 176 bytes of RAM and
25 I/O pins. In addition several peripheral features are
available including: three timer/counters, one Cap-
ture/Compare/PWM module, one serial port and one
LCD module.The Synchronous Serial Port can be con-
figured as either a 3-wire Serial Peripheral Interface
Please refer to Section 16.0 for more details about
Microchip’s development tools.
2
(SPI) or the two-wire Inter-Integrated Circuit (I C) bus.
The LCD module features programmable multiplex
mode (static, 1/2, 1/3 and 1/4) and drive bias (static and
1/3). It is capable of driving up to 32 segments and up
to 4 commons. It can also drive the LCD panel while in
SLEEP mode. The PIC16C924 also has an 5-channel
high-speed 8-bit A/D. The 8-bit resolution is ideally
suited for applications requiring low-cost analog inter-
face, e.g. thermostat control, pressure sensing, and
meters.
The PIC16C9XX family has special features to reduce
external components, thus reducing cost, enhancing
system reliability and reducing power consumption.
There are four oscillator options, of which the single pin
RC oscillator provides a low-cost solution, the LP oscil-
lator minimizes power consumption, XT is a standard
crystal, and the HS is for High Speed crystals. The
SLEEP (power-down) feature provides a power saving
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E- page 5
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 1-1: PIC16C9XX FAMILY OF DEVICES
PIC16C923
PIC16C924
Clock
Maximum Frequency of Operation (MHz)
EPROM Program Memory
Data Memory (bytes)
8
8
4K
176
4K
176
Memory
Timer Module(s)
TMR0,
TMR1,
TMR2
TMR0,
TMR1,
TMR2
Capture/Compare/PWM Module(s)
Serial Port(s)
(SPI/I C, USART)
1
1
2
2
SPI/I C
SPI/I C
Peripherals
2
Parallel Slave Port
—
—
—
5
A/D Converter (8-bit) Channels
LCD Module
4 Com,
32 Seg
4 Com,
32 Seg
Interrupt Sources
I/O Pins
8
9
25
25
Input Pins
27
27
Voltage Range (Volts)
In-Circuit Serial Programming
Brown-out Reset
Packages
2.5-6.0
Yes
—
2.5-6.0
Yes
—
Features
64-pin SDIP,
TQFP;
64-pin SDIP,
TQFP;
68-pin PLCC,
Die
68-pin PLCC,
Die
All PICmicro Family devices have Power-on Reset, selectable Watchdog Timer, selectable code protect and high I/O current capabil-
ity. All PIC16C9XX Family devices use serial programming with clock pin RB6 and data pin RB7.
DS30444E - page 6
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
2.3
Quick-Turnaround-Production (QTP)
Devices
2.0
PIC16C9XX DEVICE VARIETIES
A variety of frequency ranges and packaging options
are available. Depending on application and production
requirements, the proper device option can be selected
using the information in the PIC16C9XX Product Iden-
tification System section at the end of this data sheet.
When placing orders, please use that page of the data
sheet to specify the correct part number.
Microchip offers a QTP Programming Service for fac-
tory production orders. This service is made available
for users who choose not to program a medium to high
quantity of units and whose code patterns have stabi-
lized. The devices are identical to the OTP devices but
with all EPROM locations and configuration options
already programmed by the factory. Certain code and
prototype verification procedures apply before produc-
tion shipments are available. Please contact your local
Microchip Technology sales office for more details.
For the PIC16C9XX family, there are two device “types”
as indicated in the device number:
1. C, as in PIC16C924. These devices have
EPROM type memory and operate over the
standard voltage range.
2.4
Serialized Quick-Turnaround
Production (SQTPSM) Devices
2. LC, as in PIC16LC924. These devices have
EPROM type memory and operate over an
extended voltage range.
Microchip offers a unique programming service where
a few user-defined locations in each device are pro-
grammed with different serial numbers.The serial num-
bers may be random, pseudo-random or sequential.
2.1
UV Erasable Devices
The UV erasable version, offered in CERQUAD pack-
age, is optimal for prototype development and pilot pro-
grams.
Serial programming allows each device to have a
unique number which can serve as an entry-code,
password or ID number.
The UV erasable version can be erased and repro-
grammed to any of the configuration modes.
Microchip's PICSTART Plus and PRO MATE II pro-
grammers both support the PIC16C9XX. Third party
programmers also are available; refer to the Microchip
Third Party Guide for a list of sources.
2.2
One-Time-Programmable (OTP)
Devices
The availability of OTP devices is especially useful for
customers who need the flexibility for frequent code
updates and small volume applications.
The OTP devices, packaged in plastic packages, permit
the user to program them once. In addition to the pro-
gram memory, the configuration bits must also be pro-
grammed.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 7
PIC16C9XX
NOTES:
DS30444E - page 8
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
PIC16CXXX devices contain an 8-bit ALU and working
register. The ALU is a general purpose arithmetic unit.
It performs arithmetic and Boolean functions between
the data in the working register and any register file.
3.0
ARCHITECTURAL OVERVIEW
The high performance of the PIC16CXXX family can be
attributed to a number of architectural features com-
monly found in RISC microprocessors. To begin with,
the PIC16CXXX uses a Harvard architecture, in which,
program and data are accessed from separate memo-
ries using separate buses. This improves bandwidth
over traditional von Neumann architecture where pro-
gram and data are fetched from the same memory
using the same bus. Separating program and data
buses further allows instructions to be sized differently
than the 8-bit wide data word. Instruction opcodes are
14-bits wide making it possible to have all single word
instructions.A 14-bit wide program memory access bus
fetches a 14-bit instruction in a single cycle. A
two-stage pipeline overlaps fetch and execution of
instructions (Example 3-1). Consequently, all instruc-
tions execute in a single cycle (500 ns @ 8 MHz) except
for program branches.
The ALU is 8-bits wide and capable of addition, sub-
traction, shift and logical operations. Unless otherwise
mentioned, arithmetic operations are two's comple-
ment in nature. In two-operand instructions, typically
one operand is the working register (W register). The
other operand is a file register or an immediate con-
stant. In single operand instructions, the operand is
either the W register or a file register.
The W register is an 8-bit working register used for ALU
operations. It is not an addressable register.
Depending on the instruction executed, the ALU may
affect the values of the Carry (C), Digit Carry (DC), and
Zero (Z) bits in the STATUS register.The C and DC bits
operate as a borrow bit and a digit borrow out bit,
respectively, in subtraction. See the SUBLWand SUBWF
instructions for examples.
The PIC16C923 and PIC16C924 both address 4K x 14
of program memory and 176 x 8 of data memory.
The PIC16CXXX can directly or indirectly address its
register files or data memory. All special function regis-
ters, including the program counter, are mapped in the
data memory. The PIC16CXXX has an orthogonal
(symmetrical) instruction set that makes it possible to
carry out any operation on any register using any
addressing mode. This symmetrical nature and lack of
‘special optimal situations’ make programming with the
PIC16CXXX simple yet efficient, thus significantly
reducing the learning curve.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 9
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 3-1: PIC16C923 BLOCK DIAGRAM
13
8
PORTA
Data Bus
Program Counter
EPROM
RA0
RA1
RA2
RA3
RA4/T0CKI
Program
Memory
RAM
File
Registers
8 Level Stack
4K x 14
(13-bit)
RA5/SS
176 x 8
Program
14
RAM Addr
PORTB
Bus
9
Addr MUX
Instruction reg
RB0/INT
7
Direct Addr
Indirect
Addr
8
RB1-RB7
FSR reg
STATUS reg
MUX
PORTC
8
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
RC1/T1OSI
RC2/CCP1
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
3
Power-up
Timer
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Instruction
Decode &
Control
ALU
Power-on
Reset
PORTD
PORTE
PORTF
PORTG
8
Timing
Generation
Watchdog
Timer
W reg
RD0-RD4/SEGnn
OSC1/CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
RD5-RD7/SEGnn/COMn
MCLR
VDD, VSS
RE0-RE7/SEGnn
RF0-RF7/SEGnn
RG0-RG7/SEGnn
Timer1, Timer2,
CCP1
Timer0
COM0
VLCD1
VLCD2
VLCD3
C1
Synchronous
Serial Port
LCD
C2
VLCDADJ
DS30444E - page 10
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 3-2: PIC16C924 BLOCK DIAGRAM
13
8
PORTA
Data Bus
Program Counter
EPROM
RA0/AN0
RA1/AN1
RA2/AN2
RA3/AN3/VREF
RA4/T0CKI
RA5/AN4/SS
Program
Memory
RAM
File
Registers
8 Level Stack
4K x 14
(13-bit)
176 x 8
Program
14
RAM Addr
PORTB
Bus
9
Addr MUX
Instruction reg
RB0/INT
7
Direct Addr
Indirect
Addr
8
RB1-RB7
FSR reg
STATUS reg
MUX
PORTC
8
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
RC1/T1OSI
RC2/CCP1
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
3
Power-up
Timer
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Instruction
Decode &
Control
ALU
Power-on
Reset
PORTD
PORTE
PORTF
PORTG
8
Timing
Generation
Watchdog
Timer
W reg
RD0-RD4/SEGnn
OSC1/CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
RD5-RD7/SEGnn/COMn
MCLR
VDD, VSS
RE0-RE7/SEGnn
RF0-RF7/SEGnn
RG0-RG7/SEGnn
Timer1, Timer2,
CCP1
Timer0
A/D
COM0
VLCD1
VLCD2
VLCD3
C1
Synchronous
Serial Port
LCD
C2
VLCDADJ
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 11
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 3-1: PIC16C9XX PINOUT DESCRIPTION
DIP
Pin#
PLCC
Pin#
TQFP Pin
Pin# Type
Buffer
Type
Pin Name
Description
OSC1/CLKIN
22
24
14
I
ST/CMOS Oscillator crystal input or external clock source input. This
buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when configured in RC
oscillator mode and a CMOS input otherwise.
OSC2/CLKOUT
MCLR/VPP
23
25
15
O
—
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator
in crystal oscillator mode. In RC mode, OSC2 pin outputs
CLKOUT which has 1/4 the frequency of OSC1, and
denotes the instruction cycle rate.
1
2
57
I/P
ST
Master clear (reset) input or programming voltage input.
This pin is an active low reset to the device.
PORTA is a bi-directional I/O port. The AN and VREF multi-
plexed functions are used by the PIC16C924 only.
RA0/AN0
4
5
7
8
5
6
8
9
60
61
63
64
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
TTL
TTL
TTL
TTL
RA0 can also be Analog input0.
RA1 can also be Analog input1.
RA2 can also be Analog input2.
RA1/AN1
RA2/AN2
RA3/AN3/VREF
RA3 can also be Analog input3 or A/D Voltage Refer-
ence.
RA4/T0CKI
9
10
11
1
2
I/O
I/O
ST
RA4 can also be the clock input to the Timer0
timer/counter. Output is open drain type.
RA5/AN4/SS
10
TTL
RA5 can be the slave select for the synchronous serial
port or Analog input4.
PORTB is a bi-directional I/O port. PORTB can be software
programmed for internal weak pull-ups on all inputs.
RB0/INT
12
13
4
I/O
TTL/ST
RB0 can also be the external interrupt pin. This buffer
is a Schmitt Trigger input when configured as an exter-
nal interrupt.
RB1
RB2
RB3
RB4
RB5
RB6
11
3
12
4
3
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
TTL
TTL
59
58
56
55
53
2
3
TTL
64
63
61
68
67
65
TTL
Interrupt on change pin.
Interrupt on change pin.
TTL
TTL/ST
Interrupt on change pin. Serial programming clock.
This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when used in
serial programming mode.
RB7
62
66
54
I/O
TTL/ST
Interrupt on change pin. Serial programming data.
This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when used in
serial programming mode.
PORTC is a bi-directional I/O port.
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
24
26
16
I/O
ST
RC0 can also be the Timer1 oscillator output or
Timer1 clock input.
RC1/T1OSI
RC2/CCP1
25
26
27
28
17
18
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
RC1 can also be the Timer1 oscillator input.
RC2 can also be the Capture1 input/Compare1 out-
put/PWM1 output.
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
13
14
14
15
5
6
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
ST
RC3 can also be the synchronous serial clock
input/output for both SPI and I C modes.
2
RC4 can also be the SPI Data In (SPI mode) or data
2
I/O (I C mode).
RC5/SDO
C1
15
16
17
16
17
18
7
8
9
I/O
P
RC5 can also be the SPI Data Out (SPI mode).
LCD Voltage Generation.
C2
P
LCD Voltage Generation.
Legend: I = input
O = output
P = power
L = LCD Driver
— = Not used
TTL = TTL input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input
DS30444E - page 12
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 3-1: PIC16C9XX PINOUT DESCRIPTION (Cont.’d)
DIP
Pin#
PLCC
Pin#
TQFP Pin
Pin# Type
Buffer
Type
Pin Name
Description
COM0
59
63
51
L
Common Driver0
PORTD is a digital input/output port. These pins are also
used as LCD Segment and/or Common Drivers.
Segment Driver00/Digital Input/Output.
Segment Driver01/Digital Input/Output.
Segment Driver02/Digital Input/Output.
Segment Driver03/Digital Input/Output.
Segment Driver04/Digital Input/Output.
Segment Driver29/Common Driver3/Digital Input.
Segment Driver30/Common Driver2/Digital Input.
Segment Driver31/Common Driver1/Digital Input.
RD0/SEG00
29
30
31
32
33
56
57
58
31
32
33
34
35
60
61
62
21
22
23
24
25
48
49
50
I/O/L
I/O/L
I/O/L
I/O/L
I/O/L
I/L
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
RD1/SEG01
RD2/SEG02
RD3/SEG03
RD4/SEG04
RD5/SEG29/COM3
RD6/SEG30/COM2
RD7/SEG31/COM1
I/L
I/L
PORTE is a digital input or LCD Segment Driver port.
Segment Driver05.
RE0/SEG05
RE1/SEG06
RE2/SEG07
RE3/SEG08
RE4/SEG09
RE5/SEG10
RE6/SEG11
RE7/SEG27
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
-
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
36
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
-
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
Segment Driver06.
Segment Driver07.
Segment Driver08.
Segment Driver09.
Segment Driver10.
Segment Driver11.
Segment Driver27 (Not available on 64-pin devices).
PORTF is a digital input or LCD Segment Driver port.
Segment Driver12.
RF0/SEG12
RF1/SEG13
RF2/SEG14
RF3/SEG15
RF4/SEG16
RF5/SEG17
RF6/SEG18
RF7/SEG19
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
Segment Driver13.
Segment Driver14.
Segment Driver15.
Segment Driver16.
Segment Driver17.
Segment Driver18.
Segment Driver19.
PORTG is a digital input or LCD Segment Driver port.
Segment Driver20.
RG0/SEG20
RG1/SEG21
RG2/SEG22
RG3/SEG23
RG4/SEG24
RG5/SEG25
RG6/SEG26
RG7/SEG28
VLCDADJ
AVDD
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
—
28
—
—
27
18
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
52
30
21
21
29
19
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
—
20
—
—
19
10
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
I/L
P
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
Segment Driver21.
Segment Driver22.
Segment Driver23.
Segment Driver24.
Segment Driver25.
Segment Driver26.
Segment Driver28 (Not available on 64-pin devices).
LCD Voltage Generation.
Analog Power (PIC16C924 only).
Power (PIC16C923 only).
LCD Voltage.
P
VDD
P
VLCD1
P
VLCD2
P
—
LCD Voltage.
Legend: I = input
O = output
P = power
L = LCD Driver
— = Not used
TTL = TTL input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 13
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 3-1: PIC16C9XX PINOUT DESCRIPTION (Cont.’d)
DIP
Pin#
PLCC
Pin#
TQFP Pin
Pin# Type
Buffer
Type
Pin Name
Description
VLCD3
VDD
VSS
19
20
11
P
P
—
—
—
—
LCD Voltage.
20, 60 22, 64 12, 52
Digital power.
6, 21
—
7, 23
1
13, 62
—
P
Ground reference.
NC
—
These pins are not internally connected.These pins should
be left unconnected.
Legend: I = input
O = output
P = power
L = LCD Driver
— = Not used
TTL = TTL input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input
DS30444E - page 14
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
3.1
Clocking Scheme/Instruction Cycle
3.2
Instruction Flow/Pipelining
The clock input (from OSC1) is internally divided by
four to generate four non-overlapping quadrature
clocks namely Q1, Q2, Q3 and Q4. Internally, the pro-
gram counter (PC) is incremented every Q1, the
instruction is fetched from the program memory and
latched into the instruction register in Q4. The instruc-
tion is decoded and executed during the following Q1
through Q4. The clocks and instruction execution flow
is shown in Figure 3-3.
An “Instruction Cycle” consists of four Q cycles (Q1,
Q2, Q3 and Q4). The instruction fetch and execute are
pipelined such that fetch takes one instruction cycle
while decode and execute takes another instruction
cycle. However, due to the pipelining, each instruction
effectively executes in one cycle. If an instruction
causes the program counter to change (e.g. GOTO)
then two cycles are required to complete the instruction
(Example 3-1).
A fetch cycle begins with the program counter (PC)
incrementing in Q1.
In the execution cycle, the fetched instruction is latched
into the “Instruction Register" in cycle Q1. This instruc-
tion is then decoded and executed during the Q2, Q3,
and Q4 cycles. Data memory is read during Q2 (oper-
and read) and written during Q4 (destination write).
FIGURE 3-3: CLOCK/INSTRUCTION CYCLE
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q1
Q1
OSC1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Internal
phase
clock
Q4
PC
PC
PC+1
PC+2
OSC2/CLKOUT
(RC mode)
Fetch INST (PC)
Execute INST (PC-1)
Fetch INST (PC+1)
Execute INST (PC)
Fetch INST (PC+2)
Execute INST (PC+1)
EXAMPLE 3-1: INSTRUCTION PIPELINE FLOW
Tcy0
Tcy1
Tcy2
Tcy3
Tcy4
Tcy5
1. MOVLW 55h
Fetch 1
Execute 1
Fetch 2
2. MOVWF PORTB
3. CALL SUB_1
Execute 2
Fetch 3
Execute 3
Fetch 4
4. BSF
PORTA, BIT3 (Forced NOP)
Flush
5. Instruction @ address SUB_1
Fetch SUB_1 Execute SUB_1
All instructions are single cycle, except for any program branches. These take two cycles since the fetch
instruction is “flushed” from the pipeline while the new instruction is being fetched and then executed.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 15
PIC16C9XX
NOTES:
DS30444E - page 16
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
4.2
Data Memory Organization
4.0
MEMORY ORGANIZATION
The data memory is partitioned into four Banks which
contain the General Purpose Registers and the Special
Function Registers. Bits RP1 and RP0 are the bank
select bits.
4.1
Program Memory Organization
The PIC16C9XX family has a 13-bit program counter
capable of addressing an 8K x 14 program memory
space.
RP1:RP0 (STATUS<6:5>)
11 = Bank 3 (180h-1FFh)
10 = Bank 2 (100h-17Fh)
01 = Bank 1 (80h-FFh)
00 = Bank 0 (00h-7Fh)
Only the first 4K x 14 (0000h-0FFFh) is physically
implemented. Accessing a location above the physi-
cally implemented addresses will cause a wraparound.
The reset vector is at 0000h and the interrupt vector is
at 0004h.
The lower locations of each Bank are reserved for the
Special Function Registers. Above the Special Func-
tion Registers are General Purpose Registers imple-
mented as static RAM. All four banks contain special
function registers. Some “high use” special function
registers are mirrored in other banks for code reduction
and quicker access.
FIGURE 4-1: PROGRAM MEMORY MAP
AND STACK
PC<12:0>
CALL, RETURN
RETFIE, RETLW
13
4.2.1
GENERAL PURPOSE REGISTER FILE
Stack Level 1
Stack Level 8
The register file can be accessed either directly, or indi-
rectly through the File Select Register FSR
(Section 4.5).
The following General Purpose Registers are not phys-
ically implemented:
Reset Vector
0000h
• F0h-FFh of Bank 1
• 170h-17Fh of Bank 2
• 1F0h-1FFh of Bank 3
Interrupt Vector
0004h
0005h
These locations are used for common access across
banks.
On-chip Program
Memory (Page 0)
07FFh
0800h
On-chip Program
Memory (Page 1)
0FFFh
1000h
1FFFh
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 17
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 4-2: REGISTER FILE MAP
File
Address
File
Address
File
Address
File
Address
(1)
(1)
(1)
(1)
Indirect addr.
Indirect addr.
OPTION
PCL
100h
101h
102h
103h
104h
105h
106h
107h
108h
109h
10Ah
10Bh
10Ch
10Dh
10Eh
10Fh
110h
111h
112h
113h
114h
115h
116h
117h
118h
119h
11Ah
11Bh
11Ch
11Dh
11Eh
11Fh
120h
Indirect addr.
TMR0
Indirect addr.
00h
01h
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
12h
13h
14h
15h
16h
17h
18h
19h
1Ah
1Bh
1Ch
1Dh
1Eh
1Fh
20h
180h
181h
182h
183h
184h
185h
186h
187h
188h
189h
18Ah
18Bh
18Ch
18Dh
18Eh
18Fh
190h
191h
192h
193h
194h
195h
196h
197h
198h
199h
19Ah
19Bh
19Ch
19Dh
19Eh
19Fh
80h
81h
82h
83h
84h
85h
86h
87h
88h
89h
8Ah
8Bh
8Ch
8Dh
8Eh
8Fh
90h
91h
92h
93h
94h
95h
96h
97h
98h
99h
9Ah
9Bh
9Ch
9Dh
9Eh
9Fh
TMR0
PCL
OPTION
PCL
PCL
STATUS
FSR
STATUS
FSR
STATUS
FSR
STATUS
FSR
PORTA
PORTB
PORTC
PORTD
PORTE
PCLATH
INTCON
PIR1
TRISA
TRISB
TRISC
TRISD
TRISE
TRISB
TRISF
TRISG
PORTB
PORTF
PORTG
PCLATH
INTCON
PCLATH
INTCON
PCLATH
INTCON
PIE1
LCDSE
LCDPS
TMR1L
TMR1H
PCON
LCDCON
LCDD00
LCDD01
LCDD02
LCDD03
LCDD04
LCDD05
LCDD06
LCDD07
LCDD08
LCDD09
LCDD10
LCDD11
LCDD12
LCDD13
LCDD14
LCDD15
T1CON
TMR2
T2CON
PR2
SSPBUF
SSPCON
CCPR1L
CCPR1H
CCP1CON
SSPADD
SSPSTAT
(2)
ADRES
(2)
(2)
ADCON0
ADCON1
1A0h
A0h
General
Purpose
Register
General
Purpose
Register
1EFh
1F0h
EFh
F0h
16F
170
Mapped in
Bank 0
Mapped in
Bank 0
Mapped in
Bank 0
70h-7Fh
70h-7Fh
70h-7Fh
17F
1FFh
7Fh
FFh
Bank 3
Bank 1
Bank 2
Bank 0
Unimplemented data memory locations, read as '0'.
Note 1: Not a physical register.
2: These registers are not implemented on the PIC16C923.
DS30444E - page 18
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
4.2.2
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS
The special function registers can be classified into two
sets (core and peripheral). Those registers associated
with the “core” functions are described in this section,
and those related to the operation of the peripheral fea-
tures are described in the section of that peripheral fea-
ture.
The Special Function Registers are registers used by
the CPU and Peripheral Modules for controlling the
desired operation of the device. These registers are
implemented as static RAM.
TABLE 4-1: SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTER SUMMARY
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Bank 0
00h
01h
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
12h
13h
14h
15h
16h
17h
18h
19h
1Ah
1Bh
1Ch
1Dh
1Eh(1)
1Fh(1)
Legend:
INDF
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register)
Timer0 module’s register
0000 0000 0000 0000
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
TMR0
PCL
Program Counter's (PC) Least Significant Byte
STATUS
FSR
IRP
Indirect data memory address pointer
PORTA Data Latch when written: PORTA pins when read
PORTB Data Latch when written: PORTB pins when read
PORTC Data Latch when written: PORTC pins when read
RP1
RP0
TO
PD
Z
DC
C
(4)
(4)
PORTA
PORTB
PORTC
PORTD
PORTE
PCLATH
INTCON
PIR1
—
—
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
--xx xxxx --uu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
---0 0000 ---0 0000
0000 000x 0000 000u
—
—
PORTD Data Latch when written: PORTD pins when read
PORTE pins when read
—
—
—
T0IE
—
Write Buffer for the upper 5 bits of the Program Counter
GIE
PEIE
ADIF(2)
INTE
—
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
LCDIF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF 00-- 0000 00-- 0000
—
Unimplemented
—
—
TMR1L
TMR1H
T1CON
TMR2
T2CON
SSPBUF
SSPCON
CCPR1L
CCPR1H
CCP1CON
—
Holding register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register
Holding register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
—
—
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC
TMR1CS TMR1ON --00 0000 --uu uuuu
Timer2 module’s register
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0 -000 0000 -000 0000
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
WCOL
SSPOV
SSPEN
CKP
SSPM3
SSPM2
SSPM1
SSPM0
Capture/Compare/PWM Register (LSB)
Capture/Compare/PWM Register (MSB)
—
—
CCP1X
CCP1Y
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
CCP1M0 --00 0000 --00 0000
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADRES
ADCON0
A/D Result Register
ADCS1 ADCS0
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
(5)
CHS2
CHS1
CHS0
GO/DONE
ADON
x= unknown, u= unchanged, q= value depends on condition, - = unimplemented read as '0',
shaded locations are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
Note 1: Registers ADRES, ADCON0, and ADCON1 are not implemented in the PIC16C923, read as '0'.
2: These bits are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
3: These pixels do not display, but can be used as general purpose RAM.
4: PIC16C923 reset values for PORTA: --xx xxxxfor a POR, and --uu uuuufor all other resets,
PIC16C924 reset values for PORTA: --0x 0000when read.
5: Bit1 of ADCON0 is reserved on the PIC16C924, always maintain this bit clear.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 19
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 4-1: SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTER SUMMARY (Cont.’d)
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Bank 1
80h
81h
82h
83h
84h
85h
86h
87h
88h
89h
8Ah
8Bh
8Ch
8Dh
8Eh
8Fh
90h
91h
92h
93h
94h
95h
96h
97h
98h
99h
9Ah
9Bh
9Ch
9Dh
9Eh
9Fh(1)
Legend:
INDF
OPTION
PCL
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register)
0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
--11 1111 --11 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
--11 1111 --11 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
---0 0000 ---0 0000
0000 000x 0000 000u
RBPU
Program Counter's (PC) Least Significant Byte
IRP RP1 RP0 TO
Indirect data memory address pointer
PORTA Data Direction Register
PORTB Data Direction Register
PORTC Data Direction Register
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
STATUS
FSR
TRISA
TRISB
TRISC
TRISD
TRISE
PCLATH
INTCON
PIE1
—
PD
Z
DC
C
—
—
—
—
PORTD Data Direction Register
PORTE Data Direction Register
—
—
—
T0IE
—
Write Buffer for the upper 5 bits of the PC
GIE
PEIE
ADIE(2)
INTE
—
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
LCDIE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE 00-- 0000 00-- 0000
Unimplemented
—
—
—
PCON
—
—
—
—
—
—
POR
—
---- --0- ---- --u-
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PR2
Timer2 Period Register
Synchronous Serial Port (I2C mode) Address Register
1111 1111 1111 1111
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
SSPADD
SSPSTAT
—
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADCON1
—
—
—
—
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
---- -000 ---- -000
x= unknown, u= unchanged, q= value depends on condition, - = unimplemented read as '0',
shaded locations are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
Note 1: Registers ADRES, ADCON0, and ADCON1 are not implemented in the PIC16C923, read as '0'.
2: These bits are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
3: These pixels do not display, but can be used as general purpose RAM.
4: PIC16C923 reset values for PORTA: --xx xxxxfor a POR, and --uu uuuufor all other resets,
PIC16C924 reset values for PORTA: --0x 0000when read.
5: Bit1 of ADCON0 is reserved on the PIC16C924, always maintain this bit clear.
DS30444E - page 20
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 4-1: SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTER SUMMARY (Cont.’d)
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Bank 2
100h
101h
102h
103h
104h
105h
106h
107h
108h
109h
10Ah
10Bh
10Ch
10Dh
10Eh
10Fh
INDF
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register)
Timer0 module’s register
0000 0000 0000 0000
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
TMR0
PCL
Program Counter's (PC) Least Significant Byte
STATUS
FSR
IRP
RP1
RP0
TO
PD
Z
DC
C
Indirect data memory address pointer
Unimplemented
—
—
—
PORTB
PORTF
PORTG
—
PORTB Data Latch when written: PORTB pins when read
PORTF pins when read
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
PORTG pins when read
Unimplemented
—
—
PCLATH
INTCON
—
—
—
—
Write Buffer for the upper 5 bits of the PC
---0 0000 ---0 0000
0000 000x 0000 000u
GIE
Unimplemented
SE29
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
—
—
LCDSE
LCDPS
LCDCON
SE27
—
SE20
—
SE16
—
SE12
LP3
SE9
LP2
CS0
SE5
LP1
SE0
LP0
1111 1111 1111 1111
---- 0000 ---- 0000
00-0 0000 00-0 0000
—
LCDEN
SLPEN
—
VGEN
CS1
LMUX1
LMUX0
SEG07
COM0
SEG06
COM0
SEG05
COM0
SEG04
COM0
SEG03
COM0
SEG02
COM0
SEG01
COM0
SEG00
COM0
110h
111h
112h
113h
114h
115h
116h
117h
118h
119h
11Ah
11Bh
11Ch
11Dh
11Eh
LCDD00
LCDD01
LCDD02
LCDD03
LCDD04
LCDD05
LCDD06
LCDD07
LCDD08
LCDD09
LCDD10
LCDD11
LCDD12
LCDD13
LCDD14
LCDD15
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
SEG15
COM0
SEG14
COM0
SEG13
COM0
SEG12
COM0
SEG11
COM0
SEG10
COM0
SEG09
COM0
SEG08
COM0
SEG23
COM0
SEG22
COM0
SEG21
COM0
SEG20
COM0
SEG19
COM0
SEG18
COM0
SEG17
COM0
SEG16
COM0
SEG31
COM0
SEG30
COM0
SEG29
COM0
SEG28
COM0
SEG27
COM0
SEG26
COM0
SEG25
COM0
SEG24
COM0
SEG07
COM1
SEG06
COM1
SEG05
COM1
SEG04
COM1
SEG03
COM1
SEG02
COM1
SEG01
COM1
SEG00
COM1
SEG15
COM1
SEG14
COM1
SEG13
COM1
SEG12
COM1
SEG11
COM1
SEG10
COM1
SEG09
COM1
SEG08
COM1
SEG23
COM1
SEG22
COM1
SEG21
COM1
SEG20
COM1
SEG19
COM1
SEG18
COM1
SEG17
COM1
SEG16
COM1
SEG31
SEG30
COM1
SEG29
COM1
SEG28
COM1
SEG27
COM1
SEG26
COM1
SEG25
COM1
SEG24
COM1
COM1(3)
SEG07
COM2
SEG06
COM2
SEG05
COM2
SEG04
COM2
SEG03
COM2
SEG02
COM2
SEG01
COM2
SEG00
COM2
SEG15
COM2
SEG14
COM2
SEG13
COM2
SEG12
COM2
SEG11
COM2
SEG10
COM2
SEG09
COM2
SEG08
COM2
SEG23
COM2
SEG22
COM2
SEG21
COM2
SEG20
COM2
SEG19
COM2
SEG18
COM2
SEG17
COM2
SEG16
COM2
SEG31
SEG30
SEG29
COM2
SEG28
COM2
SEG27
COM2
SEG26
COM2
SEG25
COM2
SEG24
COM2
COM2(3)
COM2(3)
SEG07
COM3
SEG06
COM3
SEG05
COM3
SEG04
COM3
SEG03
COM3
SEG02
COM3
SEG01
COM3
SEG00
COM3
SEG15
COM3
SEG14
COM3
SEG13
COM3
SEG12
COM3
SEG11
COM3
SEG10
COM3
SEG09
COM3
SEG08
COM3
SEG23
COM3
SEG22
COM3
SEG21
COM3
SEG20
COM3
SEG19
COM3
SEG18
COM3
SEG17
COM3
SEG16
COM3
SEG31
SEG30
SEG29
SEG28
COM3
SEG27
COM3
SEG26
COM3
SEG25
COM3
SEG24
COM3
11Fh
COM3(3)
COM3(3)
COM3(3)
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, q= value depends on condition, - = unimplemented read as '0',
shaded locations are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
Note 1: Registers ADRES, ADCON0, and ADCON1 are not implemented in the PIC16C923, read as '0'.
2: These bits are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
3: These pixels do not display, but can be used as general purpose RAM.
4: PIC16C923 reset values for PORTA: --xx xxxxfor a POR, and --uu uuuufor all other resets,
PIC16C924 reset values for PORTA: --0x 0000when read.
5: Bit1 of ADCON0 is reserved on the PIC16C924, always maintain this bit clear.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 21
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 4-1: SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTER SUMMARY (Cont.’d)
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Bank 3
180h
181h
182h
183h
184h
185h
186h
187h
188h
189h
18Ah
18Bh
18Ch
18Dh
18Eh
18Fh
190h
191h
192h
193h
194h
195h
196h
197h
198h
199h
19Ah
19Bh
19Ch
19Dh
19Eh
19Fh
Legend:
INDF
OPTION
PCL
STATUS
FSR
—
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register)
0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
RBPU
Program Counter's (PC) Least Significant Byte
IRP RP1 RP0 TO
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
PD
Z
DC
C
Indirect data memory address pointer
Unimplemented
—
—
TRISB
TRISF
TRISG
—
PORTB Data Direction Register
PORTF Data Direction Register
PORTG Data Direction Register
Unimplemented
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
—
—
PCLATH
INTCON
—
—
—
—
Write Buffer for the upper 5 bits of the PC
INTE RBIE T0IF INTF
---0 0000 ---0 0000
0000 000x 0000 000u
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
RBIF
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
x= unknown, u= unchanged, q= value depends on condition, - = unimplemented read as '0',
shaded locations are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
Note 1: Registers ADRES, ADCON0, and ADCON1 are not implemented in the PIC16C923, read as '0'.
2: These bits are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
3: These pixels do not display, but can be used as general purpose RAM.
4: PIC16C923 reset values for PORTA: --xx xxxxfor a POR, and --uu uuuufor all other resets,
PIC16C924 reset values for PORTA: --0x 0000when read.
5: Bit1 of ADCON0 is reserved on the PIC16C924, always maintain this bit clear.
DS30444E - page 22
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
4.2.2.1
STATUS REGISTER
It is recommended, therefore, that only BCF, BSF,
SWAPF and MOVWF instructions are used to alter the
STATUS register because these instructions do not
affect the Z, C or DC bits from the STATUS register. For
other instructions, not affecting any status bits, see the
“Instruction Set Summary.”
The STATUS register, shown in Figure 4-3, contains the
arithmetic status of the ALU, the RESET status and the
bank select bits for data memory.
The STATUS register can be the destination for any
instruction, as with any other register. If the STATUS
register is the destination for an instruction that affects
the Z, DC or C bits, then the write to these three bits is
disabled.These bits are set or cleared according to the
device logic. Furthermore, the TO and PD bits are not
writable. Therefore, the result of an instruction with the
STATUS register as destination may be different than
intended.
Note 1: The C and DC bits operate as a borrow
and digit borrow bit, respectively, in sub-
traction. See the SUBLW and SUBWF
instructions for examples.
For example, CLRF STATUSwill clear the upper-three
bits and set the Z bit. This leaves the STATUS register
as 000u u1uu(where u= unchanged).
FIGURE 4-3: STATUS REGISTER (ADDRESS 03h, 83h, 103h, 183h)
R/W-0
IRP
R/W-0
RP1
R/W-0
RP0
R-1
TO
R-1
PD
R/W-x
Z
R/W-x
DC
R/W-x
C
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
bit7
bit0
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7:
IRP: Register Bank Select bit (used for indirect addressing)
1 = Bank 2, 3 (100h - 1FFh)
0 = Bank 0, 1 (00h - FFh)
bit 6-5: RP1:RP0: Register Bank Select bits (used for direct addressing)
11= Bank 3 (180h - 1FFh)
10= Bank 2 (100h - 17Fh)
01= Bank 1 (80h - FFh)
00= Bank 0 (00h - 7Fh)
bit 4:
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
TO: Time-out bit
1 = After power-up, CLRWDTinstruction, or SLEEPinstruction
0 = A WDT time-out occurred
PD: Power-down bit
1 = After power-up or by the CLRWDTinstruction
0 = By execution of the SLEEPinstruction
Z: Zero bit
1 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero
0 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero
DC: Digit carry/borrow bit (ADDWF, ADDLW,SUBLW,SUBWFinstructions) (for borrow the polarity is reversed)
1 = A carry-out from the 4th low order bit of the result occurred
0 = No carry-out from the 4th low order bit of the result
C: Carry/borrow bit (ADDWF, ADDLW,SUBLW,SUBWF instructions) (for borrow the polarity is reversed)
1 = A carry-out from the most significant bit of the result occurred
0 = No carry-out from the most significant bit of the result occurred
Note: A subtraction is executed by adding the two’s complement of the second operand. For rotate (RRF,
RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either the high or low order bit of the source register.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 23
PIC16C9XX
4.2.2.2
OPTION REGISTER
Note: To achieve a 1:1 prescaler assignment for
the TMR0 register, assign the prescaler to
the Watchdog Timer.
The OPTION register is a readable and writable regis-
ter which contains various control bits to configure the
TMR0/WDT prescaler, the external RB0/INT pin inter-
rupt, TMR0, and the weak pull-ups on PORTB.
FIGURE 4-4: OPTION REGISTER (ADDRESS 81h, 181h)
R/W-1
RBPU
R/W-1
R/W-1
T0CS
R/W-1
T0SE
R/W-1
PSA
R/W-1
PS2
R/W-1
PS1
R/W-1
PS0
INTEDG
R
= Readable bit
W = Writable bit
bit7
bit0
U
= Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7:
RBPU: PORTB Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTB pull-ups are disabled
0 = PORTB pull-ups are enabled by individual port latch values
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3:
INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge of RB0/INT pin
0 = Interrupt on falling edge of RB0/INT pin
T0CS: TMR0 Clock Source Select bit
1 = Transition on RA4/T0CKI pin
0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (CLKOUT)
T0SE: TMR0 Source Edge Select bit
1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on RA4/T0CKI pin
0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on RA4/T0CKI pin
PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit
1 = Prescaler is assigned to the WDT
0 = Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module
bit 2-0: PS2:PS0: Prescaler Rate Select bits
Bit Value
TMR0 Rate WDT Rate
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
1 : 1
1 : 2
1 : 4
1 : 8
1 : 16
1 : 32
1 : 64
1 : 128
1 : 2
1 : 4
1 : 8
1 : 16
1 : 32
1 : 64
1 : 128
1 : 256
DS30444E - page 24
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
4.2.2.3
INTCON REGISTER
Note: Interrupt flag bits get set when an interrupt
condition occurs regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the global
enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>).
The INTCON Register is a readable and writable regis-
ter which contains various enable and flag bits for the
TMR0 register overflow, RB Port change and external
RB0/INT pin interrupts.
FIGURE 4-5: INTCON REGISTER (ADDRESS 0Bh, 8Bh, 10Bh, 18Bh)
R/W-0
GIE
R/W-0
PEIE
R/W-0
T0IE
R/W-0
INTE
R/W-0
RBIE
R/W-0
T0IF
R/W-0
INTF
R/W-x
RBIF
R
= Readable bit
W = Writable bit
bit7
bit0
U
= Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7:
GIE: Global Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables all un-masked interrupts
0 = Disables all interrupts
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
PEIE: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables all un-masked peripheral interrupts
0 = Disables all peripheral interrupts
T0IE: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR0 interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR0 interrupt
INTE: RB0/INT External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the RB0/INT external interrupt
0 = Disables the RB0/INT external interrupt
RBIE: RB Port Change Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the RB port change interrupt
0 = Disables the RB port change interrupt
T0IF: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR0 register has overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR0 register did not overflow
INTF: RB0/INT External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The RB0/INT external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The RB0/INT external interrupt did not occur
RBIF: RB Port Change Interrupt Flag bit
1 = At least one of the RB7:RB4 pins changed state (see Section 5.2 to clear interrupt)
0 = None of the RB7:RB4 pins have changed state
Interrupt flag bits get set when an interrupt condition occurs regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the
global enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>). User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to
enabling an interrupt.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 25
PIC16C9XX
4.2.2.4
PIE1 REGISTER
Note: Bit PEIE (INTCON<6>) must be set to
This register contains the individual enable bits for the
peripheral interrupts.
enable any peripheral interrupt.
FIGURE 4-6: PIE1 REGISTER (ADDRESS 8Ch)
R/W-0
LCDIE
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
SSPIE
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMR2IE TMR1IE
bit0
R/W-0
(1)
ADIE
CCP1IE
R
= Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U
bit7
= Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7:
LCDIE: LCD Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the LCD interrupt
0 = Disables the LCD interrupt
bit 6:
ADIE: A/D Converter Interrupt Enable bit(1)
1 = Enables the A/D interrupt
0 = Disables the A/D interrupt
bit 5-4: Unimplemented: Read as '0'
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
SSPIE: Synchronous Serial Port Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the SSP interrupt
0 = Disables the SSP interrupt
CCP1IE: CCP1 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the CCP1 interrupt
0 = Disables the CCP1 interrupt
TMR2IE: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR2 to PR2 match interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR2 to PR2 match interrupt
TMR1IE: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR1 overflow interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR1 overflow interrupt
Note 1: Bit ADIE is reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain this bit clear.
DS30444E - page 26
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
4.2.2.5
PIR1 REGISTER
Note: Interrupt flag bits get set when an interrupt
condition occurs regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the global
enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>). User soft-
ware should ensure the appropriate inter-
rupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an
interrupt.
This register contains the individual flag bits for the
peripheral interrupts.
FIGURE 4-7: PIR1 REGISTER (ADDRESS 0Ch)
R/W-0
LCDIF
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
SSPIF
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMR2IF TMR1IF
bit0
R/W-0
(1)
ADIF
CCP1IF
R
= Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U
bit7
= Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7:
LCDIF: LCD Interrupt Flag bit
1 = LCD interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = LCD interrupt did not occur
bit 6:
ADIF: A/D Converter Interrupt Flag bit(1)
1 = An A/D conversion completed (must be cleared in software)
0 = The A/D conversion is not complete
bit 5-4: Unimplemented: Read as '0'
bit 3:
SSPIF: Synchronous Serial Port Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The transmission/reception is complete (must be cleared in software)
0 = Waiting to transmit/receive
bit 2:
CCP1IF: CCP1 Interrupt Flag bit
Capture Mode
1 = A TMR1 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1 register capture occurred
Compare Mode
1 = A TMR1 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1 register compare match occurred
PWM Mode
Unused in this mode
bit 1:
bit 0:
TMR2IF: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR2 to PR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR2 to PR2 match occurred
TMR1IF: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR1 register overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR1 register did not overflow
Note 1: Bit ADIF is reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain this bit clear.
Interrupt flag bits get set when an interrupt condition occurs regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the
global enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>). User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to
enabling an interrupt.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 27
PIC16C9XX
4.2.2.6
PCON REGISTER
For various reset conditions see Table 14-4 and
Table 14-5.
The Power Control (PCON) register contains a flag bit
to allow differentiation between a Power-on Reset
(POR) to an external MCLR Reset or WDT Reset.
FIGURE 4-8: PCON REGISTER (ADDRESS 8Eh)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
POR
U-0
—
R
= Readable bit
W = Writable bit
bit7
bit0
U
= Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7-2: Unimplemented: Read as '0'
bit 1:
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit
1 = No Power-on Reset occurred
0 = A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs)
bit 0:
Unimplemented: Read as '0'
DS30444E - page 28
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
4.3
PCL and PCLATH
Note 1: There are no status bits to indicate stack
The program counter (PC) is 13-bits wide.The low byte
comes from the PCL register, which is a readable and
writable register. The upper bits (PC<12:8>) are not
readable, but are indirectly writable through the
PCLATH register. On any reset, the upper bits of the PC
will be cleared. Figure 4-9 shows the two situations for
the loading of the PC. The upper example in the figure
shows how the PC is loaded on a write to PCL
(PCLATH<4:0> → PCH). The lower example in the fig-
ure shows how the PC is loaded during a CALLor GOTO
instruction (PCLATH<4:3> → PCH).
overflow or stack underflow conditions.
Note 2: There are no instructions/mnemonics
called PUSH or POP. These are actions
that occur from the execution of the
CALL, RETURN, RETLW, and RETFIE
instructions, or the vectoring to an inter-
rupt address.
4.4
Program Memory Paging
PIC16C9XX devices are capable of addressing a con-
tinuous 8K word block of program memory. The CALL
and GOTOinstructions provide only 11 bits of address
to allow branching within any 2K program memory
page. When doing a CALL or GOTO instruction the
FIGURE 4-9: LOADING OF PC IN
DIFFERENT SITUATIONS
upper
2 bits of the address are provided by
PCH
PCL
PCLATH<4:3>. When doing a CALL or GOTO instruc-
tion, the user must ensure that the page select bits are
programmed so that the desired program memory
page is addressed. If a return from a CALLinstruction
(or interrupt) is executed, the entire 13-bit PC is pushed
onto the stack. Therefore, manipulation of the
PCLATH<4:3> bits are not required for the return
instructions (which POPs the address from the stack).
12
8
7
0
Instruction with
PCL as
Destination
PC
8
PCLATH<4:0>
PCLATH
5
ALU result
PCH
12 11 10
PCL
Note: The PIC16C9XX ignores paging bit
PCLATH<4>, which is used to access pro-
gram memory pages 2 and 3. The use of
8
7
0
GOTO, CALL
PC
PCLATH<4:3>
PCLATH
11
PCLATH<4> as
a
general purpose
2
Opcode <10:0>
read/write bit is not recommended since
this may affect upward compatibility with
future products.
4.3.1
COMPUTED GOTO
A computed GOTO is accomplished by adding an offset
to the program counter (ADDWF PCL). When doing a
table read using a computed GOTO method, care
should be exercised if the table location crosses a PCL
memory boundary (each 256 byte block). Refer to the
application note “Implementing a Table Read” (AN556).
4.3.2
STACK
The PIC16CXXX family has an 8 level deep x 13-bit
wide hardware stack. The stack space is not part of
either program or data space and the stack pointer is
not readable or writable. The PC is PUSHed onto the
stack when a CALLinstruction is executed or an inter-
rupt causes a branch. The stack is POPed in the event
of a RETURN, RETLW or a RETFIE instruction execu-
tion. PCLATH is not affected by a PUSH or POP oper-
ation.
The stack operates as a circular buffer.This means that
after the stack has been PUSHed eight times, the ninth
push overwrites the value that was stored from the first
push. The tenth push overwrites the second push (and
so on).
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 29
PIC16C9XX
Example 4-1 shows the calling of a subroutine in
page 1 of the program memory.This example assumes
that PCLATH is saved and restored by the interrupt ser-
vice routine (if interrupts are used).
4.5
Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR
Registers
The INDF register is not a physical register. Addressing
the INDF register will cause indirect addressing.
Indirect addressing is possible by using the INDF reg-
ister. Any instruction using the INDF register actually
accesses the register pointed to by the File Select Reg-
ister (FSR). Reading the INDF register itself indirectly
(FSR = '0') will produce 00h. Writing to the INDF regis-
ter indirectly results in a no-operation (although status
bits may be affected). An effective 9-bit address is
obtained by concatenating the 8-bit FSR register and
the IRP bit (STATUS<7>), as shown in Figure 4-10.
EXAMPLE 4-1: CALL OF A SUBROUTINE IN
PAGE 1 FROM PAGE 0
ORG 0x500
BSF
PCLATH,3 ;Select page 1 (800h-FFFh)
CALL
SUB1_P1
;Call subroutine in
;page 1 (800h-FFFh)
:
:
:
ORG 0x900
SUB1_P1:
;called subroutine
;page 1 (800h-FFFh)
A simple program to clear RAM locations 20h-2Fh
using indirect addressing is shown in Example 4-2.
:
:
RETURN
;return to Call subroutine
;in page 0 (000h-7FFh)
EXAMPLE 4-2: INDIRECT ADDRESSING
movlw 0x20
movwf FSR
;initialize pointer
;to RAM
NEXT
clrf
incf
INDF
;clear INDF register
FSR,F ;inc pointer
btfss FSR,4 ;all done?
goto
NEXT
;no clear next
CONTINUE
:
;yes continue
FIGURE 4-10: DIRECT/INDIRECT ADDRESSING
Direct Addressing
Indirect Addressing
from opcode
7
RP1:RP0
6
0
0
IRP
FSR register
bank select
00h
location select
bank select
location select
00
01
10
11
00h
Data
Memory
7Fh
7Fh
Bank 0
Bank 1 Bank 2
Bank 3
For memory map detail see Figure 4-2.
DS30444E - page 30
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 5-1: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF PINS
RA3:RA0 AND RA5
5.0
PORTS
Some pins for these ports are multiplexed with an alter-
nate function for the peripheral features on the device.
In general, when a peripheral is enabled, that pin may
not be used as a general purpose I/O pin.
Data
bus
D
Q
Q
VDD
P
WR
Port
5.1
PORTA and TRISA Register
CK
The RA4/T0CKI pin is a Schmitt Trigger input and an
open drain output. All other RA port pins have TTL input
levels and full CMOS output drivers. All RA pins have
data direction bits (TRISA register) which can configure
these pins as output or input.
Data Latch
I/O pin(1)
N
D
Q
WR
TRIS
VSS
Analog
Q
Setting a bit in the TRISA register puts the correspond-
ing output driver in a hi-impedance mode. Clearing a bit
in the TRISA register puts the contents of the output
latch on the selected pin.
CK
input
mode
TRIS Latch
Reading the PORTA register reads the status of the
pins whereas writing to it will write to the port latch. All
write operations are read-modify-write operations.
Therefore, a write to a port implies that the port pins are
read, this value is modified, and then written to the port
data latch.
TTL
input
buffer
RD TRIS
Q
D
EN
Pin RA4 is multiplexed with the Timer0 module clock
input to become the RA4/T0CKI pin.
RD PORT
For the PIC16C924 only, other PORTA pins are multi-
plexed with analog inputs and the analog VREF input.
The operation of each pin is selected by clearing/set-
ting the control bits in the ADCON1 register (A/D Con-
trol Register1).
To A/D Converter (PIC16C924 only)
Note 1: I/O pins have protection diodes to VDD and VSS.
Note: On a Power-on Reset, these pins are con-
figured as analog inputs and read as '0'.
FIGURE 5-2: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF
RA4/T0CKI PIN
The TRISA register controls the direction of the RA
pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs.
The user must ensure the bits in the TRISA register are
maintained set when using them as analog inputs.
Data
bus
D
Q
Q
WR
PORT
CK
I/O pin(1)
EXAMPLE 5-1: INITIALIZING PORTA
N
Data Latch
BCF
BCF
CLRF
BSF
STATUS, RP0 ; Select Bank0
STATUS, RP1
D
Q
VSS
WR
TRIS
PORTA
; Initialize PORTA
;
Schmitt
Trigger
input
STATUS, RP0
Q
CK
MOVLW 0xCF
; Value used to
; initialize data
; direction
TRIS Latch
buffer
MOVWF TRISA
; Set RA<3:0> as inputs
; RA<5:4> as outputs
; RA<7:6> are always
; read as '0'.
RD TRIS
Q
D
EN
RD PORT
TMR0 clock input
Note 1: I/O pin has protection diodes to VSS only.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 31
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 5-1: PORTA FUNCTIONS
Name
Bit#
Buffer Function
RA0/AN0(1)
RA1/AN1(1)
RA2/AN2(1)
RA3/AN3/VREF
RA4/T0CKI
bit0
bit1
bit2
bit3
bit4
TTL
TTL
TTL
TTL
ST
Input/output or analog input
Input/output or analog input
Input/output or analog input
Input/output or analog input or VREF
(1)
Input/output or external clock input for Timer0
Output is open drain type
RA5/AN4/SS (1) bit5
TTL
Input/output or analog input or slave select input for synchronous serial port
Legend: TTL = TTL input, ST = Schmitt Trigger input
Note 1: The AN and VREF functions are for the A/D module and are only implemented on the PIC16C924.
TABLE 5-2: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTA
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on
all other
resets
Address Name
Bit 7 Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
05h
85h
9Fh
PORTA
TRISA
—
—
—
—
—
—
RA5
RA4
RA3
RA2
RA1
RA0
(2)
(2)
PORTA Data Direction Control Register
--11 1111 --11 1111
(1)
ADCON1
—
—
—
PCFG2 PCFG1 PCFG0 ---- -000 ---- -000
Legend: x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented locations read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by PORTA.
Note 1: The ADCON1 register is implemented on the PIC16C924 only.
2: PIC16C923 reset values for PORTA: --xx xxxxfor a POR, and --uu uuuufor all other resets,
PIC16C924 reset values for PORTA: --0x 0000when read.
DS30444E - page 32
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
PORTB. The “mismatch” outputs of RB7:RB4 are
OR’ed together to generate the RB Port Change Inter-
rupt with flag bit RBIF (INTCON<0>).
5.2
PORTB and TRISB Register
PORTB is an 8-bit wide bi-directional port. The corre-
sponding data direction register is TRISB. Setting a bit
in the TRISB register puts the corresponding output
driver in a hi-impedance input mode. Clearing a bit in
the TRISB register puts the contents of the output latch
on the selected pin(s).
This interrupt can wake the device from SLEEP. The
user, in the interrupt service routine, can clear the inter-
rupt in the following manner:
a) Any read or write of PORTB. This will end the
mismatch condition.
EXAMPLE 5-2: INITIALIZING PORTB
b) Clear flag bit RBIF.
BCF
BCF
CLRF
BSF
STATUS, RP0 ; Select Bank0
STATUS, RP1
A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit RBIF.
Reading PORTB will end the mismatch condition, and
allow flag bit RBIF to be cleared.
PORTB
STATUS, RP0
; Initialize PORTB
;
MOVLW 0xCF
; Value used to
; initialize data
; direction
; Set RB<3:0> as inputs
; RB<5:4> as outputs
; RB<7:6> as inputs
This interrupt on mismatch feature, together with soft-
ware configurable pull-ups on these four pins allow
easy interface to a keypad and make it possible for
wake-up on key-depression. Refer to the Embedded
Control Handbook, "Implementing Wake-Up on Key
Stroke" (AN552).
MOVWF TRISB
Each of the PORTB pins has a weak internal pull-up. A
single control bit can turn on all the pull-ups. This is
performed by clearing bit RBPU (OPTION<7>). The
weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port
pin is configured as an output.The pull-ups are also dis-
abled on a Power-on Reset.
The interrupt on change feature is recommended for
wake-up on key depression operation and operations
where PORTB is only used for the interrupt on change
feature. Polling of PORTB is not recommended while
using the interrupt on change feature.
FIGURE 5-3: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF
FIGURE 5-4: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF
RB7:RB4 PINS
RB3:RB0 PINS
VDD
RBPU(2)
VDD
weak
P
RBPU(2)
pull-up
weak
pull-up
P
Data Latch
Data bus
D
Q
Data Latch
Data bus
D
Q
I/O
pin(1)
WR Port
CK
TRIS Latch
I/O
pin(1)
WR Port
CK
TRIS Latch
D
Q
TTL
Input
Buffer
D
Q
WR TRIS
CK
WR TRIS
TTL
CK
Input
Buffer
ST
Buffer
RD TRIS
RD Port
RD TRIS
RD Port
Q
D
Latch
Q
D
EN
EN
Q1
Set RBIF
RB0/INT
Schmitt Trigger
Buffer
RD Port
Q
D
From other
RD Port
Q3
RB7:RB4 pins
Note 1: I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS.
EN
2: To enable weak pull-ups, set the appropriate TRIS bit
and clear the RBPU bit (OPTION<7>).
RB7:RB6 in serial programming mode
Note 1: I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS.
Four of PORTB’s pins, RB7:RB4, have an interrupt on
change feature. Only pins configured as inputs can
cause this interrupt to occur (i.e. any RB7:RB4 pin con-
figured as an output is excluded from the interrupt on
change comparison). The input pins (of RB7:RB4) are
compared with the old value latched on the last read of
2: To enable weak pull-ups, set the appropriate TRIS bit
and clear the RBPU bit (OPTION<7>).
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 33
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 5-3: PORTB FUNCTIONS
Name
Bit#
bit0
Buffer
TTL/ST
Function
RB0/INT
Input/output pin or external interrupt input. Internal software
programmable weak pull-up. This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when
configured as the external interrupt.
RB1
RB2
RB3
RB4
bit1
bit2
bit3
bit4
TTL
TTL
TTL
TTL
Input/output pin. Internal software programmable weak pull-up.
Input/output pin. Internal software programmable weak pull-up.
Input/output pin. Internal software programmable weak pull-up.
Input/output pin (with interrupt on change). Internal software programmable
weak pull-up.
RB5
RB6
bit5
bit6
TTL
Input/output pin (with interrupt on change). Internal software programmable
weak pull-up.
TTL/ST
Input/output pin (with interrupt on change). Internal software programmable
weak pull-up. Serial programming clock. This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger
input when used in serial programming mode.
RB7
bit7
TTL/ST
Input/output pin (with interrupt on change). Internal software programmable
weak pull-up. Serial programming data.This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input
when used in serial programming mode.
Legend: TTL = TTL input, ST = Schmitt Trigger input
TABLE 5-4: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTB
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
06h, 106h PORTB
86h, 186h TRISB
RB7
RB6
RB5
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
RB0
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
PORTB Data Direction Control Register
T0SE
81h, 181h OPTION RBPU INTEDG T0CS
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
Legend: x= unknown, u= unchanged. Shaded cells are not used by PORTB.
DS30444E - page 34
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
5.3
PORTC and TRISC Register
FIGURE 5-5: PORTC BLOCK DIAGRAM
(PERIPHERAL OUTPUT
PORTC is an 6-bit bi-directional port. Each pin is indi-
vidually configurable as an input or output through the
TRISC register. PORTC is multiplexed with several
peripheral functions (Table 5-5). PORTC pins have
Schmitt Trigger input buffers.
OVERRIDE)
VDD
RBPU(2)
weak
pull-up
P
Data Latch
Data bus
When enabling peripheral functions, care should be
taken in defining TRIS bits for each PORTC pin. Some
peripherals override the TRIS bit to make a pin an out-
put, while other peripherals override the TRIS bit to
make a pin an input. Since the TRIS bit override is in
effect while the peripheral is enabled, read-mod-
ify-write instructions (BSF, BCF, XORWF) with TRISC
as destination should be avoided.The user should refer
to the corresponding peripheral section for the correct
TRIS bit settings.
D
Q
I/O
pin(1)
WR Port
CK
TRIS Latch
D
Q
TTL
Input
Buffer
WR TRIS
CK
RD TRIS
RD Port
Q
D
EXAMPLE 5-3: INITIALIZING PORTC
EN
BCF
BCF
CLRF
BSF
STATUS,RP0 ; Select Bank0
STATUS,RP1
PORTC
; Initialize PORTC
RB0/INT
STATUS,RP0 ;
Schmitt Trigger
Buffer
RD Port
MOVLW 0xCF
; Value used to
; initialize data
; direction
; Set RC<3:0> as inputs
; RC<5:4> as outputs
; RC<7:6> always read 0
Note 1: I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS.
2: To enable weak pull-ups, set the appropriate TRIS bit(s)
and clear the RBPU bit (OPTION<7>).
MOVWF TRISC
TABLE 5-5: PORTC FUNCTIONS
Name
Bit# Buffer Type
Function
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
RC1/T1OSI
bit0
bit1
bit2
bit3
ST
ST
ST
ST
Input/output port pin or Timer1 oscillator output or Timer1 clock input
Input/output port pin or Timer1 oscillator input
RC2/CCP1
Input/output port pin or Capture input/Compare output/PWM output
Input/output port pin or the synchronous serial clock for both SPI and
RC3/SCK/SCL
2
I C modes.
2
RC4/SDI/SDA
bit4
ST
ST
Input/output port pin or the SPI Data In (SPI mode) or data I/O (I C
mode).
RC5/SDO
bit5
Input/output port pin or Synchronous Serial Port data out
Legend: ST = Schmitt Trigger input
TABLE 5-6: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTC
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
07h
87h
PORTC
TRISC
—
—
—
—
RC5
RC4
RC3
RC2
RC1
RC0
--xx xxxx --uu uuuu
--11 1111 --11 1111
PORTC Data Direction Control Register
Legend: x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented, read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by PORTC.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 35
PIC16C9XX
5.4
PORTD and TRISD Registers
FIGURE 5-6: PORTD<4:0> BLOCK
DIAGRAM
PORTD is an 8-bit port with Schmitt Trigger input buff-
ers. The first five pins are configurable as general pur-
pose I/O pins or LCD segment drivers. Pins RD5, RD6
and RD7 can be digital inputs or LCD segment or com-
mon drivers.
LCD
Segment Data
LCD Segment
Output Enable
TRISD controls the direction of pins RD0 through RD4
when PORTD is configured as a digital port.
Data Bus
D
Q
Note: On a Power-on Reset these pins are con-
WR
I/O pin
figured as LCD segment drivers.
PORT
CK
Data Latch
Note: To configure the pins as a digital port, the
corresponding bits in the LCDSE register
must be cleared. Any bit set in the LCDSE
register overrides any bit settings in the
corresponding TRIS register.
D
Q
WR
TRIS
CK
Schmitt
Trigger
input
TRIS Latch
EXAMPLE 5-4: INITIALIZING PORTD
buffer
RD TRIS
BCF
BSF
BCF
BCF
BSF
BCF
STATUS,RP0
STATUS,RP1
LCDSE,SE29
LCDSE,SE0
STATUS,RP0
STATUS,RP1
;Select Bank2
;
;Make RD<7:5> digital
;Make RD<4:0> digital
;Select Bank1
;
LCDSE<n>
Q
D
MOVLW 0x07
MOVWF TRISD
;Make RD<4:0> outputs
;Make RD<7:5> inputs
EN
RD
PORT
DS30444E - page 36
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 5-7: PORTD<7:5> BLOCK
DIAGRAM
LCD
Segment Data
LCD Segment
Output Enable
LCD
Common Data
LCD Common
Output Enable
Digital Input/
LCD Output pin
LCDSE<n>
Schmitt
Trigger
input
buffer
Data Bus
Q
D
EN
RD PORT
RD TRIS
VDD
TABLE 5-7: PORTD FUNCTIONS
Buffer
Name
Bit#
Function
Type
RD0/SEG00
bit0
bit1
bit2
bit3
bit4
bit5
bit6
bit7
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
Input/output port pin or Segment Driver00
Input/output port pin or Segment Driver01
Input/output port pin or Segment Driver02
Input/output port pin or Segment Driver03
Input/output port pin or Segment Driver04
RD1/SEG01
RD2/SEG02
RD3/SEG03
RD4/SEG04
RD5/SEG29/COM3
RD6/SEG30/COM2
RD7/SEG31/COM1
Digital input pin or Segment Driver29 or Common Driver3
Digital input pin or Segment Driver30 or Common Driver2
Digital input pin or Segment Driver31 or Common Driver1
Legend: ST = Schmitt Trigger input
TABLE 5-8: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTD
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
08h
PORTD
TRISD
LCDSE
RD7
RD6
RD5
RD4
RD3
RD2
RD1
RD0
0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
88h
PORTD Data Direction Control Register
SE29 SE27 SE20 SE16
10Dh
SE12
SE9
SE5
SE0
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by PORTD.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 37
PIC16C9XX
5.5
PORTE and TRISE Register
FIGURE 5-8: PORTE BLOCK DIAGRAM
PORTE is an digital input only port. Each pin is multi-
plexed with an LCD segment driver. These pins have
Schmitt Trigger input buffers.
LCD
Segment Data
LCD Segment
Output Enable
Note 1: On a Power-on Reset these pins are con-
LCD
Common Data
figured as LCD segment drivers.
Note 2: To configure the pins as a digital port, the
corresponding bits in the LCDSE register
must be cleared. Any bit set in the LCDSE
register overrides any bit settings in the
corresponding TRIS register.
LCD Common
Output Enable
Digital Input/
LCD Output pin
LCDSE<n>
EXAMPLE 5-5: INITIALIZING PORTE
Schmitt
Trigger
input
BCF STATUS,RP0
BSF STATUS,RP1
BCF LCDSE,SE27
BCF LCDSE,SE5
BCF LCDSE,SE9
;Select Bank2
;
;Make all PORTE
;and PORTG<7>
;digital inputs
buffer
Data Bus
Q
D
EN
RD PORT
RD TRIS
VDD
TABLE 5-9: PORTE FUNCTIONS
Name
Bit#
Buffer Type
Function
RE0/SEG05
RE1/SEG06
RE2/SEG07
RE3/SEG08
RE4/SEG09
RE5/SEG10
RE6/SEG11
RE7/SEG27
bit0
bit1
bit2
bit3
bit4
bit5
bit6
bit7
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
Digital input or Segment Driver05
Digital input or Segment Driver06
Digital input or Segment Driver07
Digital input or Segment Driver08
Digital input or Segment Driver09
Digital input or Segment Driver10
Digital input or Segment Driver11
Digital input or Segment Driver27 (not available on 64-pin devices)
Legend: ST = Schmitt Trigger input
TABLE 5-10: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTE
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
09h
PORTE
TRISE
LCDSE
RE7
RE6
RE5
RE4
RE3
RE2
RE1
RE0
0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
89h
PORTE Data Direction Control Register
SE29 SE27 SE20 SE16
10Dh
SE12
SE9
SE5
SE0
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by PORTE.
DS30444E - page 38
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
5.6
PORTF and TRISF Register
FIGURE 5-9: PORTF BLOCK DIAGRAM
PORTF is an digital input only port. Each pin is multi-
plexed with an LCD segment driver. These pins have
Schmitt Trigger input buffers.
LCD
Segment Data
LCD Segment
Output Enable
Note 1: On a Power-on Reset these pins are con-
figured as LCD segment drivers.
LCD
Common Data
Note 2: To configure the pins as a digital port, the
corresponding bits in the LCDSE register
must be cleared. Any bit set in the LCDSE
register overrides any bit settings in the
corresponding TRIS register.
LCD Common
Output Enable
Digital Input/
LCD Output pin
LCDSE<n>
EXAMPLE 5-6: INITIALIZING PORTF
Schmitt
Trigger
input
BCF STATUS,RP0
BSF STATUS,RP1
BCF LCDSE,SE16
BCF LCDSE,SE12
;Select Bank2
;
;Make all PORTF
;digital inputs
buffer
Data Bus
Q
D
EN
RD PORT
RD TRIS
VDD
TABLE 5-11: PORTF FUNCTIONS
Name
Bit#
Buffer Type
Function
RF0/SEG12
RF1/SEG13
RF2/SEG14
RF3/SEG15
RF4/SEG16
RF5/SEG17
RF6/SEG18
RF7/SEG19
bit0
bit1
bit2
bit3
bit4
bit5
bit6
bit7
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
Digital input or Segment Driver12
Digital input or Segment Driver13
Digital input or Segment Driver14
Digital input or Segment Driver15
Digital input or Segment Driver16
Digital input or Segment Driver17
Digital input or Segment Driver18
Digital input or Segment Driver19
Legend: ST = Schmitt Trigger input
TABLE 5-12: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTF
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
107h
187h
10Dh
PORTF
TRISF
RF7
RF6
RF5
RF4
RF3
RF2
RF1
RF0
0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
PORTF Data Direction Control Register
SE29 SE27 SE20 SE16
LCDSE
SE12
SE9
SE5
SE0
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by PORTF.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 39
PIC16C9XX
5.7
PORTG and TRISG Register
FIGURE 5-10: PORTG BLOCK DIAGRAM
PORTG is an digital input only port. Each pin is multi-
plexed with an LCD segment driver. These pins have
Schmitt Trigger input buffers.
LCD
Segment Data
LCD Segment
Output Enable
Note 1: On a Power-on Reset these pins are con-
figured as LCD segment drivers.
LCD
Common Data
Note 2: To configure the pins as a digital port, the
corresponding bits in the LCDSE register
must be cleared. Any bit set in the LCDSE
register overrides any bit settings in the
corresponding TRIS register.
LCD Common
Output Enable
Digital Input/
LCD Output pin
LCDSE<n>
EXAMPLE 5-7: INITIALIZING PORTG
Schmitt
Trigger
input
BCF STATUS,RP0
BSF STATUS,RP1
BCF LCDSE,SE27
BCF LCDSE,SE20
;Select Bank2
;
;Make all PORTG
;and PORTE<7>
;digital inputs
buffer
Data Bus
Q
D
EN
RD PORT
RD TRIS
VDD
TABLE 5-13: PORTG FUNCTIONS
Name
Bit#
Buffer Type
Function
RG0/SEG20
RG1/SEG21
RG2/SEG22
RG3/SEG23
RG4/SEG24
RG5/SEG25
RG6/SEG26
RG7/SEG28
bit0
bit1
bit2
bit3
bit4
bit5
bit6
bit7
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
Digital input or Segment Driver20
Digital input or Segment Driver21
Digital input or Segment Driver22
Digital input or Segment Driver23
Digital input or Segment Driver24
Digital input or Segment Driver25
Digital input or Segment Driver26
Digital input or Segment Driver28 (not available on 64-pin devices)
Legend: ST = Schmitt Trigger input
TABLE 5-14: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTG
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
108h
188h
10Dh
PORTG
TRISG
LCDSE
RG7
RG6
RG5
RG4
RG3
RG2
RG1
RG0
0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
PORTG Data Direction Control Register
SE29 SE27 SE20 SE16
SE12
SE9
SE5
SE0
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by PORTG.
DS30444E - page 40
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
5.8
I/O Programming Considerations
EXAMPLE 5-8: READ-MODIFY-WRITE
INSTRUCTIONS ON AN I/O
PORT
5.8.1
BI-DIRECTIONAL I/O PORTS
;Initial PORT settings: PORTB<7:4> Inputs
Any instruction which writes, operates internally as a
read followed by a write operation. The BCF and BSF
instructions, for example, read the register into the
CPU, execute the bit operation and write the result back
to the register. Caution must be used when these
instructions are applied to a port with both inputs and
outputs defined. For example, a BSFoperation on bit5
of PORTB will cause all eight bits of PORTB to be read
into the CPU. Then the BSF operation takes place on
bit5 and PORTB is written to the output latches. If
another bit of PORTB is used as a bi-directional I/O pin
(e.g., bit0) and it is defined as an input at this time, the
input signal present on the pin itself would be read into
the CPU and rewritten to the data latch of this particular
pin, overwriting the previous content. As long as the pin
stays in the input mode, no problem occurs. However, if
bit0 is switched into output mode later on, the contents
of the data latch may now be unknown.
;
PORTB<3:0> Outputs
;PORTB<7:6> have external pull-ups and are
;not connected to other circuitry
;
;
;
PORT latch PORT pins
---------- ---------
BCF PORTB, 7
BCF PORTB, 6
BCF STATUS, RP1 ;
BSF STATUS, RP0 ;
BCF TRISB, 7
BCF TRISB, 6
; 01pp pppp
; 10pp pppp
11pp pppp
11pp pppp
; 10pp pppp
; 10pp pppp
11pp pppp
10pp pppp
;
;Note that the user may have expected the
;pin values to be 00pp ppp. The 2nd BCF
;caused RB7 to be latched as the pin value
;(high).
A pin actively outputting a Low or High should not be
driven from external devices at the same time in order
to change the level on this pin (“wired-or”, “wired-and”).
The resulting high output currents may damage the
chip.
Reading the port register, reads the values of the port
pins. Writing to the port register writes the value to the
port latch. When using read-modify-write instructions
(ex. BCF, BSF) on a port, the value of the port pins is
read, the desired operation is done to this value, and
this value is then written to the port latch.
5.8.2
SUCCESSIVE OPERATIONS ON I/O PORTS
The actual write to an I/O port happens at the end of an
instruction cycle, whereas for reading, the data must be
valid at the beginning of the instruction cycle
(Figure 5-11). Therefore, care must be exercised if a
write followed by a read operation is carried out on the
same I/O port. The sequence of instructions should be
such to allow the pin voltage to stabilize (load depen-
dent) before the next instruction which causes that file
to be read into the CPU is executed. Otherwise, the
previous state of that pin may be read into the CPU
rather than the new state. When in doubt, it is better to
separate these instructions with a NOP or another
instruction not accessing this I/O port.
Example 5-8 shows the effect of two sequential
read-modify-write instructions on an I/O port.
FIGURE 5-11: SUCCESSIVE I/O OPERATION
Q4
Q4
Q4
Q1 Q2
Q4
Q3
Q3
Q3
Q3
Q1 Q2
PC
Q1 Q2
Q1 Q2
Note:
This example shows a write to PORTB
followed by a read from PORTB.
PC + 3
NOP
PC
Instruction
fetched
PC + 1
PC + 2
NOP
MOVWF PORTB MOVF PORTB,W
write to
PORTB
Note that:
data setup time = (0.25TCY - TPD)
RB7:RB0
where TCY = instruction cycle
TPD = propagation delay
Port pin
sampled here
TPD
Therefore, at higher clock frequencies,
a write followed by a read may be prob-
lematic.
Instruction
executed
NOP
MOVWF PORTB
write to
MOVF PORTB,W
PORTB
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 41
PIC16C9XX
NOTES:
DS30444E - page 42
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
chronous Serial Port (SSP). The prescaler option
allows Timer2 to increment at the following rates: 1:1,
1:4, 1:16.
6.0
OVERVIEW OF TIMER
MODULES
Each module can generate an interrupt to indicate that
an event has occurred (e.g. timer overflow). Each of
these modules is explained in full detail in the following
sections. The timer modules are:
The postscaler allows the TMR2 register to match the
period register (PR2) a programmable number of times
before generating an interrupt. The postscaler can be
programmed from 1:1 to 1:16 (inclusive).
• Timer0 Module (Section 7.0)
• Timer1 Module (Section 8.0)
• Timer2 Module (Section 9.0)
6.4
CCP Overview
The CCP module can operate in one of these three
modes: 16-bit capture, 16-bit compare, or up to 10-bit
Pulse Width Modulation (PWM).
6.1
Timer0 Overview
The Timer0 module is a simple 8-bit timer/counter. The
clock source can be either the internal system clock
(Fosc/4) or an external clock. When the clock source is
an external clock, the Timer0 module can be selected
to increment on either the rising or falling edge.
Capture mode captures the 16-bit value of TMR1 into
the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair. The capture event
can be programmed for either the falling edge, rising
edge, fourth rising edge, or the sixteenth rising edge of
the CCP1 pin.
TheTimer0 module also has a programmable prescaler
option. This prescaler can be assigned to either the
Timer0 module or the Watchdog Timer. Bit PSA
(OPTION<3>) assigns the prescaler, and bits PS2:PS0
(OPTION<2:0>) determine the prescaler value. Timer0
can increment at the following rates: 1:1 when pres-
caler assigned to Watchdog timer, 1:2, 1:4, 1:8, 1:16,
1:32, 1:64, 1:128, and 1:256.
Compare mode compares the TMR1H:TMR1L register
pair to the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair. When a
match occurs an interrupt can be generated, and the
output pin CCP1 can be forced to given state (High or
Low), TMR1 can be reset and start A/D conversion.
This depends on the control bits CCP1M3:CCP1M0.
PWM mode compares the TMR2 register to a 10-bit
duty cycle register (CCPR1H:CCPR1L<5:4>) as well
as to an 8-bit period register (PR2). When the TMR2
register = Duty Cycle register, the CCP1 pin will be
forced low.WhenTMR2 = PR2, TMR2 is cleared to 00h,
an interrupt can be generated, and the CCP1 pin (if an
output) will be forced high.
Synchronization of the external clock occurs after the
prescaler. When the prescaler is used, the external
clock frequency may be higher then the device’s fre-
quency. The maximum frequency is 50 MHz, given the
high and low time requirements of the clock.
6.2
Timer1 Overview
Timer1 is a 16-bit timer/counter. The clock source can
be either the internal system clock (Fosc/4), an external
clock, or an external crystal. Timer1 can operate as
either a timer or a counter.When operating as a counter
(external clock source), the counter can either operate
synchronized to the device or asynchronously to the
device. Asynchronous operation allows Timer1 to oper-
ate during sleep, which is useful for applications that
require a real-time clock as well as the power savings
of SLEEP mode.
Timer1 also has a prescaler option which allowsTimer1
to increment at the following rates: 1:1, 1:2, 1:4, and
1:8. Timer1 can be used in conjunction with the Cap-
ture/Compare/PWM module. When used with a CCP
module, Timer1 is the time-base for 16-bit capture or
the 16-bit compare and must be synchronized to the
device. Timer1 oscillator is also one of the clock
sources for the LCD module.
6.3
Timer2 Overview
Timer2 is an 8-bit timer with a programmable prescaler
and postscaler, as well as an 8-bit period register
(PR2). Timer2 can be used with the CCP1 module (in
PWM mode) as well as the clock source for the Syn-
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 43
PIC16C9XX
NOTES:
DS30444E - page 44
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
bit T0SE selects the rising edge. Restrictions on the
external clock input are discussed in detail in
Section 7.2.
7.0
TIMER0 MODULE
The Timer0 module has the following features:
• 8-bit timer/counter
The prescaler is mutually exclusively shared between
the Timer0 module and the Watchdog Timer. The pres-
caler assignment is controlled in software by control bit
PSA (OPTION<3>). Clearing bit PSA will assign the
prescaler to the Timer0 module. The prescaler is not
readable or writable.When the prescaler is assigned to
the Timer0 module, prescale values of 1:2, 1:4, ...,
1:256 are selectable. Section 7.3 details the operation
of the prescaler.
• Readable and writable
• 8-bit software programmable prescaler
• Internal or external clock select
• Interrupt on overflow from FFh to 00h
• Edge select for external clock
Figure 7-1 is a simplified block diagram of the Timer0
module.
Timer mode is selected by clearing bit T0CS
(OPTION<5>). In timer mode, the Timer0 module will
increment every instruction cycle (without prescaler). If
the TMR0 register is written, the increment is inhibited
for the following two instruction cycles (Figure 7-2 and
Figure 7-3). The user can work around this by writing
an adjusted value to the TMR0 register.
7.1
Timer0 Interrupt
The TMR0 interrupt is generated when the TMR0 reg-
ister overflows from FFh to 00h. This overflow sets bit
T0IF (INTCON<2>). The interrupt can be masked by
clearing bit T0IE (INTCON<5>). Bit T0IF must be
cleared in software by the Timer0 module interrupt ser-
vice routine before re-enabling this interrupt.The TMR0
interrupt cannot awaken the processor from SLEEP
since the timer is shut off during SLEEP. Figure 7-4 dis-
plays the Timer0 interrupt timing.
Counter mode is selected by setting bit T0CS
(OPTION<5>). In counter mode Timer0 will increment
either on every rising or falling edge of pin RA4/T0CKI.
The incrementing edge is determined by the Timer0
Source Edge Select bit T0SE (OPTION<4>). Clearing
FIGURE 7-1: TIMER0 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data bus
FOSC/4
0
1
PSout
8
1
0
Sync with
Internal
clocks
TMR0
Programmable
Prescaler
RA4/T0CKI
pin
PSout
(2 cycle delay)
T0SE
3
Set interrupt
flag bit T0IF
on overflow
PS2, PS1, PS0
PSA
T0CS
Note 1: T0CS, T0SE, PSA, PS2:PS0 (OPTION<5:0>).
2: The prescaler is shared with Watchdog Timer (refer to Figure 7-6 for detailed block diagram).
FIGURE 7-2: TIMER0 TIMING: INTERNAL CLOCK/NO PRESCALE
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
PC
(Program
Counter)
PC-1
PC
PC+1
PC+2
PC+3
PC+4
PC+5
PC+6
Instruction
Fetch
MOVF TMR0,W MOVF TMR0,W MOVF TMR0,W MOVF TMR0,W MOVF TMR0,W
MOVWF TMR0
T0
T0+1
T0+2
NT0
NT0
NT0
NT0+1
NT0+2
TMR0
Instruction
Executed
Read TMR0
reads NT0 + 1
Read TMR0
reads NT0
Read TMR0
reads NT0
Read TMR0
reads NT0
Read TMR0
reads NT0 + 2
Write TMR0
executed
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 45
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 7-3: TIMER0 TIMING: INTERNAL CLOCK/PRESCALE 1:2
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
PC
(Program
Counter)
PC-1
PC
PC+1
PC+2
PC+3
PC+4
PC+5
PC+6
MOVF TMR0,W MOVF TMR0,W MOVF TMR0,W MOVF TMR0,W MOVF TMR0,W
MOVWF TMR0
Instruction
Fetch
T0
T0+1
NT0+1
6
NT0
TMR0
Instruction
Execute
Read TMR0
reads NT0
Read TMR0
reads NT0
Read TMR0
reads NT0
Read TMR0
reads NT0
Read TMR0
reads NT0 + 1
Write TMR0
executed
FIGURE 7-4: TIMER0 INTERRUPT TIMING
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
OSC1
CLKOUT(3)
Timer0
FEh
FFh
00h
01h
02h
1
1
T0IF bit
(INTCON<2>)
GIE bit
(INTCON<7>)
INSTRUCTION
FLOW
PC
PC
PC +1
PC +1
0004h
0005h
Instruction
fetched
Inst (PC)
Inst (PC+1)
Inst (0004h)
Inst (0005h)
Instruction
executed
Inst (PC-1)
Dummy cycle
Dummy cycle
Inst (0004h)
Inst (PC)
Note 1: Interrupt flag bit T0IF is sampled here (every Q1).
2: Interrupt latency = 4TCY where TCY = instruction cycle time.
3: CLKOUT is available only in RC oscillator mode.
DS30444E - page 46
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
caler so that the prescaler output is symmetrical. For
the external clock to meet the sampling requirement,
the ripple-counter must be taken into account. There-
fore, it is necessary for T0CKI to have a period of at
least 4Tosc (and a small RC delay of 40 ns) divided by
the prescaler value. The only requirement on T0CKI
high and low time is that they do not violate the mini-
mum pulse width requirement of 10 ns. Refer to param-
eters 40, 41 and 42 in the electrical specification of the
desired device.
7.2
Using Timer0 with an External Clock
When an external clock input is used for Timer0, it must
meet certain requirements. The requirements ensure
the external clock can be synchronized with the internal
phase clock (TOSC). Also, there is a delay in the actual
incrementing of Timer0 after synchronization.
7.2.1
EXTERNAL CLOCK SYNCHRONIZATION
When no prescaler is used, the external clock input is
the same as the prescaler output. The synchronization
of T0CKI with the internal phase clocks is accom-
plished by sampling the prescaler output on the Q2 and
Q4 cycles of the internal phase clocks (Figure 7-5).
Therefore, it is necessary for T0CKI to be high for at
least 2Tosc (and a small RC delay of 20 ns) and low for
at least 2Tosc (and a small RC delay of 20 ns). Refer to
the electrical specification of the desired device.
7.2.2
TMR0 INCREMENT DELAY
Since the prescaler output is synchronized with the
internal clocks, there is a small delay from the time the
external clock edge occurs to the time the Timer0 mod-
ule is actually incremented. Figure 7-5 shows the delay
from the external clock edge to the timer incrementing.
When a prescaler is used, the external clock input is
divided by the asynchronous ripple-counter type pres-
FIGURE 7-5: TIMER0 TIMING WITH EXTERNAL CLOCK
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Small pulse
misses sampling
External Clock Input or
(2)
Prescaler output
(1)
(3)
External Clock/Prescaler
Output after sampling
Increment Timer0 (Q4)
Timer0
T0
T0 + 1
T0 + 2
Note 1: Delay from clock input change to Timer0 increment is 3Tosc to 7Tosc. (Duration of Q = Tosc).
Therefore, the error in measuring the interval between two edges on Timer0 input = ±4Tosc max.
2: External clock if no prescaler selected, Prescaler output otherwise.
3: The arrows indicate the points in time where sampling occurs.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 47
PIC16C9XX
When assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions
writing to the TMR0 register (e.g. CLRF 1, MOVWF 1,
BSF 1,x....etc.) will clear the prescaler count. When
assigned to WDT, a CLRWDT instruction will clear the
prescaler count along with the Watchdog Timer. The
prescaler is not readable or writable.
7.3
Prescaler
An 8-bit counter is available as a prescaler for the
Timer0 module, or as a postscaler for the Watchdog
Timer (Figure 7-6). For simplicity, this counter is being
referred to as “prescaler” throughout this data sheet.
Note that the prescaler may be used by either the
Timer0 module or the WDT but not both. Thus, a pres-
caler assignment for the Timer0 module means that
there is no prescaler for the Watchdog Timer, and
vice-versa.
Note: Writing to TMR0 when the prescaler is
assigned to Timer0 will clear the prescaler
count, but will not change the prescaler
assignment.
The PSA and PS2:PS0 bits (OPTION<3:0>) determine
the prescaler assignment and prescale ratio.
FIGURE 7-6: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE TIMER0/WDT PRESCALER
Data Bus
8
CLKOUT (=Fosc/4)
M
U
X
1
0
0
1
M
U
X
RA4/T0CKI
pin
SYNC
2
Cycles
TMR0 reg
T0SE
T0CS
Set flag bit T0IF
on Overflow
PSA
0
1
8-bit Prescaler
M
U
X
Watchdog
Timer
8
8 - to - 1MUX
PS2:PS0
PSA
1
0
WDT Enable bit
M U X
PSA
WDT
Time-out
Note: T0CS, T0SE, PSA, PS2:PS0 are (OPTION<5:0>).
DS30444E - page 48
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
7.3.1
SWITCHING PRESCALER ASSIGNMENT
Note: To avoid an unintended device RESET, the
following instruction sequence (shown in
Example 7-1) must be executed when
changing the prescaler assignment from
Timer0 to the WDT. This precaution must
be followed even if the WDT is disabled.
The prescaler assignment is fully under software con-
trol, i.e., it can be changed “on the fly” during program
execution.
EXAMPLE 7-1: CHANGING PRESCALER (TIMER0→WDT)
1) BSF
STATUS, RP0
;Select Bank1
2) MOVLW b'xx0x0xxx'
3) MOVWF OPTION_REG
;Select clock source and prescale value of
Lines 2 and 3 do NOT have to
be included if the final desired
prescale value is other than 1:1.
If 1:1 is final desired value, then
a temporary prescale value is
set in lines 2 and 3 and the final
prescale value will be set in lines
10 and 11.
;other than 1:1
4) BCF
5) CLRF
6) BSF
STATUS, RP0
TMR0
;Select Bank0
;Clear TMR0 and prescaler
STATUS, RP1
;Select Bank1
7) MOVLW b'xxxx1xxx'
8) MOVWF OPTION_REG
9) CLRWDT
;Select WDT, do not change prescale value
;
;Clears WDT and prescaler
10) MOVLW b'xxxx1xxx'
11) MOVWF OPTION_REG
;Select new prescale value and WDT
;
12) BCF
STATUS, RP0
;Select Bank0
To change prescaler from the WDT to the Timer0 mod-
ule use the precaution shown in Example 7-2.
EXAMPLE 7-2: CHANGING PRESCALER (WDT→TIMER0)
CLRWDT
BSF
;Clear WDT and prescaler
STATUS, RP0 ;Select Bank1
MOVLW
MOVWF
BCF
b'xxxx0xxx' ;Select TMR0, new prescale value and
OPTION_REG ;clock source
STATUS, RP0 ;Select Bank0
TABLE 7-1: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER0
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
01h, 101h
TMR0
Timer0 module’s register
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
RBIF 0000 000x 0000 000u
0Bh, 8Bh,
10Bh, 18Bh
INTCON GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
T0SE
RBIE
PSA
T0IF
PS2
INTF
PS1
81h, 181h
85h
OPTION RBPU INTEDG
TRISA
T0CS
PS0
1111 1111 1111 1111
--11 1111 --11 1111
—
—
PORTA Data Direction Control Register
Legend: x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented locations read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by Timer0.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 49
PIC16C9XX
NOTES:
DS30444E - page 50
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
Timer1 can be turned on and off using the control bit
TMR1ON (T1CON<0>).
8.0
TIMER1 MODULE
Timer1 is a 16-bit timer/counter consisting of two 8-bit
registers (TMR1H and TMR1L) which are readable and
writable. The TMR1 Register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L)
increments from 0000h to FFFFh and rolls over to
0000h.The TMR1 Interrupt, if enabled, is generated on
overflow which is latched in interrupt flag bit TMR1IF
(PIR1<0>). This interrupt can be enabled/disabled by
setting/clearing TMR1 interrupt enable bit TMR1IE
(PIE1<0>).
Timer1 also has an internal “reset input”.This reset can
be generated by the CCP module (Section 10.0).
Figure 8-1 shows the Timer1 control register.
When the Timer1 oscillator is enabled (T1OSCEN is
set), the RC1/T1OSI and RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI pins
become inputs.
Timer1 can operate in one of two modes:
• As a timer
• As a counter
The operating mode is determined by the clock select
bit, TMR1CS (T1CON<1>).
In timer mode, Timer1 increments every instruction
cycle. In counter mode, it increments on every rising
edge of the external clock input.
FIGURE 8-1: T1CON:TIMER1 CONTROL REGISTER (ADDRESS 10h)
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON
bit0
R
= Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U
bit7
= Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7-6: Unimplemented: Read as '0'
bit 5-4: T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits
11= 1:8 Prescale value
10= 1:4 Prescale value
01= 1:2 Prescale value
00= 1:1 Prescale value
bit 3:
bit 2:
T1OSCEN: Timer1 Oscillator Enable Control bit
1 = Oscillator is enabled
0 = Oscillator is shut off
Note: The oscillator inverter and feedback resistor are turned off to eliminate power drain
T1SYNC: Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Control bit
TMR1CS = 1
1 = Do not synchronize external clock input
0 = Synchronize external clock input
TMR1CS = 0
This bit is ignored. Timer1 uses the internal clock when TMR1CS = 0.
bit 1:
bit 0:
TMR1CS: Timer1 Clock Source Select bit
1 = External clock from pin T1CKI (on the rising edge)
0 = Internal clock (Fosc/4)
TMR1ON: Timer1 On bit
1 = Enables Timer1
0 = Stops Timer1
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 51
PIC16C9XX
8.2.1
EXTERNAL CLOCK INPUT TIMING FOR
SYNCHRONIZED COUNTER MODE
8.1
Timer1 Operation in Timer Mode
Timer mode is selected by clearing the TMR1CS
(T1CON<1>) bit. In this mode, the input clock to the
timer is Fosc/4. The synchronize control bit T1SYNC
(T1CON<2>) has no effect since the internal clock is
always in sync.
When an external clock input is used for Timer1 in syn-
chronized counter mode, it must meet certain require-
ments. The external clock requirement is due to
internal phase clock (Tosc) synchronization. Also, there
is a delay in the actual incrementing of TMR1 after syn-
chronization.
8.2
Timer1 Operation in Synchronized
Counter Mode
When the prescaler is 1:1, the external clock input is
the same as the prescaler output. The synchronization
of T1CKI with the internal phase clocks is accom-
plished by sampling the prescaler output on the Q2 and
Q4 cycles of the internal phase clocks. Therefore, it is
necessary for T1CKI to be high for at least 2Tosc (and
a small RC delay of 20 ns) and low for at least 2Tosc
(and a small RC delay of 20 ns). Refer to the appropri-
ate electrical specifications, parameters 45, 46, and 47.
Counter mode is selected by setting bit TMR1CS. In
this mode the timer increments on every rising edge of
clock input on pin RC1/T1OSI when bit T1OSCEN is
set or pin RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI when bit T1OSCEN is
cleared.
If T1SYNC is cleared, then the external clock input is
synchronized with internal phase clocks. The synchro-
nization is done after the prescaler stage. The pres-
caler is an asynchronous ripple-counter.
When a prescaler other than 1:1 is used, the external
clock input is divided by the asynchronous rip-
ple-counter type prescaler so that the prescaler output
is symmetrical. In order for the external clock to meet
the sampling requirement, the ripple-counter must be
taken into account.Therefore, it is necessary for T1CKI
to have a period of at least 4Tosc (and a small RC delay
of 40 ns) divided by the prescaler value. The only
requirement on T1CKI high and low time is that they do
not violate the minimum pulse width requirements of
10 ns). Refer to the appropriate electrical specifica-
tions, parameters 40, 42, 45, 46, and 47.
In this configuration, during SLEEP mode, Timer1 will
not increment even if the external clock is present,
since the synchronization circuit is shut off. The pres-
caler however will continue to increment.
FIGURE 8-2: TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Set flag bit
TMR1IF on
Overflow
Synchronized
0
TMR1
clock input
TMR1L
TMR1H
T1OSC
1
TMR1ON
on/off
T1SYNC
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
RC1/T1OSI
1
Synchronize
det
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
T1OSCEN
Enable
Oscillator
Fosc/4
Internal
0
(1)
Clock
2
SLEEP input
T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0
TMR1CS
Note 1: When the T1OSCEN bit is cleared, the inverter and feedback resistor are turned off. This eliminates power drain.
DS30444E - page 52
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
8.3
Timer1 Operation in Asynchronous
Counter Mode
EXAMPLE 8-1: READING A 16-BIT
FREE-RUNNING TIMER
If control bit T1SYNC (T1CON<2>) is set, the external
clock input is not synchronized. The timer continues to
increment asynchronous to the internal phase clocks.
The timer will continue to run during SLEEP and can
generate an interrupt on overflow which will wake-up
the processor. However, special precautions in soft-
ware are needed to read-from or write-to the Timer1
register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) (Section 8.3.2).
; All interrupts are disabled
MOVF TMR1H, W ;Read high byte
MOVWF TMPH
MOVF TMR1L, W ;Read low byte
MOVWF TMPL
MOVF TMR1H, W ;Read high byte
SUBWF TMPH,
;
;
W
;Sub 1st read
; with 2nd read
BTFSC STATUS,Z ;Is result = 0
GOTO CONTINUE ;Good 16-bit read
In asynchronous counter mode, Timer1 cannot be used
as a time-base for capture or compare operations.
;
; TMR1L may have rolled over between the read
; of the high and low bytes. Reading the high
; and low bytes now will read a good value.
;
8.3.1
EXTERNAL CLOCK INPUT TIMING WITH
UNSYNCHRONIZED CLOCK
If control bit T1SYNC is set, the timer will increment
completely asynchronously. The input clock must meet
certain minimum high time and low time requirements,
as specified in timing parameters 45, 46, and 47.
MOVF
MOVWF TMPH
MOVF TMR1L, W ;Read low byte
MOVWF TMPL
; Re-enable the Interrupt (if required)
CONTINUE ;Continue with your code
TMR1H, W ;Read high byte
;
;
8.3.2
READING AND WRITING TMR1 IN
ASYNCHRONOUS COUNTER MODE
8.4
Timer1 Oscillator
Reading TMR1H or TMR1L while the timer is running,
from an external asynchronous clock, will ensure a
valid read (taken care of in hardware). However, the
user should keep in mind that reading the 16-bit timer
in two 8-bit values itself poses certain problems since
the timer may overflow between the reads.
A crystal oscillator circuit is built in between pins T1OSI
(input) and T1OSO (amplifier output). It is enabled by
setting control bit T1OSCEN (T1CON<3>).The oscilla-
tor is a low power oscillator rated up to 200 kHz. It will
continue to run during SLEEP. It is primarily intended
for a 32 kHz crystal. Table 8-1 shows the capacitor
selection for the Timer1 oscillator.
For writes, it is recommended that the user simply stop
the timer and write the desired values. A write conten-
tion may occur by writing to the timer registers while the
register is incrementing. This may produce an unpre-
dictable value in the timer register.
The Timer1 oscillator is identical to the LP oscillator.
The user must provide a software time delay to ensure
proper oscillator start-up.
Reading the 16-bit value requires some care.
Example 8-1 is an example routine to read the 16-bit
timer value. This is useful if the timer cannot be
stopped.
TABLE 8-1: CAPACITOR SELECTION FOR
THE TIMER1 OSCILLATOR
Osc Type
Freq
C1
C2
LP
32 kHz
100 kHz
200 kHz
33 pF
15 pF
15 pF
33 pF
15 pF
15 pF
These values are for design guidance only.
Crystals Tested:
32.768 kHz Epson C-001R32.768K-A ± 20 PPM
100 kHz
200 kHz
Epson C-2 100.00 KC-P
STD XTL 200.000 kHz
± 20 PPM
± 20 PPM
Note 1: Higher capacitance increases the stability
of oscillator but also increases the start-up
time.
2: Since each resonator/crystal has its own
characteristics, the user should consult the
resonator/crystal manufacturer for appropri-
ate values of external components.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 53
PIC16C9XX
8.5
Resetting Timer1 using the CCP
Trigger Output
8.6
Resetting of Timer1 Register Pair
(TMR1H:TMR1L)
If the CCP1 module is configured in compare mode to
generate a “special event trigger" (CCP1M3:CCP1M0
= 1011), this signal will reset Timer1.
TMR1H and TMR1L registers are not reset on a POR
or any other reset except by the CCP1 special event
trigger.
T1CON register is reset to 00h on a Power-on Reset. In
any other reset, the register is unaffected.
Note: The special event trigger from the CCP1
module will not set interrupt flag bit
TMR1IF (PIR1<0>).
8.7
Timer1 Prescaler
Timer1 must be configured for either timer or synchro-
nized counter mode to take advantage of this feature. If
Timer1 is running in asynchronous counter mode, this
reset operation may not work.
The prescaler counter is cleared on writes to the
TMR1H or TMR1L registers.
In the event that a write to Timer1 coincides with a spe-
cial event trigger from CCP1, the write will take prece-
dence.
In this mode of operation, the CCPR1H:CCPR1L regis-
ters pair effectively becomes the period register for
Timer1.
TABLE 8-2: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER1 AS A TIMER/COUNTER
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on
all other
resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0000 000x 0000 000u
0Bh, 8Bh,
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
10Bh, 18Bh
00-- 0000 00-- 0000
00-- 0000 00-- 0000
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
--00 0000 --uu uuuu
0Ch
PIR1
LCDIF ADIF(1)
LCDIE ADIE(1)
—
—
—
—
SSPIF
SSPIE
CCP1IF
CCP1IE
TMR2IF
TMR2IE
TMR1IF
TMR1IE
8Ch
PIE1
0Eh
TMR1L
TMR1H
T1CON
Holding register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register
Holding register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register
0Fh
10h
—
—
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by theTimer1 module.
Note 1: Bits ADIE and ADIF are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30444E - page 54
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
9.1
Timer2 Prescaler and Postscaler
9.0
TIMER2 MODULE
The prescaler and postscaler counters are cleared
when any of the following occurs:
Timer2 is an 8-bit timer with a prescaler and a
postscaler. It can be used as the PWM time-base for
the PWM mode of the CCP module.The TMR2 register
is readable and writable, and is cleared on any device
reset.
• a write to the TMR2 register
• a write to the T2CON register
• any device reset (Power-on Reset, MCLR Reset,
or Watchdog Timer Reset)
The input clock (FOSC/4) has a prescale option of 1:1,
1:4
or
1:16
(selected
by
control
bits
TMR2 will not clear when T2CON is written.
T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0 (T2CON<1:0>)).
9.2
Output of TMR2
The Timer2 module has an 8-bit period register, PR2.
TMR2 increments from 00h until it matches PR2 and
then resets to 00h on the next increment cycle. PR2 is
a readable and writable register.The PR2 register is set
during RESET.
The output of TMR2 (before the postscaler) is fed to the
Synchronous Serial Port module which optionally uses
it to generate shift clock.
The match output of TMR2 goes through a 4-bit
postscaler (which gives a 1:1 to 1:16 scaling inclusive)
to generate a TMR2 interrupt (latched in flag bit
TMR2IF, (PIR1<1>)).
FIGURE 9-1: TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Sets flag
TMR2
output (1)
bit TMR2IF
Timer2 can be shut off by clearing control bit TMR2ON
(T2CON<2>) to minimize power consumption.
Prescaler
1:1, 1:4, 1:16
Reset
TMR2 reg
Fosc/4
Figure 9-2 shows the Timer2 control register.
Postscaler
to 1:1
2
Comparator
1:16
EQ
4
PR2 reg
Note 1: TMR2 register output can be software selected
by the SSP Module as the source clock.
FIGURE 9-2: T2CON:TIMER2 CONTROL REGISTER (ADDRESS 12h)
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
bit0
R
= Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U
bit7
= Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7:
Unimplemented: Read as '0'
bit 6-3: TOUTPS3:TOUTPS0: Timer2 Output Postscale Select bits
0000= 1:1 Postscale
0001= 1:2 Postscale
•
•
•
1111= 1:16 Postscale
bit 2:
TMR2ON: Timer2 On bit
1 = Timer2 is on
0 = Timer2 is off
bit 1-0: T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0: Timer2 Clock Prescale Select bits
00= Prescaler is 1
01= Prescaler is 4
1x= Prescaler is 16
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 55
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 9-1: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER2 AS A TIMER/COUNTER
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on
all other
resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0000 000x 0000 000u
0Bh, 8Bh,
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
10Bh, 18Bh
ADIF(1)
ADIE(1)
—
—
—
—
SSPIF
SSPIE
CCP1IF
CCP1IE
TMR2IF
TMR2IE
TMR1IF
TMR1IE
00-- 0000 00-- 0000
00-- 0000 00-- 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
-000 0000 -000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
0Ch
PIR1
LCDIF
LCDIE
8Ch
PIE1
11h
TMR2
T2CON
PR2
Timer2 module’s register
TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
Timer2 Period Register
12h
—
92h
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer2 module.
Note 1: Bits ADIE and ADIF are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30444E - page 56
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
For use of the CCP module, refer to the Embedded
Control Handbook, "Using the CCP Modules" (AN594).
10.0 CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM
(CCP) MODULE
The CCP (Capture/Compare/PWM) module contains a
16-bit register which can operate as a 16-bit capture
register, as a 16-bit compare register, or as a PWM
master/slave duty cycle register. Table 10-1 shows the
timer resources used by the CCP module.
TABLE 10-1: CCP MODE - TIMER RESOURCE
CCP Mode
Timer Resource
Capture
Compare
PWM
Timer1
Timer1
Timer2
Capture/Compare/PWM Register1 (CCPR1) is com-
prised of two 8-bit registers: CCPR1L (low byte) and
CCPR1H (high byte). The CCP1CON register controls
the operation of CCP1. All three are readable and writ-
able.
Figure 10-1 shows the CCP1CON register.
FIGURE 10-1: CCP1CON REGISTER (ADDRESS 17h)
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CCP1X CCP1Y CCP1M3 CCP1M2 CCP1M1 CCP1M0
bit0
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
bit7
- n =Value at POR reset
bit 7-6: Unimplemented: Read as '0'
bit 5-4: CCP1X:CCP1Y: PWM Least Significant bits
Capture Mode
Unused
Compare Mode
Unused
PWM Mode
These bits are the two LSbs of the PWM duty cycle. The eight MSbs are found in CCPR1L.
bit 3-0: CCP1M3:CCP1M0: CCP1 Mode Select bits
0000= Capture/Compare/PWM off (resets CCP1 module)
0100= Capture mode, every falling edge
0101= Capture mode, every rising edge
0110= Capture mode, every 4th rising edge
0111= Capture mode, every 16th rising edge
1000= Compare mode, set output on match (bit CCP1IF is set)
1001= Compare mode, clear output on match (bit CCP1IF is set)
1010= Compare mode, generate software interrupt on match (bit CCP1IF is set, CCP1 pin is unaffected)
1011= Compare mode, trigger special event (CCP1IF bit is set; CCP1 resets TMR1)
11xx= PWM mode
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 57
PIC16C9XX
Switching from one capture prescaler to another may
generate an interrupt. Also, the prescaler counter will
not be cleared, therefore the first capture may be from
a non-zero prescaler. Example 10-1 shows the recom-
mended method for switching between capture prescal-
ers.This example also clears the prescaler counter and
will not generate the “false” interrupt.
10.1
Capture Mode
In Capture mode, CCPR1H:CCPR1L captures the
16-bit value of the TMR1 register when an event occurs
on pin RC2/CCP1 (Figure 10-2).An event is defined as:
• Every falling edge
• Every rising edge
• Every 4th rising edge
• Every 16th rising edge
EXAMPLE 10-1: CHANGING BETWEEN
CAPTURE PRESCALERS
An event is selected by control bits CCP1M3:CCP1M0
(CCP1CON<3:0>). When a capture is made, the inter-
rupt request flag bit CCP1IF (PIR1<2>) is set. It must
be cleared in software. If another capture occurs before
the value in register CCPR1 is read, the old captured
value will be lost.
CLRF
CCP1CON
; Turn CCP module off
MOVLW NEW_CAPT_PS ; Load the W reg with
; the new prescaler
; mode value and CCP ON
MOVWF CCP1CON
; Load CCP1CON with
; this value
10.1.1 CCP PIN CONFIGURATION
10.2
Compare Mode
In capture mode, the RC2/CCP1 pin should be config-
ured as an input by setting the TRISC<2> bit.
In Compare mode, the 16-bit CCPR1 register value is
constantly compared against the TMR1 register pair
value. When a match occurs, the RC2/CCP1 pin is:
Note: If the RC2/CCP1 pin is configured as an
output, a write to the port can cause a cap-
ture condition.
• Driven High
• Driven Low
• Remains Unchanged
FIGURE 10-2: CAPTURE MODE OPERATION
BLOCK DIAGRAM
The action on the pin is based on the value of control
bits CCP1M3:CCP1M0 (CCP1CON<3:0>). At the
same time, a compare interrupt is also generated.
Set CCP1IF
PIR1<2>
CCP
Prescaler
FIGURE 10-3: COMPARE MODE
OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM
÷ 1, 4, 16
RC2/CCP1
pin
CCPR1H
CCPR1L
TMR1L
Capture
Enable
Special event trigger will reset Timer1, but not
set interrupt flag bit TMR1IF (PIR1<0>).
and
edge detect
TMR1H
Set CCP1IF
PIR1<2>
CCP1CON<3:0>
Q’s
CCPR1H CCPR1L
Q
S
R
10.1.2 TIMER1 MODE SELECTION
Output
Logic
Comparator
match
RC2/CCP1
Timer1 must be running in timer mode or synchronized
counter mode for the CCP module to use the capture
feature. In asynchronous counter mode the capture
operation may not work.
TRISC<2>
Output Enable
TMR1H TMR1L
CCP1CON<3:0>
Mode Select
10.1.3 SOFTWARE INTERRUPT
When the Capture mode is changed, a false capture
interrupt may be generated. The user should keep
enable bit CCP1IE (PIE1<2>) clear to avoid false inter-
rupts and should clear flag bit CCP1IF following any
such change in operating mode.
10.2.1 CCP PIN CONFIGURATION
The user must configure the RC2/CCP1 pin as an out-
put by clearing the TRISC<2> bit.
Note: Clearing the CCP1CON register will force
the RC2/CCP1 compare output latch to the
default low level. This is not the data latch.
10.1.4 CCP PRESCALER
There are four prescaler settings, specified by bits
CCP1M3:CCP1M0. Whenever the CCP module is
turned off, or the CCP module is not in Capture mode,
the prescaler counter is cleared. This means that any
reset will clear the prescaler counter.
DS30444E - page 58
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
10.2.1 TIMER1 MODE SELECTION
FIGURE 10-4: SIMPLIFIED PWM BLOCK
DIAGRAM
Timer1 must be running in Timer mode or Synchro-
nized Counter mode if the CCP module is using the
compare feature. In Asynchronous Counter mode, the
compare operation may not work.
CCP1CON<5:4>
Duty cycle registers
CCPR1L
10.2.2 SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE
When Generate Software Interrupt is chosen, the
CCP1 pin is not affected. Only a CCP interrupt is gen-
erated (if enabled).
CCPR1H (Slave)
Q
R
S
Comparator
TMR2
10.2.3 SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER
RC1/CCP1
(Note 1)
In this mode, an internal hardware trigger is generated
which may be used to initiate an action.
TRISC<2>
Comparator
The special event trigger output of CCP1 resets the
TMR1 register pair and starts an A/D conversion. This
allows the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair to effectively
be a 16-bit programmable period register for Timer1.
Clear Timer,
CCP1 pin and
latch D.C.
PR2
Note 1: 8-bit timer is concatenated with 2-bit internal Q clock
or 2 bits of the prescaler to create 10-bit time-base.
Note: The "special event trigger" from the CCP1
module will not set interrupt flag bit
TMR1IF (PIR1<0>).
A PWM output (Figure 10-5) has a time-base (period)
and a time that the output stays high (duty cycle). The
frequency of the PWM is the inverse of the period
(1/period).
10.3
PWM Mode
In Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) mode, the CCP1 pin
produces up to a 10-bit resolution PWM output. Since
the CCP1 pin is multiplexed with the PORTC data latch,
the TRISC<2> bit must be cleared to make the CCP1
pin an output.
FIGURE 10-5: PWM OUTPUT
Period
Note: Clearing the CCP1CON register will force
the CCP1 PWM output latch to the default
low level. This is not the PORTC I/O data
latch.
TMR2 = PR2
Duty Cycle
Figure 10-4 shows a simplified block diagram of the
CCP module in PWM mode.
TMR2 = Duty Cycle
TMR2 = PR2
For a step by step procedure on how to set up the CCP
module for PWM operation, see Section 10.3.3.
10.3.1 PWM PERIOD
The PWM period is specified by writing to the PR2 reg-
ister. The PWM period can be calculated using the fol-
lowing formula:
PWM period = [ (PR2) + 1 ] • 4 • TOSC •
(TMR2 prescale value)
PWM frequency is defined as 1 / [PWM period].
When TMR2 is equal to PR2, the following three events
occur on the next increment cycle:
• TMR2 is cleared
• The CCP1 pin is set (exception: if PWM duty
cycle = 0%, the CCP1 pin will not be set)
• The PWM duty cycle is latched from CCPR1L into
CCPR1H
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 59
PIC16C9XX
EXAMPLE 10-2: PWM PERIOD AND DUTY
CYCLE CALCULATION
Note: The Timer2 postscaler (Section 9.0) is not
used in the determination of the PWM fre-
quency. The postscaler could be used to
have a servo update rate at a different fre-
quency than the PWM output.
Desired PWM frequency is 31.25 kHz,
Fosc = 8 MHz
TMR2 prescale = 1
1/31.25 kHz = [ (PR2) + 1 ] • 4 • 1/8 MHz • 1
10.3.2 PWM DUTY CYCLE
32 µs
= [ (PR2) + 1 ] • 4 • 125 ns • 1
The PWM duty cycle is specified by writing to the
CCPR1L register and to the CCP1CON<5:4> bits. Up
to 10-bit resolution is available: the CCPR1L contains
the eight MSbs and CCP1CON<5:4> contains the two
LSbs. This 10-bit value is represented by
CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4>. The following equation is
used to calculate the PWM duty cycle in time:
PR2
= 63
Find the maximum resolution of the duty cycle that can
be used with a 31.25 kHz frequency and 8 MHz oscilla-
tor:
1/31.25 kHz = 2PWM RESOLUTION • 1/8 MHz • 1
32 µs
256
= 2PWM RESOLUTION • 125 ns • 1
= 2PWM RESOLUTION
PWM duty cycle = (CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4>) •
Tosc • (TMR2 prescale value)
CCPR1L and CCP1CON<5:4> can be written to at any
time, but the duty cycle value is not latched into
CCPR1H until after a match between PR2 and TMR2
occurs (i.e., the period is complete). In PWM mode,
CCPR1H is a read-only register.
log(256)
8.0
= (PWM Resolution) • log(2)
= PWM Resolution
At most, an 8-bit resolution duty cycle can be obtained
from a 31.25 kHz frequency and a 8 MHz oscillator, i.e.,
0 ≤ CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4> ≤ 255. Any value greater
than 255 will result in a 100% duty cycle.
The CCPR1H register and a 2-bit internal latch are
used to double buffer the PWM duty cycle. This double
buffering is essential for glitchless PWM operation.
In order to achieve higher resolution, the PWM fre-
quency must be decreased. In order to achieve higher
PWM frequency, the resolution must be decreased.
When the CCPR1H and 2-bit latch match TMR2 con-
catenated with an internal 2-bit Q clock or 2 bits of the
TMR2 prescaler, the CCP1 pin is cleared.
Table 10-2 lists example PWM frequencies and resolu-
tions for Fosc = 8 MHz. TMR2 prescaler and PR2 val-
ues are also shown.
Maximum PWM resolution (bits) for a given PWM fre-
quency:
10.3.3 SET-UP FOR PWM OPERATION
FOSC
log( FPWM )
The following steps should be taken when configuring
the CCP module for PWM operation:
=
bits
log(2)
1. Set the PWM period by writing to the PR2 regis-
ter.
2. Set the PWM duty cycle by writing to the
CCPR1L register and CCP1CON<5:4> bits.
Note: If the PWM duty cycle value is longer than
the PWM period the CCP1 pin will not be
cleared.
3. Make the CCP1 pin an output by clearing the
TRISC<2> bit.
4. Set the TMR2 prescale value and enable Timer2
by writing to T2CON.
5. Configure the CCP module for PWM operation.
TABLE 10-2: EXAMPLE PWM FREQUENCIES AND RESOLUTIONS AT 8 MHz
PWM Frequency
Timer Prescaler (1, 4, 16)
488 Hz 1.95 kHz 7.81 kHz 31.25 kHz 62.5 kHz
250 kHz
16
0xFF
10
4
1
1
0x3F
8
1
0x1F
7
1
0x07
5
PR2 Value
0xFF
10
0xFF
10
Maximum Resolution (bits)
DS30444E - page 60
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 10-3: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER1, CAPTURE AND COMPARE
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on
all other
Resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0000 000x 0000 000u
0Bh, 8Bh,
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
10Bh, 18Bh
00-- 0000 00-- 0000
00-- 0000 00-- 0000
0Ch
8Ch
87h
0Eh
0Fh
10h
15h
16h
PIR1
LCDIF ADIF(1)
LCDIE ADIE(1)
—
—
—
—
SSPIF
SSPIE
CCP1IF
CCP1IE
TMR2IF
TMR2IE
TMR1IF
TMR1IE
PIE1
TRISC
—
—
PORTC Data Direction Control Register
--11 1111 --11 1111
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
--00 0000 --uu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
--00 0000 --00 0000
TMR1L
TMR1H
T1CON
CCPR1L
CCPR1H
CCP1CON
Holding register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register
Holding register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register
—
—
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON
Capture/Compare/PWM1 (LSB)
Capture/Compare/PWM1 (MSB)
17h
—
—
CCP1X
CCP1Y
CCP1M3 CCP1M2 CCP1M1 CCP1M0
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented locations read as '0’. Shaded cells are not used in these modes.
Note 1: Bits ADIE and ADIF reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
TABLE 10-4: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PWM AND TIMER2
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on
all other
Resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0Bh, 8Bh,
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
0000 000x 0000 000u
10Bh, 18Bh
0Ch
8Ch
87h
11h
92h
12h
15h
16h
PIR1
LCDIF
LCDIE
—
ADIF(1)
ADIE(1)
—
—
—
—
—
SSPIF
SSPIE
CCP1IF
CCP1IE
TMR2IF
TMR2IE
TMR1IF 00-- 0000 00-- 0000
TMR1IE 00-- 0000 00-- 0000
--11 1111 --11 1111
PIE1
TRISC
TMR2
PORTC Data Direction Control Register
Timer2 module’s register
0000 0000 0000 0000
PR2
Timer2 module’s Period register
1111 1111 1111 1111
T2CON
CCPR1L
CCPR1H
CCP1CON
—
TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0 -000 0000 -000 0000
Capture/Compare/PWM1 (LSB)
Capture/Compare/PWM1 (MSB)
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
17h
—
—
CCP1X
CCP1Y
CCP1M3 CCP1M2 CCP1M1 CCP1M0 --00 0000 --00 0000
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented locations read as '0’. Shaded cells are not used in this mode.
Note 1: Bits ADIE and ADIF reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 61
PIC16C9XX
NOTES:
DS30444E - page 62
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
play drivers, A/D converters, etc. The SSP module can
operate in one of two modes:
11.0 SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL
PORT (SSP) MODULE
The Synchronous Serial Port (SSP) module is a serial
interface useful for communicating with other periph-
eral or microcontroller devices. These peripheral
devices may be serial EEPROMs, shift registers, dis-
• Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
2
• Inter-Integrated Circuit (I C)
Refer to Application Note AN578, "Use of the SSP
2
Module in the I C Multi-Master Environment."
FIGURE 11-1: SSPSTAT: SYNC SERIAL PORT STATUS REGISTER (ADDRESS 94h)
R/W-0 R/W-0
SMP CKE
bit7
R-0
D/A
R-0
P
R-0
S
R-0
R-0
UA
R-0
BF
R/W
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
bit0
- n =Value at POR reset
bit 7:
bit 6:
SMP: SPI data input sample phase
SPI Master Mode
1 = Input data sampled at end of data output time
0 = Input data sampled at middle of data output time
SPI Slave Mode
SMP must be cleared when SPI is used in slave mode
CKE: SPI Clock Edge Select (Figure 11-5, Figure 11-6, and Figure 11-7)
CKP = 0
1 = Data transmitted on rising edge of SCK
0 = Data transmitted on falling edge of SCK
CKP = 1
1 = Data transmitted on falling edge of SCK
0 = Data transmitted on rising edge of SCK
2
bit 5:
bit 4:
D/A: Data/Address bit (I C mode only)
1 = Indicates that the last byte received or transmitted was data
0 = Indicates that the last byte received or transmitted was address
2
P: Stop bit (I C mode only. This bit is cleared when the SSP module is disabled, or when the Start bit was
detected last)
1 = Indicates that a stop bit has been detected last (this bit is '0' on RESET)
0 = Stop bit was not detected last
2
bit 3:
bit 2:
S: Start bit (I C mode only. This bit is cleared when the SSP module is disabled, or when the Stop bit was
detected last)
1 = Indicates that a start bit has been detected last (this bit is '0' on RESET)
0 = Start bit was not detected last
2
R/W: Read/Write bit information (I C mode only)
This bit holds the R/W bit information following the last address match. This bit is only valid from the
address match to the next start bit, stop bit, or ACK bit.
1 = Read
0 = Write
2
bit 1:
bit 0:
UA: Update Address (10-bit I C mode only)
1 = Indicates that the user needs to update the address in the SSPADD register
0 = Address does not need to be updated
BF: Buffer Full Status bit
2
Receive (SPI and I C modes)
1 = Receive complete, SSPBUF is full
0 = Receive not complete, SSPBUF is empty
2
Transmit (I C mode only)
1 = Transmit in progress, SSPBUF is full
0 = Transmit complete, SSPBUF is empty
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 63
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 11-2: SSPCON: SYNC SERIAL PORT CONTROL REGISTER (ADDRESS 14h)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CKP
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
WCOL SSPOV SSPEN
bit7
SSPM3 SSPM2 SSPM1 SSPM0
bit0
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
- n =Value at POR reset
bit 7:
WCOL: Write Collision Detect bit
1 = The SSPBUF register is written while it is still transmitting the previous word
(must be cleared in software)
0 = No collision
bit 6:
SSPOV: Receive Overflow Indicator bit
In SPI mode
1 = A new byte is received while the SSPBUF register is still holding the previous data. In case of overflow,
the data in SSPSR is lost. Overflow can only occur in slave mode.The user must read the SSPBUF, even
if only transmitting data, to avoid setting overflow. In master mode the overflow bit is not set since each
new reception (and transmission) is initiated by writing to the SSPBUF register.
0 = No overflow
2
In I C mode
1 = A byte is received while the SSPBUF register is still holding the previous byte. SSPOV is a "don’t care"
in transmit mode. SSPOV must be cleared in software in either mode.
0 = No overflow
bit 5:
SSPEN: Synchronous Serial Port Enable bit
In SPI mode
1 = Enables serial port and configures SCK, SDO, and SDI as serial port pins
0 = Disables serial port and configures these pins as I/O port pins
2
In I C mode
1 = Enables the serial port and configures the SDA and SCL pins as serial port pins
0 = Disables serial port and configures these pins as I/O port pins
In both modes, when enabled, these pins must be properly configured as input or output.
bit 4:
CKP: Clock Polarity Select bit
In SPI mode
1 = Idle state for clock is a high level
0 = Idle state for clock is a low level
2
In I C mode
SCK release control
1 = Enable clock
0 = Holds clock low (clock stretch) (Used to ensure data setup time)
bit 3-0: SSPM3:SSPM0: Synchronous Serial Port Mode Select bits
0000= SPI master mode, clock = FOSC/4
0001= SPI master mode, clock = FOSC/16
0010= SPI master mode, clock = FOSC/64
0011= SPI master mode, clock = TMR2 output/2
0100= SPI slave mode, clock = SCK pin. SS pin control enabled.
0101= SPI slave mode, clock = SCK pin. SS pin control disabled. SS can be used as I/O pin
2
0110= I C slave mode, 7-bit address
2
0111= I C slave mode, 10-bit address
2
1011= I C Firmware controlled master mode (slave idle)
2
1110= I C slave mode, 7-bit address with start and stop bit interrupts enabled
2
1111= I C slave mode, 10-bit address with start and stop bit interrupts enabled
DS30444E - page 64
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
11.1
SPI Mode
EXAMPLE 11-1: LOADING THE SSPBUF
(SSPSR) REGISTER
The SPI mode allows 8-bits of data to be synchro-
nously transmitted and received simultaneously. To
accomplish communication, typically three pins are
used:
BCF
BSF
STATUS, RP1
STATUS, RP0
;Select Bank1
;
LOOP BTFSS SSPSTAT, BF
;Has data been
;received
• Serial Data Out (SDO) RC5/SDO
• Serial Data In (SDI) RC4/SDI
• Serial Clock (SCK) RC3/SCK
;(transmit
;complete)?
;No
GOTO LOOP
BCF
STATUS, RP0
;Select Bank0
;W reg = contents
; of SSPBUF
;Save in user RAM
Additionally a fourth pin may be used when in a slave
mode of operation:
MOVF SSPBUF, W
• Slave Select (SS) RA5/AN4/SS (the AN4 function
is implemented on the PIC16C924 only)
MOVWF RXDATA
MOVF TXDATA, W
;W reg = contents
; of TXDATA
;New data to xmit
When initializing the SPI, several options need to be
specified.This is done by programming the appropriate
control bits in the SSPCON register (SSPCON<5:0>)
and SSPSTAT<7:6>. These control bits allow the fol-
lowing to be specified:
MOVWF SSPBUF
The block diagram of the SSP module, when in SPI
mode (Figure 11-3), shows that the SSPSR is not
directly readable or writable, and can only be accessed
from addressing the SSPBUF register. Additionally, the
SSP status register (SSPSTAT) indicates the various
status conditions.
• Master Mode (SCK is the clock output)
• Slave Mode (SCK is the clock input)
• Clock Polarity (Idle state of SCK)
• Clock edge (output data on rising/falling edge of
SCK)
FIGURE 11-3: SSP BLOCK DIAGRAM
(SPI MODE)
• Clock Rate (Master mode only)
Internal
data bus
• Slave Select Mode (Slave mode only)
The SSP consists of a transmit/receive Shift Register
(SSPSR) and a buffer register (SSPBUF). The SSPSR
shifts the data in and out of the device, MSb first. The
SSPBUF holds the data that was written to the SSPSR,
until the received data is ready. Once the 8-bits of data
have been received, that byte is moved to the SSPBUF
register. Then the buffer full detect bit BF
(SSPSTAT<0>) and interrupt flag bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>)
are set. This double buffering of the received data
(SSPBUF) allows the next byte to start reception before
reading the data that was just received. Any write to the
SSPBUF register during transmission/reception of data
will be ignored, and the write collision detect bit WCOL
(SSPCON<7>) will be set. User software must clear the
WCOL bit so that it can be determined if the following
write(s) to the SSPBUF register completed success-
fully. When the application software is expecting to
receive valid data, the SSPBUF should be read before
the next byte of data to transfer is written to the
SSPBUF. Buffer full bit BF (SSPSTAT<0>) indicates
when SSPBUF has been loaded with the received data
(transmission is complete). When the SSPBUF is read,
bit BF is cleared. This data may be irrelevant if the SPI
is only a transmitter. Generally the SSP Interrupt is
used to determine when the transmission/reception
has completed.The SSPBUF must be read and/or writ-
ten. If the interrupt method is not going to be used, then
software polling can be done to ensure that a write col-
lision does not occur. Example 11-1 shows the loading
of the SSPBUF (SSPSR) for data transmission. The
shaded instruction is only required if the received data
is meaningful.
Read
Write
SSPBUF reg
SSPSR reg
shift
clock
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
bit0
Control
Enable
SS
RA5/AN4/SS
Edge
Select
2
Clock Select
SSPM3:SSPM0
4
TMR2 output
2
Edge
Select
TCY
Prescaler
4, 16, 64
RC3/SCK/
SCL
TRISC<3>
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 65
PIC16C9XX
To enable the serial port, SSP Enable bit, SSPEN
(SSPCON<5>) must be set.To reset or reconfigure SPI
mode, clear bit SSPEN, re-initialize the SSPCON reg-
ister, and then set bit SSPEN. This configures the SDI,
SDO, SCK, and SS pins as serial port pins. For the pins
to behave as the serial port function, they must have
their data direction bits (in the TRISC register) appro-
priately programmed. That is:
The master can initiate the data transfer at any time
because it controls the SCK. The master determines
when the slave (Processor 2) is to broadcast data by
the firmware protocol.
In master mode the data is transmitted/received as
soon as the SSPBUF register is written to. If the SPI is
only going to receive, the SCK output could be disabled
(programmed as an input). The SSPSR register will
continue to shift in the signal present on the SDI pin at
the programmed clock rate. As each byte is received, it
will be loaded into the SSPBUF register as if a normal
received byte (interrupts and status bits appropriately
set). This could be useful in receiver applications as a
“line activity monitor” mode.
• SDI must have TRISC<4> set
• SDO must have TRISC<5> cleared
• SCK (Master mode) must have TRISC<3>
cleared
• SCK (Slave mode) must have TRISC<3> set
• SS must have TRISA<5> set
In slave mode, the data is transmitted and received as
the external clock pulses appear on SCK.When the last
bit is latched the interrupt flag bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>) is
set.
Any serial port function that is not desired may be over-
ridden by programming the corresponding data direc-
tion (TRIS) register to the opposite value. An example
would be in master mode where you are only sending
data (to a display driver), then both SDI and SS could
be used as general purpose outputs by clearing their
corresponding TRIS register bits.
The clock polarity is selected by appropriately program-
ming bit CKP (SSPCON<4>). This then would give
waveforms for SPI communication as shown in
Figure 11-5, Figure 11-6, and Figure 11-7 where the
MSB is transmitted first. In master mode, the SPI clock
rate (bit rate) is user programmable to be one of the fol-
lowing:
Figure 11-4 shows a typical connection between two
microcontrollers. The master controller (Processor 1)
initiates the data transfer by sending the SCK signal.
Data is shifted out of both shift registers on their pro-
grammed clock edge, and latched on the opposite edge
of the clock. Both processors should be programmed to
same Clock Polarity (CKP), then both controllers would
send and receive data at the same time. Whether the
data is meaningful (or dummy data) depends on the
application software. This leads to three scenarios for
data transmission:
• FOSC/4 (or TCY)
• FOSC/16 (or 4 • TCY)
• FOSC/64 (or 16 • TCY)
• Timer2 output/2
This allows a maximum bit clock frequency (at 8 MHz)
of 2 MHz. When in slave mode the external clock must
meet the minimum high and low times.
• Master sends data — Slave sends dummy data
• Master sends data — Slave sends data
In sleep mode, the slave can transmit and receive data
and wake the device from sleep.
• Master sends dummy data — Slave sends data
FIGURE 11-4: SPI MASTER/SLAVE CONNECTION
SPI Master SSPM3:SSPM0 = 00xxb
SPI Slave SSPM3:SSPM0 = 010xb
SDO
SDI
Serial Input Buffer
(SSPBUF)
Serial Input Buffer
(SSPBUF)
SDI
SDO
Shift Register
Shift Register
(SSPSR)
(SSPSR)
LSb
MSb
MSb
LSb
Serial Clock
SCK
SCK
PROCESSOR 1
PROCESSOR 2
DS30444E - page 66
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
The SS pin allows a synchronous slave mode. The
SPI must be in slave mode (SSPCON<3:0> = 04h)
and the TRISA<5> bit must be set for the synchro-
nous slave mode to be enabled. When the SS pin is
low, transmission and reception are enabled and the
SDO pin is driven. When the SS pin goes high, the
SDO pin is no longer driven, even if in the middle of
a transmitted byte, and becomes a floating output.
External pull-up/ pull-down resistors may be desirable,
depending on the application.
Note: When the SPI is in Slave Mode with SS pin
control enabled, (SSPCON<3:0> = 0100)
the SPI module will reset if the SS pin is set
to VDD.
Note: If the SPI is used in Slave Mode with
CKE = '1', then the SS pin control must be
enabled.
To emulate two-wire communication, the SDO pin can
be connected to the SDI pin. When the SPI needs to
operate as a receiver the SDO pin can be configured as
an input. This disables transmissions from the SDO.
The SDI can always be left as an input (SDI function)
since it cannot create a bus conflict.
FIGURE 11-5: SPI MODE TIMING, MASTER MODE
SCK (CKP = 0,
CKE = 0)
SCK (CKP = 0,
CKE = 1)
SCK (CKP = 1,
CKE = 0)
SCK (CKP = 1,
CKE = 1)
bit2
bit7
bit6
bit5
bit3
bit1
bit0
bit4
SDO
SDI (SMP = 0)
bit7
bit0
SDI (SMP = 1)
SSPIF
bit7
bit0
FIGURE 11-6: SPI MODE TIMING (SLAVE MODE WITH CKE = 0)
SS (optional)
SCK (CKP = 0)
SCK (CKP = 1)
bit2
bit7
bit6
bit5
bit3
bit1
bit0
bit4
SDO
SDI (SMP = 0)
bit7
bit0
SSPIF
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 67
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 11-7: SPI MODE TIMING (SLAVE MODE WITH CKE = 1)
SS
(not optional)
SCK (CKP = 0)
SCK (CKP = 1)
bit2
SDO
bit7
bit6
bit5
bit3
bit1
bit0
bit4
SDI (SMP = 0)
SSPIF
bit7
bit0
TABLE 11-1: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SPI OPERATION
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0Bh, 8Bh,
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
0000 000x
0000 000u
10Bh, 18Bh
0Ch
8Ch
13h
14h
85h
87h
PIR1
LCDIF
ADIF(1)
—
—
—
—
SSPIF
SSPIE
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
TMR1IE
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
xxxx xxxx
0000 0000
--11 1111
--11 1111
0000 0000
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
--11 1111
--11 1111
0000 0000
PIE1
LCDIE ADIE(1)
CCP1IE TMR2IE
SSPBUF
SSPCON
TRISA
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
WCOL SSPOV SSPEN CKP SSPM3 SSPM2
SSPM1
SSPM0
—
—
—
—
PORTA Data Direction Control Register
PORTC Data Direction Control Register
TRISC
SSPSTAT
94h
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the SSP in SPI mode.
Note 1: Bits ADIE and ADIF are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30444E - page 68
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
2
The output stages of the clock (SCL) and data (SDA)
lines must have an open-drain or open-collector in
order to perform the wired-AND function of the bus.
External pull-up resistors are used to ensure a high
level when no device is pulling the line down.The num-
11.2
I C Overview
This section provides an overview of the Inter-Inte-
grated Circuit (I C) bus, with Section 11.3 discussing
the operation of the SSP module in I C mode.
2
2
2
2
The I C bus is a two-wire serial interface developed by
ber of devices that may be attached to the I C bus is
the Philips Corporation. The original specification, or
standard mode, was for data transfers of up to 100
Kbps. An enhanced specification, or fast mode is not
supported. This device will communicate with fast
mode devices if attached to the same bus.
limited only by the maximum bus loading specification
of 400 pF.
11.2.1 INITIATING AND TERMINATING DATA
TRANSFER
2
The I C interface employs a comprehensive protocol to
During times of no data transfer (idle time), both the
clock line (SCL) and the data line (SDA) are pulled high
through the external pull-up resistors. The START and
STOP conditions determine the start and stop of data
transmission.The START condition is defined as a high
to low transition of the SDA when the SCL is high. The
STOP condition is defined as a low to high transition of
the SDA when the SCL is high. Figure 11-8 shows the
START and STOP conditions. The master generates
these conditions for starting and terminating data trans-
fer. Due to the definition of the START and STOP con-
ditions, when data is being transmitted, the SDA line
can only change state when the SCL line is low.
ensure reliable transmission and reception of data.
When transmitting data, one device is the “master”
which initiates transfer on the bus and generates the
clock signals to permit that transfer, while the other
device(s) acts as the “slave.” All portions of the slave
protocol are implemented in the SSP module’s hard-
ware, except general call support, while portions of the
master protocol need to be addressed in the
PIC16CXXX software. Table 11-2 defines some of the
I C bus terminology. For additional information on the
I C interface specification, refer to the Philips docu-
ment “The I C bus and how to use it.” #939839340011,
which can be obtained from the Philips Corporation.
2
2
2
2
In the I C interface protocol each device has an
FIGURE 11-8: START AND STOP
CONDITIONS
address.When a master wishes to initiate a data trans-
fer, it first transmits the address of the device that it
wishes to “talk” to. All devices “listen” to see if this is
their address. Within this address, a bit specifies if the
master wishes to read-from/write-to the slave device.
The master and slave are always in opposite modes
(transmitter/receiver) of operation during a data trans-
fer.That is they can be thought of as operating in either
of these two relations:
SDA
S
SCL
P
Change
of Data
Allowed
Change
of Data
Allowed
Start
Condition
Stop
Condition
• Master-transmitter and Slave-receiver
• Slave-transmitter and Master-receiver
In both cases the master generates the clock signal.
2
TABLE 11-2: I C BUS TERMINOLOGY
Term
Description
Transmitter
Receiver
Master
The device that sends the data to the bus.
The device that receives the data from the bus.
The device which initiates the transfer, generates the clock and terminates the transfer.
The device addressed by a master.
Slave
Multi-master
More than one master device in a system. These masters can attempt to control the bus at the
same time without corrupting the message.
Arbitration
Procedure that ensures that only one of the master devices will control the bus. This ensure that
the transfer data does not get corrupted.
Synchronization
Procedure where the clock signals of two or more devices are synchronized.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 69
PIC16C9XX
2
11.2.2 ADDRESSING I C DEVICES
FIGURE 11-11: SLAVE-RECEIVER
ACKNOWLEDGE
There are two address formats.The simplest is the 7-bit
address format with a R/W bit (Figure 11-9). The more
complex is the 10-bit address with a R/W bit
(Figure 11-10). For 10-bit address format, two bytes
must be transmitted with the first five bits specifying this
to be a 10-bit address.
Data
Output by
Transmitter
Data
Output by
Receiver
not acknowledge
acknowledge
SCL from
Master
9
8
2
1
FIGURE 11-9: 7-BIT ADDRESS FORMAT
S
MSb
LSb
Clock Pulse for
Acknowledgment
Start
Condition
R/W ACK
S
slave address
Sent by
Slave
If the master is receiving the data (master-receiver), it
generates an acknowledge signal for each received
byte of data, except for the last byte. To signal the end
of data to the slave-transmitter, the master does not
generate an acknowledge (not acknowledge). The
slave then releases the SDA line so the master can
generate the STOP condition. The master can also
generate the STOP condition during the acknowledge
pulse for valid termination of data transfer.
S
R/W
ACK
Start Condition
Read/Write pulse
Acknowledge
2
FIGURE 11-10: I C 10-BIT ADDRESS
FORMAT
If the slave needs to delay the transmission of the next
byte, holding the SCL line low will force the master into
a wait state. Data transfer continues when the slave
releases the SCL line.This allows the slave to move the
received data or fetch the data it needs to transfer
before allowing the clock to start. This wait state tech-
nique can also be implemented at the bit level,
Figure 11-12.The slave will inherently stretch the clock,
when it is a transmitter, but will not when it is a receiver.
The slave will have to clear the SSPCON<4> bit to
enable clock stretching when it is a receiver.
S
1 1 1 1 0 A9 A8 R/W ACK A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 ACK
sent by slave
= 0 for write
S
- Start Condition
R/W - Read/Write Pulse
ACK - Acknowledge
11.2.3 TRANSFER ACKNOWLEDGE
All data must be transmitted per byte, with no limit to the
number of bytes transmitted per data transfer. After
each byte, the slave-receiver generates an acknowl-
edge bit (ACK) (Figure 11-11). When a slave-receiver
doesn’t acknowledge the slave address or received
data, the master must abort the transfer. The slave
must leave SDA high so that the master can generate
the STOP condition (Figure 11-8).
FIGURE 11-12: DATA TRANSFER WAIT STATE
SDA
MSB
acknowledgment
signal from receiver
acknowledgment
signal from receiver
byte complete
interrupt with receiver
clock line held low while
interrupts are serviced
SCL
S
1
2
7
8
9
1
2
3 • 8
9
P
Start
Condition
Stop
Condition
Address
R/W ACK Wait
State
Data
ACK
DS30444E - page 70
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
Figure 11-13 and Figure 11-14 show Master-transmit-
ter and Master-receiver data transfer sequences.
is high), but occurs after a data transfer acknowledge
pulse (not the bus-free state). This allows a master to
send “commands” to the slave and then receive the
requested information or to address a different slave
device. This sequence is shown in Figure 11-15.
When a master does not wish to relinquish the bus (by
generating a STOP condition), a repeated START con-
dition (Sr) must be generated.This condition is identical
to the start condition (SDA goes high-to-low while SCL
FIGURE 11-13: MASTER-TRANSMITTER SEQUENCE
For 7-bit address:
For 10-bit address:
S Slave AddressR/W A1Slave Address A2
S Slave AddressR/W A Data A Data A/A P
First 7 bits
Second byte
'0' (write)
data transferred
(n bytes - acknowledge)
(write)
A master transmitter addresses a slave receiver with a
7-bit address. The transfer direction is not changed.
Data A
Data A/A P
A = acknowledge (SDA low)
A = not acknowledge (SDA high)
From master to slave
S = Start Condition
A master transmitter addresses a slave receiver
with a 10-bit address.
From slave to master
P = Stop Condition
FIGURE 11-14: MASTER-RECEIVER SEQUENCE
For 10-bit address:
S Slave AddressR/W A1Slave Address A2
First 7 bits Second byte
(write)
For 7-bit address:
S Slave AddressR/W A Data A Data A
P
'1' (read) data transferred
(n bytes - acknowledge)
A master reads a slave immediately after the first byte.
SrSlave AddressR/W A3 Data A Data A P
First 7 bits
A = acknowledge (SDA low)
A = not acknowledge (SDA high)
From master to slave
(read)
S = Start Condition
A master transmitter addresses a slave receiver
with a 10-bit address.
From slave to master
P = Stop Condition
FIGURE 11-15: COMBINED FORMAT
(read or write)
(n bytes + acknowledge)
S Slave AddressR/W A Data A/A Sr Slave Address R/W A Data A/A P
(write)
Direction of transfer
may change at this point
(read)
Sr = repeated
Start Condition
Transfer direction of data and acknowledgment bits depends on R/W bits.
Combined format:
SrSlave Address R/W A Slave Address A Data A
First 7 bits Second byte
Data A/A Sr Slave Address R/W A Data A
First 7 bits
Data A P
(read)
(write)
Combined format - A master addresses a slave with a 10-bit address, then transmits
data to this slave and reads data from this slave.
A = acknowledge (SDA low)
A = not acknowledge (SDA high)
From master to slave
S = Start Condition
From slave to master
P = Stop Condition
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 71
PIC16C9XX
11.2.4 MULTI-MASTER
11.2.4.2 Clock Synchronization
Clock synchronization occurs after the devices have
2
The I C protocol allows a system to have more than
started arbitration. This is performed using
a
one master. This is called multi-master. When two or
more masters try to transfer data at the same time, arbi-
tration and synchronization occur.
wired-AND connection to the SCL line. A high to low
transition on the SCL line causes the concerned
devices to start counting off their low period. Once a
device clock has gone low, it will hold the SCL line low
until its SCL high state is reached.The low to high tran-
sition of this clock may not change the state of the SCL
line, if another device clock is still within its low period.
The SCL line is held low by the device with the longest
low period. Devices with shorter low periods enter a
high wait-state, until the SCL line comes high.When the
SCL line comes high, all devices start counting off their
high periods.The first device to complete its high period
will pull the SCL line low. The SCL line high time is
determined by the device with the shortest high period,
Figure 11-17.
11.2.4.1 ARBITRATION
Arbitration takes place on the SDA line, while the SCL
line is high.The master which transmits a high when the
other master transmits
(Figure 11-16), and turns off its data output stage. A
master which lost arbitration can generate clock pulses
until the end of the data byte where it lost arbitration.
When the master devices are addressing the same
device, arbitration continues into the data.
a low loses arbitration
FIGURE 11-16: MULTI-MASTER
ARBITRATION
(TWO MASTERS)
FIGURE 11-17: CLOCK SYNCHRONIZATION
transmitter 1 loses arbitration
DATA 1 SDA
start counting
HIGH period
wait
state
DATA 1
DATA 2
SDA
CLK
1
counter
reset
CLK
2
SCL
SCL
Masters that also incorporate the slave function, and
have lost arbitration must immediately switch over to
slave-receiver mode.This is because the winning mas-
ter-transmitter may be addressing it.
Arbitration is not allowed between:
• A repeated START condition
• A STOP condition and a data bit
• A repeated START condition and a STOP condi-
tion
Care needs to be taken to ensure that these conditions
do not occur.
DS30444E - page 72
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
2
2
The SSPCON register allows control of the I C opera-
11.3
SSP I C Operation
tion. Four mode selection bits (SSPCON<3:0>) allow
one of the following I C modes to be selected:
2
The SSP module in I C mode fully implements all slave
functions, except general call support, and provides
interrupts on start and stop bits in hardware to facilitate
firmware implementations of the master functions. The
SSP module implements the standard mode specifica-
tions as well as 7-bit and 10-bit addressing. Two pins
are used for data transfer.These are the RC3/SCK/SCL
pin, which is the clock (SCL), and the RC4/SDI/SDA
pin, which is the data (SDA). The user must configure
these pins as inputs or outputs through the
TRISC<4:3> bits. The SSP module functions are
enabled by setting SSP Enable bit SSPEN (SSP-
CON<5>).
2
2
• I C Slave mode (7-bit address)
2
• I C Slave mode (10-bit address)
2
• I C Slave mode (7-bit address), with start and
stop bit interrupts enabled
2
• I C Slave mode (10-bit address), with start and
stop bit interrupts enabled
2
• I C Firmware controlled Master Mode, slave is
idle
2
Selection of any I C mode, with the SSPEN bit set,
forces the SCL and SDA pins to be open drain, pro-
vided these pins are programmed to inputs by setting
the appropriate TRISC bits.
FIGURE 11-18: SSP BLOCK DIAGRAM
2
(I C MODE)
The SSPSTAT register gives the status of the data
transfer.This information includes detection of a START
or STOP bit, specifies if the received byte was data or
address if the next byte is the completion of 10-bit
address, and if this will be a read or write data transfer.
The SSPSTAT register is read only.
Internal
data bus
Read
Write
The SSPBUF is the register to which transfer data is
written to or read from. The SSPSR register shifts the
data in or out of the device. In receive operations, the
SSPBUF and SSPSR create a doubled buffered
receiver.This allows reception of the next byte to begin
before reading the last byte of received data. When the
complete byte is received, it is transferred to the
SSPBUF register and flag bit SSPIF is set. If another
complete byte is received before the SSPBUF register
is read, a receiver overflow has occurred and bit
SSPOV (SSPCON<6>) is set and the byte in the
SSPSR is lost.
SSPBUF reg
SSPSR reg
RC3/SCK/SCL
shift
clock
RC4/
SDI/
SDA
MSb
LSb
Addr Match
Match detect
SSPADD reg
The SSPADD register holds the slave address. In 10-bit
mode, the user needs to write the high byte of the
address (1111 0 A9 A8 0). Following the high byte
address match, the low byte of the address needs to be
loaded (A7:A0).
Set, Reset
S, P bits
Start and
Stop bit detect
(SSPSTAT reg)
2
The SSP module has five registers for I C operation.
These are the:
• SSP Control Register (SSPCON)
• SSP Status Register (SSPSTAT)
• Serial Receive/Transmit Buffer (SSPBUF)
• SSP Shift Register (SSPSR) - Not directly acces-
sible
• SSP Address Register (SSPADD)
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 73
PIC16C9XX
11.3.1 SLAVE MODE
address is compared on the falling edge of the eighth
clock (SCL) pulse. If the addresses match, and the BF
and SSPOV bits are clear, the following events occur:
In slave mode, the SCL and SDA pins must be config-
ured as inputs (TRISC<4:3> set). The SSP module will
override the input state with the output data when
required (slave-transmitter).
a) The SSPSR register value is loaded into the
SSPBUF register.
b) The buffer full bit, BF is set.
c) An ACK pulse is generated.
When an address is matched or the data transfer after
an address match is received, the hardware automati-
cally will generate the acknowledge (ACK) pulse, and
then load the SSPBUF register with the received value
currently in the SSPSR register.
d) SSP interrupt flag bit, SSPIF (PIR1<3>) is set
(interrupt is generated if enabled) - on the falling
edge of the ninth SCL pulse.
In 10-bit address mode, two address bytes need to be
received by the slave (Figure 11-10).The five Most Sig-
nificant bits (MSbs) of the first address byte specify if
this is a 10-bit address. Bit R/W (SSPSTAT<2>) must
specify a write so the slave device will receive the sec-
ond address byte. For a 10-bit address the first byte
would equal ‘1111 0 A9 A8 0’, where A9 and A8 are
the two MSbs of the address. The sequence of events
for a 10-bit address is as follows, with steps 7- 9 for
slave-transmitter:
There are certain conditions that will cause the SSP
module not to give this ACK pulse. These are if either
(or both):
a) The buffer full bit BF (SSPSTAT<0>) was set
before the transfer was received.
b) The overflow bit SSPOV (SSPCON<6>) was set
before the transfer was received.
In this case, the SSPSR register value is not loaded into
the SSPBUF, but bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>) is set.Table 11-3
shows what happens when a data transfer byte is
received, given the status of bits BF and SSPOV. The
shaded cells show the condition where user software
did not properly clear the overflow condition. Flag bit BF
is cleared by reading the SSPBUF register while bit
SSPOV is cleared through software.
1. Receive first (high) byte of Address (bits SSPIF,
BF, and bit UA (SSPSTAT<1>) are set).
2. Update the SSPADD register with second (low)
byte of Address (clears bit UA and releases the
SCL line).
3. Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and
clear flag bit SSPIF.
The SCL clock input must have a minimum high and
low time for proper operation.The high and low times of
4. Receive second (low) byte of Address (bits
SSPIF, BF, and UA are set).
2
the I C specification as well as the requirement of the
SSP module is shown in timing parameter #100 and
parameter #101.
5. Update the SSPADD register with the first (high)
byte of Address, if match releases SCL line, this
will clear bit UA.
11.3.1.1 ADDRESSING
6. Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and
clear flag bit SSPIF.
Once the SSP module has been enabled, it waits for a
START condition to occur. Following the START condi-
tion, the 8-bits are shifted into the SSPSR register. All
incoming bits are sampled with the rising edge of the
clock (SCL) line. The value of register SSPSR<7:1> is
compared to the value of the SSPADD register. The
7. Receive repeated START condition.
8. Receive first (high) byte of Address (bits SSPIF
and BF are set).
9. Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and
clear flag bit SSPIF.
TABLE 11-3: DATA TRANSFER RECEIVED BYTE ACTIONS
Status Bits as Data
Transfer is Received
Set bit SSPIF
(SSP Interrupt occurs
if enabled)
Generate ACK
Pulse
BF
SSPOV
SSPSR → SSPBUF
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
Yes
No
No
No
Yes
No
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
DS30444E - page 74
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
11.3.1.2 RECEPTION
An SSP interrupt is generated for each data transfer
byte. Flag bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>) must be cleared in soft-
ware. The SSPSTAT register is used to determine the
status of the byte.
When the R/W bit of the address byte is clear and an
address match occurs, the R/W bit of the SSPSTAT reg-
ister is cleared.The received address is loaded into the
SSPBUF register.
When the address byte overflow condition exists, then
no acknowledge (ACK) pulse is given. An overflow con-
dition is defined as either bit BF (SSPSTAT<0>) is set
or bit SSPOV (SSPCON<6>) is set.
2
FIGURE 11-19: I C WAVEFORMS FOR RECEPTION (7-BIT ADDRESS)
Receiving Address
A7 A6 A5 A4
R/W=0
Receiving Data
Receiving Data
ACK
9
ACK
9
ACK
9
SDA
SCL
A3 A2 A1
D5
D2
D0
8
D5
D2
D0
8
D7 D6
D4 D3
D7 D6
D4 D3
D1
7
D1
7
3
7
1
2
4
5
4
3
6
5
6
1
2
3
6
1
2
4
8
5
P
S
SSPIF (PIR1<3>)
Cleared in software
Bus Master
terminates
transfer
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
SSPBUF register is read
SSPOV (SSPCON<6>)
Bit SSPOV is set because the SSPBUF register is still full.
ACK is not sent.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 75
PIC16C9XX
11.3.1.3 TRANSMISSION
An SSP interrupt is generated for each data transfer
byte. Flag bit SSPIF must be cleared in software, and
the SSPSTAT register is used to determine the status of
the byte. Flag bit SSPIF is set on the falling edge of the
ninth clock pulse.
When the R/W bit of the incoming address byte is set
and an address match occurs, the R/W bit of the
SSPSTAT register is set. The received address is
loaded into the SSPBUF register.The ACK pulse will be
sent on the ninth bit, and pin RC3/SCK/SCL is held low.
The transmit data must be loaded into the SSPBUF
register, which also loads the SSPSR register.Then pin
RC3/SCK/SCL should be enabled by setting bit CKP
(SSPCON<4>). The master must monitor the SCL pin
prior to asserting another clock pulse. The slave
devices may be holding off the master by stretching the
clock. The eight data bits are shifted out on the falling
edge of the SCL input.This ensures that the SDA signal
is valid during the SCL high time (Figure 11-20).
As a slave-transmitter, the ACK pulse from the mas-
ter-receiver is latched on the rising edge of the ninth
SCL input pulse. If the SDA line was high (not ACK),
then the data transfer is complete. When the ACK is
latched by the slave, the slave logic is reset and the
slave then monitors for another occurrence of the
START bit. If the SDA line was low (ACK), the transmit
data must be loaded into the SSPBUF register, which
also loads the SSPSR register. Then pin
RC3/SCK/SCL should be enabled by setting bit CKP.
2
FIGURE 11-20: I C WAVEFORMS FOR TRANSMISSION (7-BIT ADDRESS)
Receiving Address
R/W = 1
ACK
Transmitting Data
ACK
9
SDA
SCL
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
P
SCL held low
while CPU
responds to SSPIF
Data in
sampled
cleared in software
SSPIF (PIR1<3>)
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
From SSP interrupt
service routine
SSPBUF is written in software
CKP (SSPCON<4>)
Set bit after writing to SSPBUF
(the SSPBUF must be written-to
before the CKP bit can be set)
DS30444E - page 76
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
11.3.2 MASTER MODE
11.3.3 MULTI-MASTER MODE
Master mode of operation is supported, in firmware,
using interrupt generation on the detection of the
START and STOP conditions. The STOP (P) and
START (S) bits are cleared from a reset or when the
SSP module is disabled.The STOP and START bits will
toggle based on the start and stop conditions. Control
In multi-master mode, the interrupt generation on the
detection of the START and STOP conditions allows the
determination of when the bus is free. The STOP (P)
and START (S) bits are cleared from a reset or when
the SSP module is disabled.The STOP and START bits
will toggle based on the start and stop conditions. Con-
2
2
of the I C bus may be taken when the P bit is set, or the
trol of the I C bus may be taken when bit P (SSP-
bus is idle with both the S and P bits clear.
STAT<4>) is set, or the bus is idle with both the S and
P bits clear. When the bus is busy, enabling the SSP
Interrupt will generate the interrupt when the STOP
condition occurs.
In master mode the SCL and SDA lines are manipu-
lated by clearing the corresponding TRISC<4:3> bit(s).
The output level is always low, irrespective of the
value(s) in PORTC<4:3>. So when transmitting data, a
'1' data bit must have the TRISC<4> bit set (input) and
a '0' data bit must have the TRISC<4> bit cleared (out-
put).The same scenario is true for the SCL line with the
TRISC<3> bit.
In multi-master operation, the SDA line must be moni-
tored to see if the signal level is the expected output
level. This check only needs to be done when a high
level is output. If a high level is expected and a low level
is present, the device needs to release the SDA and
SCL lines (set TRISC<4:3>). There are two stages
where this arbitration can be lost, they are:
The following events will cause SSP Interrupt Flag bit,
SSPIF, to be set (SSP Interrupt if enabled):
• Address Transfer
• Data Transfer
• START condition
• STOP condition
When the slave logic is enabled, the slave continues to
receive. If arbitration was lost during the address trans-
fer stage, communication to the device may be in
progress. If addressed an ACK pulse will be generated.
If arbitration was lost during the data transfer stage, the
device will need to re-transfer the data at a later time.
• Data transfer byte transmitted/received
Master mode of operation can be done with either the
slave mode idle (SSPM3:SSPM0 = 1011) or with the
slave active. When both master and slave modes are
enabled, the software needs to differentiate the
source(s) of the interrupt.
2
TABLE 11-4: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH I C OPERATION
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0000 000x
0000 000u
0Bh, 8Bh,
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
10Bh, 18Bh
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
xxxx xxxx
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
--11 1111
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
--11 1111
0Ch
8Ch
13h
93h
14h
94h
PIR1
LCDIF
LCDIE
ADIF(1)
ADIE(1)
—
—
—
—
SSPIF
CCP1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF
PIE1
SSPIE CCP1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE
SSPBUF
SSPADD
SSPCON
SSPSTAT
TRISC
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
Synchronous Serial Port (I2C mode) Address Register
WCOL
SMP
—
SSPOV SSPEN
CKP
P
SSPM3 SSPM2 SSPM1
R/W UA
SSPM0
BF
CKE
—
D/A
S
87h
PORTC Data Direction Control Register
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by SSP in I2C mode.
Note 1: Bits ADIE and ADIF are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 77
PIC16C9XX
2
FIGURE 11-21: OPERATION OF THE I C MODULE IN IDLE_MODE, RCV_MODE OR XMIT_MODE
IDLE_MODE (7-bit):
if (Addr_match)
{
Set interrupt;
if (R/W = 1)
{
}
Send ACK = 0;
set XMIT_MODE;
else if (R/W = 0) set RCV_MODE;
}
RCV_MODE:
if ((SSPBUF=Full) OR (SSPOV = 1))
{
Set SSPOV;
Do not acknowledge;
}
{
else
transfer SSPSR → SSPBUF;
send ACK = 0;
}
Receive 8-bits in SSPSR;
Set interrupt;
XMIT_MODE:
While ((SSPBUF = Empty) AND (CKP=0)) Hold SCL Low;
Send byte;
Set interrupt;
if ( ACK Received = 1)
{
}
End of transmission;
Go back to IDLE_MODE;
else if ( ACK Received = 0) Go back to XMIT_MODE;
IDLE_MODE (10-Bit):
If (High_byte_addr_match AND (R/W = 0))
{
PRIOR_ADDR_MATCH = FALSE;
Set interrupt;
if ((SSPBUF = Full) OR ((SSPOV = 1))
{
Set SSPOV;
Do not acknowledge;
}
{
else
Set UA = 1;
Send ACK = 0;
While (SSPADD not updated) Hold SCL low;
Clear UA = 0;
Receive Low_addr_byte;
Set interrupt;
Set UA = 1;
If (Low_byte_addr_match)
{
PRIOR_ADDR_MATCH = TRUE;
Send ACK = 0;
while (SSPADD not updated) Hold SCL low;
Clear UA = 0;
Set RCV_MODE;
}
}
}
else if (High_byte_addr_match AND (R/W = 1)
if (PRIOR_ADDR_MATCH)
{
{
send ACK = 0;
set XMIT_MODE;
}
else PRIOR_ADDR_MATCH = FALSE;
}
DS30444E - page 78
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
The A/D module has three registers. These registers
are:
12.0 ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER (A/D) MODULE
• A/D Result Register (ADRES)
• A/D Control Register 0 (ADCON0)
• A/D Control Register 1 (ADCON1)
This section applies to the PIC16C924 only.
The analog-to-digital (A/D) converter module has five
inputs.
The ADCON0 register, shown in Figure 12-1, controls
the operation of the A/D module. The ADCON1 regis-
ter, shown in Figure 12-2, configures the functions of
the port pins. The port pins can be configured as ana-
log inputs (RA3 can also be a voltage reference) or as
digital I/O.
The A/D allows conversion of an analog input signal to
a corresponding 8-bit digital number (refer to Applica-
tion Note AN546 for use of A/D Converter). The output
of the sample and hold is the input into the converter,
which generates the result via successive approxima-
tion. The analog reference voltage is software select-
able to either the device’s AVDD pin or the voltage level
on the RA3/AN3/VREF pin. The A/D converter has a
unique feature of being able to operate while the device
is in SLEEP mode.
To operate in sleep, the A/D conversion clock must be
derived from the A/D’s internal RC oscillator.
FIGURE 12-1: ADCON0 REGISTER (ADDRESS 1Fh)
R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0
ADCS1 ADCS0 CHS2
bit7
R/W-0
CHS1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
R/W-0
ADON
CHS0 GO/DONE
R =Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U =Unimplemented bit,
read as ‘0’
bit0
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7-6: ADCS1:ADCS0: A/D Conversion Clock Select bits
00= FOSC/2
01= FOSC/8
10= FOSC/32
11= FRC (clock derived from an RC oscillation)
bit 5-3: CHS2:CHS0: Analog Channel Select bits
000= channel 0, (RA0/AN0)
001= channel 1, (RA1/AN1)
010= channel 2, (RA2/AN2)
011= channel 3, (RA3/AN3)
100= channel 4, (RA5/AN4)
bit 2:
GO/DONE: A/D Conversion Status bit
If ADON = 1
1 = A/D conversion in progress (setting this bit starts the A/D conversion)
0 = A/D conversion not in progress (This bit is automatically cleared by hardware when the A/D conversion
is complete)
bit 1:
bit 0:
Reserved: Always maintain this bit clear
ADON: A/D On bit
1 = A/D converter module is operating
0 = A/D converter module is shutoff and consumes no operating current
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 79
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 12-2: ADCON1 REGISTER (ADDRESS 9Fh)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
R =Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U =Unimplemented
bit, read as ‘0’
bit7
bit0
- n = Value at POR reset
bit 7-3: Unimplemented: Read as '0'
bit 2-0: PCFG2:PCFG0: A/D Port Configuration Control bits
PCFG2:PCFG0
RA0
RA1
RA2
RA5
RA3
VREF
000
001
010
011
100
111
A
A
A
A
A
AVDD
RA3
AVDD
RA3
AVDD
—
A
A
A
A
D
A
A
A
A
D
A
A
A
D
D
A
A
A
D
D
VREF
A
VREF
A
D
A = Analog input
D = Digital I/O
The ADRES register contains the result of the A/D con-
version. When the A/D conversion is complete, the
result is loaded into the ADRES register, the GO/DONE
bit (ADCON0<2>) is cleared, and A/D interrupt flag bit
ADIF is set. The block diagram of the A/D module is
shown in Figure 12-3.
3. Wait the required acquisition time.
4. Start conversion:
• Set GO/DONE bit (ADCON0)
5. Wait for A/D conversion to complete, by either:
• Polling for the GO/DONE bit to be cleared
OR
After the A/D module has been configured as desired,
the selected channel must be acquired before the con-
version is started. The analog input channels must
have their corresponding TRIS bits selected as an
input. To determine acquisition time, see Section 12.1.
After this acquisition time has elapsed the A/D conver-
sion can be started. The following steps should be fol-
lowed for doing an A/D conversion:
• Waiting for the A/D interrupt
6. Read A/D Result register (ADRES), clear bit
ADIF if required.
7. For next conversion, go to step 1 or step 2 as
required. The A/D conversion time per bit is
defined as TAD. A minimum wait of 2TAD is
required before next acquisition starts.
1. Configure the A/D module:
• Configure analog pins / voltage reference /
and digital I/O (ADCON1)
• Select A/D input channel (ADCON0)
• Select A/D conversion clock (ADCON0)
• Turn on A/D module (ADCON0)
2. Configure A/D interrupt (if desired):
• Clear ADIF bit
• Set ADIE bit
• Set GIE bit
DS30444E - page 80
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 12-3: A/D BLOCK DIAGRAM
CHS2:CHS0
100
011
010
001
000
RA5/AN4
RA3/AN3/VREF
RA2/AN2
VAIN
(Input voltage)
A/D
Converter
RA1/AN1
AVDD
RA0/AN0
000or
010or
100
VREF
(Reference
voltage)
001or
011
PCFG2:PCFG0
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 81
PIC16C9XX
12.1
A/D Acquisition Requirements
Note 1: The reference voltage (VREF) has no
effect on the equation, since it cancels
itself out.
For the A/D converter to meet its specified accuracy,
the charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed
to fully charge to the input channel voltage level. The
analog input model is shown in Figure 12-4.The source
impedance (RS) and the internal sampling switch (RSS)
impedance directly affect the time required to charge
the capacitor CHOLD.The sampling switch (RSS) imped-
ance varies over the device voltage (VDD),
(Figure 12-4). The source impedance affects the offset
voltage at the analog input (due to pin leakage current).
The maximum recommended impedance for ana-
log sources is 10 kΩ. After the analog input channel is
selected (changed) this acquisition must be done
before the conversion can be started.
Note 2: The charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) is
not discharged after each conversion.
Note 3: The maximum recommended impedance
for analog sources is 10 kΩ. This is
required to meet the pin leakage specifi-
cation.
Note 4: After a conversion has completed, a
2.0 TAD delay must complete before
acquisition can begin again. During this
time the holding capacitor is not con-
nected to the selected A/D input channel.
To calculate the minimum acquisition time,
Equation 12-1 may be used. This equation calculates
the acquisition time to within 1/2 LSb error (512 steps
for the A/D). The 1/2 LSb error is the maximum error
allowed for the A/D to meet its specified accuracy.
EXAMPLE 12-1: CALCULATING THE
MINIMUM REQUIRED
SAMPLE TIME
TACQ = Amplifier Settling Time +
Holding Capacitor Charging Time +
Temperature Coefficient
EQUATION 12-1: A/D MINIMUM CHARGING
TIME
TACQ = 5 µs + Tc + [(Temp - 25°C)(0.05 µs/°C)]
(-Tc/CHOLD(RIC + RSS + RS))
VHOLD = (VREF - (VREF/512)) • (1 - e
)
TC =
-CHOLD (RIC + RSS + RS) ln(1/511)
-51.2 pF (1 kΩ + 7 kΩ + 10 kΩ) ln(0.0020)
-51.2 pF (18 kΩ) ln(0.0020)
-0.921 µs (-6.2364)
Given: VHOLD = (VREF/512), for 1/2 LSb resolution
The above equation reduces to:
TC = -(51.2 pF)(1 kΩ - RSS + RS) ln(1/511)
Example 12-1 shows the calculation of the minimum
required acquisition time (TACQ). This calculation is
based on the following system assumptions.
5.747 µs
TACQ = 5 µs + 5.747 µs + [(50°C - 25°C)(0.05 µs/°C)]
CHOLD = 51.2 pF
10.747 µs + 1.25 µs
11.997 µs
Rs = 10 kΩ
1/2 LSb error
VDD = 5V → Rss = 7 kΩ
Temp (system max.) = 50°C
VHOLD = 0 @ t = 0
FIGURE 12-4: ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
Sampling
Switch
VT = 0.6V
RAx
SS
RIC ≤ 1k
RSS
Rs
CHOLD
= DAC capacitance
= 51.2 pF
CPIN
5 pF
VA
I leakage
± 500 nA
VT = 0.6V
VSS
Legend CPIN
VT
= input capacitance
= threshold voltage
6V
5V
I leakage = leakage current at the pin due to
various junctions
VDD 4V
3V
2V
RIC
SS
= interconnect resistance
= sampling switch
CHOLD
= sample/hold capacitance (from DAC)
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Sampling Switch
( kΩ )
DS30444E - page 82
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
12.2
Selecting the A/D Conversion Clock
12.3
Configuring Analog Port Pins
The A/D conversion time per bit is defined as TAD. The
A/D conversion requires 9.5 TAD per 8-bit conversion.
The source of the A/D conversion clock is software
selected. The four possible options for TAD are:
The ADCON1 and TRISA registers control the opera-
tion of the A/D port pins. The port pins that are desired
as analog inputs must have their corresponding TRIS
bits set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared (output), the
digital output level (VOH or VOL) will be converted.
• 2TOSC
The A/D operation is independent of the state of the
CHS2:CHS0 bits and the TRIS bits.
• 8TOSC
• 32TOSC
• Internal RC oscillator
Note 1: When reading the port register, all pins
configured as analog inputs will read as
cleared (a low level). Pins configured as
digital inputs, will convert an analog input.
Analog levels on a digitally configured
input will not affect the conversion accu-
racy.
For correct A/D conversions, the A/D conversion clock
(TAD) must be selected to ensure a minimum TAD time
of 1.6 µs.
Table 12-1 shows the resultant TAD times derived from
the device operating frequencies and the A/D clock
source selected.
Note 2: Analog levels on any pin that is defined as
a digital input (including the AN4:AN0
pins), may cause the input buffer to con-
sume current that is out of the devices
specification.
TABLE 12-1: TAD vs. DEVICE OPERATING FREQUENCIES
A/D Clock Source (TAD)
Device Frequency
5 MHz 1.25 MHz
Operation
ADCS1:ADCS0
8 MHz
333.33 kHz
(2)
(2)
2TOSC
8TOSC
32TOSC
RC
00
01
10
11
250 ns
1 µs
400 ns
1.6 µs
6.4 µs
6 µs
(3)
1.6 µs
6.4 µs
24 µs
(3)
(3)
4 µs
25.6 µs
96 µs
(1,4)
(1,4)
(1,4)
(1)
2 - 6 µs
2 - 6 µs
2 - 6 µs
2 - 6 µs
Legend: Shaded cells are outside of recommended range.
Note 1: The RC source has a typical TAD time of 4 µs.
2: These values violate the minimum required TAD time.
3: For faster conversion times, the selection of another clock source is recommended.
4: When derived frequency is greater than 1 MHz, the RC A/D conversion clock source is recommended for
sleep mode only
5: For extended voltage devices (LC), please refer to the electrical specifications section.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 83
PIC16C9XX
Clearing the GO/DONE bit during a conversion will
abort the current conversion. The ADRES register will
NOT be updated with the partially completed A/D con-
version sample. That is, the ADRES register will con-
tinue to contain the value of the last completed
conversion (or the last value written to the ADRES reg-
ister). After the A/D conversion is aborted, a 2TAD wait
is required before the next acquisition is started. After
this 2TAD wait, an acquisition is automatically started on
the selected channel.
12.4
A/D Conversions
Example 12-2 show how to perform an A/D conversion.
The RA pins are configured as analog inputs.The ana-
log reference (VREF) is the device VDD. The A/D inter-
rupt is enabled, and the A/D conversion clock is FRC.
The conversion is performed on the RA0 pin
(channel0).
Note: The GO/DONE bit should NOT be set in
the same instruction that turns on the A/D.
EXAMPLE 12-2: DOING AN A/D CONVERSION
BCF
BSF
CLRF
BSF
BCF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BCF
BSF
BSF
STATUS, RP1
STATUS, RP0
ADCON1
; Select Bank1
;
; Configure A/D inputs
; Enable A/D interrupts
; Select Bank0
; RC Clock, A/D is on, Channel 0 is selected
;
; Clear A/D interrupt flag bit
; Enable peripheral interrupts
; Enable all interrupts
PIE1,
ADIE
STATUS, RP0
0xC1
ADCON0
PIR1,
ADIF
INTCON, PEIE
INTCON, GIE
;
;
;
;
Ensure that the required acquisition time for the selected input channel has elapsed.
Then the conversion may be started.
BSF
:
ADCON0, GO
; Start A/D Conversion
; The ADIF bit will be set and the GO/DONE bit
:
;
is cleared upon completion of the A/D Conversion.
DS30444E - page 84
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
12.4.1 FASTER CONVERSION - LOWER
RESOLUTION TRADE-OFF
Since the TAD is based from the device oscillator, the
user must use some method (a timer, software loop,
etc.) to determine when the A/D oscillator may be
changed. Example 12-3 shows a comparison of time
required for a conversion with 4-bits of resolution, ver-
sus the 8-bit resolution conversion. The example is for
devices operating at 8 MHz (The A/D clock is pro-
grammed for 32TOSC), and assumes that immediately
after 6TAD, the A/D clock is programmed for 2TOSC.
Not all applications require a result with 8-bits of reso-
lution, but may instead require a faster conversion time.
The A/D module allows users to make the trade-off of
conversion speed to resolution. Regardless of the res-
olution required, the acquisition time is the same. To
speed up the conversion, the clock source of the A/D
module may be switched so that the TAD time violates
the minimum specified time (see the applicable electri-
cal specification). Once the TAD time violates the mini-
mum specified time, all the following A/D result bits are
not valid (see A/D Conversion Timing in the Electrical
Specifications section.) The clock sources may only be
switched between the three oscillator versions (cannot
be switched from/to RC). The equation to determine
the time before the oscillator can be switched is as fol-
lows:
The 2TOSC violates the minimum TAD time, therefore
the last 4-bits will not be converted to correct values.
Conversion time = 2TAD + N • TAD + (8 - N)(2TOSC)
Where: N = number of bits of resolution required.
EXAMPLE 12-3: 4-BIT vs. 8-BIT CONVERSION TIMES
Resolution
Freq. (MHz)
4-bit
8-bit
TAD
8
8
8
1.6 µs
12.5 ns
10.6 µs
1.6 µs
125 ns
16 µs
TOSC
2TAD + N • TAD + (8 - N)(2TOSC)
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 85
PIC16C9XX
scale error is that full scale does not take offset error
into account. Gain error can be calibrated out in soft-
ware.
12.5
A/D Operation During Sleep
The A/D module can operate during SLEEP mode.This
requires that the A/D clock source be set to RC
(ADCS1:ADCS0 = 11). When the RC clock source is
selected, the A/D module waits one instruction cycle
before starting the conversion. This allows the SLEEP
instruction to be executed, which eliminates all digital
switching noise from the conversion. When the conver-
sion is completed the GO/DONE bit will be cleared, and
the result loaded into the ADRES register. If the A/D
interrupt is enabled, the device will wake-up from
SLEEP. If the A/D interrupt is not enabled, the A/D mod-
ule will then be turned off, although the ADON bit will
remain set.
Linearity error refers to the uniformity of the code
changes. Linearity errors cannot be calibrated out of
the system. Integral non-linearity error measures the
actual code transition versus the ideal code transition
adjusted by the gain error for each code.
Differential non-linearity measures the maximum actual
code width versus the ideal code width. This measure
is unadjusted.
The maximum pin leakage current is ± 1 µA.
In systems where the device frequency is low, use of
the A/D RC clock is preferred. At moderate to high fre-
quencies, TAD should be derived from the device oscil-
lator. TAD must not violate the minimum and should be
≤ 8 µs for preferred operation. This is because TAD,
when derived from TOSC, is kept away from on-chip
phase clock transitions.This reduces, to a large extent,
the effects of digital switching noise.This is not possible
with the RC derived clock. The loss of accuracy due to
digital switching noise can be significant if many I/O
pins are active.
When the A/D clock source is another clock option (not
RC), a SLEEPinstruction will cause the present conver-
sion to be aborted and the A/D module to be turned off,
though the ADON bit will remain set.
Turning off the A/D places the A/D module in its lowest
current consumption state.
Note: For the A/D module to operate in SLEEP,
the A/D clock source must be set to RC
(ADCS1:ADCS0 = 11). To perform an A/D
conversion in SLEEP, ensure the SLEEP
instruction immediately follows the instruc-
tion that sets the GO/DONE bit.
In systems where the device will enter SLEEP mode
after the start of the A/D conversion, the RC clock
source selection is required. In this mode, the digital
noise from the modules in SLEEP are stopped. This
method gives high accuracy.
12.6
A/D Accuracy/Error
The absolute accuracy specified for the A/D converter
includes the sum of all contributions for quantization
error, integral error, differential error, full scale error, off-
set error, and monotonicity. It is defined as the maxi-
mum deviation from an actual transition versus an ideal
transition for any code. The absolute error of the A/D
converter is specified at < ±1 LSb for VDD = VREF (over
the device’s specified operating range). However, the
accuracy of the A/D converter will degrade as VDD
diverges from VREF.
12.7
Effects of a RESET
A device reset forces all registers to their reset state.
This forces the A/D module to be turned off, and any
conversion is aborted.
The value that is in the ADRES register is not modified
for a Power-on Reset. The ADRES register will contain
unknown data after a Power-on Reset.
For a given range of analog inputs, the output digital
code will be the same.This is due to the quantization of
the analog input to a digital code. Quantization error is
typically ± 1/2 LSb and is inherent in the analog to dig-
ital conversion process.The only way to reduce quanti-
zation error is to increase the resolution of the A/D
converter.
Offset error measures the first actual transition of a
code versus the first ideal transition of a code. Offset
error shifts the entire transfer function. Offset error can
be calibrated out of a system or introduced into a sys-
tem through the interaction of the total leakage current
and source impedance at the analog input.
Gain error measures the maximum deviation of the last
actual transition and the last ideal transition adjusted for
offset error. This error appears as a change in slope of
the transfer function. The difference in gain error to full
DS30444E - page 86
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
12.8
Use of the CCP Trigger
12.10 Transfer Function
An A/D conversion can be started by the “special event
trigger” of the CCP1 module. This requires that the
CCP1M3:CCP1M0 bits (CCP1CON<3:0>) be pro-
grammed as 1011and that the A/D module is enabled
(ADON bit is set). When the trigger occurs, the
GO/DONE bit will be set, starting the A/D conversion,
and the Timer1 counter will be reset to zero. Timer1 is
reset to automatically repeat the A/D acquisition period
with minimal software overhead (moving the ADRES to
the desired location). The appropriate analog input
channel must be selected and the minimum acquisition
done before the “special event trigger” sets the
GO/DONE bit (starts a conversion).
The ideal transfer function of the A/D converter is as fol-
lows: the first transition occurs when the analog input
voltage (VAIN) is Analog VREF / 256 (Figure 12-5).
FIGURE 12-5: A/D TRANSFER FUNCTION
FFh
FEh
If the A/D module is not enabled (ADON is cleared),
then the “special event trigger” will be ignored by the
A/D module, but will still reset the Timer1 counter.
04h
03h
02h
01h
00h
12.9
Connection Considerations
If the input voltage exceeds the rail values (VSS or VDD)
by greater than 0.2V, then the accuracy of the conver-
sion is out of specification.
An external RC filter is sometimes added for anti-alias-
ing of the input signal. The R component should be
selected to ensure that the total source impedance is
kept under the 10 kΩ recommended specification. Any
external components connected (via hi-impedance) to
an analog input pin (capacitor, zener diode, etc.) should
have very little leakage current at the pin.
Analog input voltage
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 87
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 12-6: FLOWCHART OF A/D OPERATION
ADON = 0
Yes
ADON = 0?
No
Acquire
Selected Channel
Yes
GO = 0?
No
Yes
Yes
Start of A/D
Conversion Delayed
1 Instruction Cycle
Finish Conversion
SLEEP
Instruction?
A/D Clock
= RC?
GO = 0
ADIF = 1
No
No
Yes
Yes
Abort Conversion
GO = 0
Wake-up
From Sleep?
Finish Conversion
Device in
SLEEP?
Wait 2 TAD
GO = 0
ADIF = 1
ADIF = 0
No
No
SLEEP
Power-down A/D
Finish Conversion
Stay in Sleep
Power-down A/D
Wait 2 TAD
GO = 0
ADIF = 1
Wait 2 TAD
TABLE 12-2: SUMMARY OF A/D REGISTERS
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on all
other Resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0000 000x
0000 000u
0Bh, 8Bh,
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
10Bh, 18Bh
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
xxxx xxxx
0000 0000
---- -000
--0x 0000
--11 1111
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
---- -000
--0u 0000
--11 1111
0Ch
8Ch
1Eh
1Fh
9Fh
05h
PIR1
LCDIF
LCDIE
ADIF
ADIE
—
—
—
—
SSPIF
SSPIE
CCP1IF
CCP1IE
TMR2IF TMR1IF
TMR2IE TMR1IE
PIE1
ADRES
ADCON0
ADCON1
PORTA
TRISA
A/D Result Register
ADCS1 ADCS0
(1)
CHS2
—
CHS1
—
CHS0
—
GO/DONE
PCFG2
RA2
ADON
—
—
—
—
—
—
PCFG1
RA1
PCFG0
RA0
RA5
RA4
RA3
85h
PORTA Data Direction Control Register
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used for A/D conversion.
Note 1: Bit1 of ADCON0 is reserved, always maintain this bit clear.
DS30444E - page 88
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
Once the module is initialized for the LCD panel, the
individual bits of the LCD data registers are cleared/set
to represent a clear/dark pixel respectively.
13.0 LCD MODULE
The LCD module generates the timing control to drive
a static or multiplexed LCD panel, with support for up to
32 segments multiplexed with up to 4 commons. It also
provides control of the LCD pixel data.
Once the module is configured, the LCDEN
(LCDCON<7>) bit is used to enable or disable the LCD
module. The LCD panel can also operate during sleep
by clearing the SLPEN (LCDCON<6>) bit.
The interface to the module consists of 3 control regis-
ters (LCDCON, LCDSE, and LCDPS) used to define
the timing requirements of the LCD panel and up to 16
LCD data registers (LCD00-LCD15) that represent the
array of the pixel data. In normal operation, the control
registers are configured to match the LCD panel being
used. Primarily, the initialization information consists of
selecting the number of commons required by the LCD
panel, and then specifying the LCD Frame clock rate to
be used by the panel.
Figure 13-4 through Figure 13-7 provides waveforms
for Static, 1/2, 1/3, and 1/4 MUX drives.
FIGURE 13-1: LCDCON REGISTER (ADDRESS 10Fh)
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
—
R/W-0
VGEN
R/W-0 R/W-0
CS1 CS0
R/W-0
R/W-0
LCDEN SLPEN
bit7
LMUX1 LMUX0
bit0
R =Readable bit
W =Writable bit
U =Unimplemented bit,
Read as ‘0’
-n =Value at POR reset
bit 7:
bit 6:
LCDEN: Module drive enable bit
1 = LCD drive enabled
0 = LCD drive disabled
SLPEN: LCD display sleep enable
1 = LCD module will stop operating during SLEEP
0 = LCD module will continue to display during SLEEP
bit 5:
bit 4:
Unimplemented: Read as '0'
VGEN: Voltage Generator Enable
1 = Internal LCD Voltage Generator Enabled, (powered-up)
0 = Internal LCD Voltage Generator powered-down, voltage is expected to be provided externally
bit 3-2: CS1:CS0: Clock Source Select bits
00 = Fosc/256
01 = T1CKI (Timer1)
1x = Internal RC oscillator
bit 1-0: LMUX1:LMUX0: Common Selection bits
Specifies the number of commons and the bias method
LMUX1:LMUX0
MULTIPLEX
BIAS
Max # of Segments
00
01
10
11
Static (COM0)
Static
1/3
1/3
32
31
30
29
1/2
1/3
1/4
(COM0, 1)
(COM0, 1, 2)
(COM0, 1, 2, 3) 1/3
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 89
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 13-2: LCD MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM
128
to
LCD
RAM
32 x 4
SEG<31:0>
Data Bus
TO I/O PADS
32
MUX
Timing Control
LCDCON
LCDPS
LCDSE
COM3:COM0
TO I/O PADS
Internal RC osc
T1CKI
Clock
Source
Select
and
Fosc/4
Divide
FIGURE 13-3: LCDPS REGISTER (ADDRESS 10Eh)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0
LP3 LP2 LP1 LP0
bit0
R =Readable bit
W =Writable bit
U =Unimplemented bit, Read as ‘0’
-n =Value at POR reset
bit7
bit 7-4: Unimplemented, read as '0'
bit 3-0: LP3:LP0: Frame Clock Prescale Selection bits
LMUX1:LMUX0
Multiplex
Frame Frequency =
00
01
10
11
Static
1/2
Clock source / (128 * (LP3:LP0 + 1))
Clock source / (128 * (LP3:LP0 + 1))
Clock source / (96 * (LP3:LP0 + 1))
Clock source / (128 * (LP3:LP0 + 1))
1/3
1/4
DS30444E - page 90
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 13-4: WAVEFORMS IN STATIC DRIVE
V1
COM0
V0
V1
COM0
SEG0
SEG1
V0
V1
V0
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
V0
1 Frame
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 91
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 13-5: WAVEFORMS IN 1/2 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0
COM1
COM0
COM1
SEG0
SEG1
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
-V3
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
-V3
1 Frame
DS30444E - page 92
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 13-6: WAVEFORMS IN 1/3 MUX, 1/3 BIAS
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0
COM2
COM1
COM1
COM0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
COM2
SEG0
SEG1
COM0-SEG0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
-V3
1 Frame
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 93
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 13-7: WAVEFORMS IN 1/4 MUX, 1/3 BIAS
COM3
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM2
COM0
COM1
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM1
COM0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM2
COM3
SEG0
SEG1
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
-V3
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
1 Frame
DS30444E - page 94
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
The second source is the Timer1 external oscillator.
This oscillator provides a lower speed clock which may
be used to continue running the LCD while the proces-
sor is in sleep. It is assumed that the frequency pro-
vided on this oscillator will be 32 kHz. To use the
Timer1 oscillator as a LCD module clock source, it is
only necessary to set the T1OSCEN (T1CON<3>) bit.
13.1
LCD Timing
The LCD module has 3 possible clock source inputs
and supports static, 1/2, 1/3, and 1/4 multiplexing.
13.1.1 TIMING CLOCK SOURCE SELECTION
The clock sources for the LCD timing generation are:
The third source is the system clock divided by 256.
This divider ratio is chosen to provide about 32 kHz
output when the external oscillator is 8 MHz. The
divider is not programmable. Instead the LCDPS regis-
ter is used to set the LCD frame clock rate.
• Internal RC oscillator
• Timer1 oscillator
• System clock divided by 256
The first timing source is an internal RC oscillator which
runs at a nominal frequency of 14 kHz. This oscillator
provides a lower speed clock which may be used to
continue running the LCD while the processor is in
sleep. The RC oscillator will power-down when it is not
selected or when the LCD module is disabled.
All of the clock sources are selected with bits CS1:CS0
(LCDCON<3:2>). Refer to Figure 13-1 for details of the
register programming.
FIGURE 13-8: LCD CLOCK GENERATION
FOSC
÷256
TMR1 32 kHz
crystal oscillator
Static
1/2
÷4
÷2
÷1,2,3,4
Ring Counter
÷32
4-bit Programmable
Prescaler
1/3
1/4
Internal RC oscillator
Nominal FRC = 14 kHz
LCDPS<3:0>
LMUX1:LMUX0
LMUX1:LMUX0
CS1:CS0
internal
data bus
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 95
PIC16C9XX
13.1.2 MULTIPLEX TIMING GENERATION
TABLE 13-2: APPROX. FRAME FREQ IN Hz
USINGTIMER1 @ 32.768 kHz OR
Fosc @ 8 MHz
The timing generation circuitry will generate 1 to 4 com-
mon clocks based on the display mode selected. The
mode is specified by bits LMUX1:LMUX0
(LCDCON<1:0>). Table 13-1 shows the formulas for
calculating the frame frequency.
LP3:LP0
Static
1/2
1/3
1/4
2
3
4
5
6
7
85
64
51
43
37
32
85
64
51
43
37
32
114
85
68
57
49
43
85
64
51
43
37
32
TABLE 13-1: FRAME FREQUENCY
FORMULAS
Multiplex Frame Frequency =
Static
1/2
Clock source / (128 * (LP3:LP0 + 1))
Clock source / (128 * (LP3:LP0 + 1))
Clock source / (96 * (LP3:LP0 + 1))
Clock source / (128 * (LP3:LP0 + 1))
1/3
TABLE 13-3: APPROX. FRAME FREQ IN Hz
USING INTERNAL RC OSC @
14 kHz
1/4
LP3:LP0
Static
1/2
1/3
1/4
0
1
2
3
109
55
109
55
146
73
109
55
36
36
49
36
27
27
36
27
DS30444E - page 96
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
A new frame is defined to begin at the leading edge of
the COM0 common signal. The interrupt will be set
immediately after the LCD controller completes
accessing all pixel data required for a frame. This will
occur at a certain fixed time before the frame boundary
as shown in Figure 13-9. The LCD controller will begin
to access data for the next frame within TFWR after the
interrupt.
13.2
LCD Interrupts
The LCD timing generation provides an interrupt that
defines the LCD frame timing. This interrupt can be
used to coordinate the writing of the pixel data with the
start of a new frame. Writing pixel data at the frame
boundary allows a visually crisp transition of the image.
This interrupt can also be used to synchronize external
events to the LCD. For example, the interface to an
external segment driver, such as a Microchip AY0438,
can be synchronized for segment data update to the
LCD frame.
FIGURE 13-9: EXAMPLE WAVEFORMS IN 1/4 MUX DRIVE
LCD
Interrupt
occurs
Controller accesses
next frame data
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0
COM1
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM2
COM3
V3
V2
V1
V0
1 Frame
TFINT
Frame
Boundary
Frame
Boundary
TFWR
TFWR = TFRAME/(LMUX1:LMUX0 + 1)
TFINT = (TFWR /2 - (2TCY + 40 ns)) → min.
(TFWR /2 - (1TCY + 40 ns)) → max.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 97
PIC16C9XX
Table 13-4 shows the correlation of each bit in the
LCDD registers to the respective common and seg-
ment signals.
13.3
Pixel Control
13.3.1 LCDD (PIXEL DATA) REGISTERS
Any LCD pixel location not being used for display can
be used as general purpose RAM.
The pixel registers contain bits which define the state of
each pixel. Each bit defines one unique pixel.
FIGURE 13-10:GENERIC LCDD REGISTER LAYOUT
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
SEGs
COMc
SEGs
COMc
SEGs
COMc
SEGs
COMc
SEGs
COMc
SEGs
COMc
SEGs
COMc
SEGs
COMc
R =Readable bit
W =Writable bit
U =Unimplemented bit,
Read as ‘0’
bit7
bit0
-n =Value at POR reset
bit 7-0: SEGsCOMc: Pixel Data Bit for segment s and common c
1 = Pixel on (dark)
0 = Pixel off (clear)
DS30444E - page 98
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
The LCD interrupt can be used to determine the frame
boundary. See Section 13.2 for the formulas to calcu-
late the delay.
13.4
Operation During Sleep
The LCD module can operate during sleep. The selec-
tion is controlled by bit SLPEN (LCDCON<6>). Setting
the SLPEN bit allows the LCD module to go to sleep.
Clearing the SLPEN bit allows the module to continue
to operate during sleep.
If a SLEEPinstruction is executed and SLPEN = '0', the
module will continue to display the current contents of
the LCDD registers. To allow the module to continue
operation while in sleep, the clock source must be
either the internal RC oscillator or Timer1 external
oscillator. While in sleep, the LCD data cannot be
changed. The LCD module current consumption will
not decrease in this mode, however the overall con-
sumption of the device will be lower due to shutdown of
the core and other peripheral functions.
If a SLEEPinstruction is executed and SLPEN = '1', the
LCD module will cease all functions and go into a very
low current consumption mode. The module will stop
operation immediately and drive the minimum LCD
voltage on both segment and common lines. Figure
13-11 shows this operation. To ensure that the LCD
completes the frame, the SLEEPinstruction should be
executed immediately after a LCD frame boundary.
Note: The internal RC oscillator or external
Timer1 oscillator must be used to operate
the LCD module during sleep.
FIGURE 13-11:SLEEP ENTRY/EXIT WHEN SLPEN = 1 OR CS1:CS0 = 00
3/3V
2/3V
1/3V
Pin
COM0
0/3V
3/3V
2/3V
1/3V
0/3V
3/3V
2/3V
1/3V
0/3V
Pin
COM1
Pin
COM3
3/3V
2/3V
Pin
SEG0
1/3V
0/3V
interrupted
frame
Wake-up
SLEEPinstruction execution
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 99
PIC16C9XX
13.4.1 SEGMENT ENABLES
EXAMPLE 13-1: STATIC MUX WITH 32
SEGMENTS
The LCDSE register is used to select the pin function
for groups of pins. The selection allows each group of
pins to operate as either LCD drivers or digital only
pins. To configure the pins as a digital port, the corre-
sponding bits in the LCDSE register must be cleared.
BCF
BSF
BCF
BCF
STATUS,RP0
STATUS,RP1
LCDCON,LMUX1 ;Select Static MUX
LCDCON,LMUX0 ;
;Select Bank 2
;
MOVLW 0xFF
MOVWF LCDSE
. . .
;Make PortD,E,F,G
;LCD pins
;configure rest of LCD
If the pin is a digital I/O the correspondingTRIS bit con-
trols the data direction. Any bit set in the LCDSE regis-
ter overrides any bit settings in the corresponding TRIS
register.
EXAMPLE 13-2: 1/3 MUX WITH 13
SEGMENTS
Note 1: On a Power-on Reset these pins are con-
figured as LCD drivers.
BCF
BSF
BSF
BCF
MOVLW 0x87
MOVWF LCDSE
. . .
STATUS,RP0
STATUS,RP1
LCDCON,LMUX1 ;Select 1/3 MUX
LCDCON,LMUX0 ;
;Select Bank 2
;
Note 2: The LMUX1:LMUX0 takes precedence
over the LCDSE bit settings for pins RD7,
RD6 and RD5.
;Make PORTD<7:0> &
;PORTE<6:0> LCD pins
;configure rest of LCD
FIGURE 13-12:LCDSE REGISTER (ADDRESS 10Dh)
R/W-1
SE29
R/W-1
SE27
R/W-1
SE20
R/W-1
SE16
R/W-1 R/W-1
SE12 SE9
R/W-1
SE5
R/W-1
SE0
bit0
R =Readable bit
W =Writable bit
U =Unimplemented bit,
Read as ‘0’
bit7
-n =Value at POR reset
bit 7:
SE29: Pin function select RD7/COM1/SEG31 - RD5/COM3/SEG29
1 = pins have LCD drive function
0 = pins have digital Input function
The LMUX1:LMUX0 setting takes precedence over the LCDSE register.
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
SE27: Pin function select RG7/SEG28 and RE7/SEG27
1 = pins have LCD drive function
0 = pins have digital Input function
SE20: Pin function select RG6/SEG26 - RG0/SEG20
1 = pins have LCD drive function
0 = pins have digital Input function
SE16: Pin function select RF7/SEG19 - RF4/SEG16
1 = pins have LCD drive function
0 = pins have digital Input function
SE12: Pin function select RF3/SEG15 - RF0/SEG12
1 = pins have LCD drive function
0 = pins have digital Input function
SE9: Pin function select RE6/SEG11 - RE4/SEG09
1 = pins have LCD drive function
0 = pins have digital Input function
SE5: Pin function select RE3/SEG08 - RE0/SEG05
1 = pins have LCD drive function
0 = pins have digital Input function
SE0: Pin function select RD4/SEG04 - RD0/SEG00
1 = pins have LCD drive function
0 = pins have digital I/O function
DS30444E - page 100
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
2*VLCD1 and VLCD3 = 3 * VLCD1.When the charge pump
is not operating, Vlcd3 will be internally tied to VDD. See
the Electrical Specifications section for charge pump
capacitor and potentiometer values.
13.5
Voltage Generation
There are two methods for LCD voltage generation,
internal charge pump, or external resistor ladder.
13.5.1 CHARGE PUMP
13.5.2 EXTERNAL R-LADDER
The LCD charge pump is shown in Figure 13-13. The
1.0V - 2.3V regulator will establish a stable base volt-
age from the varying battery voltage. This regulator is
adjustable through the range by connecting a variable
external resistor from VLCDADJ to ground.The poten-
tiometer provides contrast adjustment for the LCD.This
base voltage is connected to VLCD1 on the charge
pump. The charge pump boosts VLCD1 into VLCD2 =
The LCD module can also use an external resistor lad-
der (R-Ladder) to generate the LCD voltages.
Figure 13-13 shows external connections for static and
1/3 bias.The VGEN (LCDCON<4>) bit must be cleared
to use an external R-Ladder.
FIGURE 13-13:CHARGE PUMP AND RESISTOR LADDER
VDD
10 µA
nominal
LCDEN
SLPEN
Charge Pump
VLCD3
VLCD2
VLCD1
C1 C2
VLCDADJ
100k*
130k*
0.47 µF*
0.47 µF*
0.47 µF*
Connections for
internal charge
pump, VGEN = 1
0.47 µF*
Connections for
external R-ladder,
1/3 Bias,
10k*
10k*
10k*
10k*
5k*
5k*
VGEN = 0
VDD
VDD
Connections for
external R-ladder,
Static Bias,
VGEN = 0
* These values are provided for design guidance only and should be
optimized to the application by the designer.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 101
PIC16C9XX
- Timing source, bits CS1:CS0
- Voltage generation, bit VGEN
- Sleep mode, bit SLPEN
13.6
Configuring the LCD Module
The following is the sequence of steps to follow to con-
figure the LCD module.
4. Write initial values to pixel data registers,
LCDD00 through LCDD15.
1. Select the frame clock prescale using bits
LP3:LP0 (LCDPS<3:0>).
5. Clear LCD interrupt flag, LCDIF (PIR1<7>), and
if desired, enable the interrupt by setting bit
LCDIE (PIE1<7>).
2. Configure the appropriate pins to function as
segment drivers using the LCDSE register.
3. Configure the LCD module for the following
using the LCDCON register.
6. Enable the LCD module, by setting bit LCDEN
(LCDCON<7>).
- Multiplex mode and Bias, bits
LMUX1:LMUX0
TABLE 13-4: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE LCD MODULE
Value on
Power-on
Reset
Value on
all other
Resets
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0Bh, 8Bh,
10Bh, 18Bh
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
RBIE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
0000 000x 0000 000u
0Ch
PIR1
LCDIF
LCDIE
—
ADIF(1)
ADIE(1)
—
—
—
—
—
SSPIF
SSPIE
CCP1IF TMR2IF
CCP1IE TMR2IE
TMR1IF 00-- 0000 00-- 0000
TMR1IE 00-- 0000 00-- 0000
8Ch
PIE1
10h
T1CON
LCDSE
LCDPS
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON --00 0000 --uu uuuu
10Dh
10Eh
10Fh
SE29
—
SE27
—
SE20
—
SE16
—
SE12
LP3
SE9
LP2
CS0
SE5
LP1
SE0
LP0
1111 1111 1111 1111
---- 0000 ---- 0000
LCDCON LCDEN
SLPEN
—
VGEN
CS1
LMUX1
LMUX0 00-0 0000 00-0 0000
SEG07
LCDD00
SEG06
COM0
SEG05
COM0
SEG04
COM0
SEG03
COM0
SEG02
COM0
SEG01
COM0
SEG00
COM0
110h
111h
112h
113h
114h
115h
116h
117h
118h
119h
11Ah
11Bh
11Ch
11Dh
11Eh
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM0
SEG15
LCDD01
SEG14
COM0
SEG13
COM0
SEG12
COM0
SEG11
COM0
SEG10
COM0
SEG09
COM0
SEG08
COM0
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM0
SEG23
LCDD02
SEG22
COM0
SEG21
COM0
SEG20
COM0
SEG19
COM0
SEG18
COM0
SEG17
COM0
SEG16
COM0
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM0
SEG31
LCDD03
SEG30
COM0
SEG29
COM0
SEG28
COM0
SEG27
COM0
SEG26
COM0
SEG25
COM0
SEG24
COM0
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM0
SEG07
LCDD04
SEG06
COM1
SEG05
COM1
SEG04
COM1
SEG03
COM1
SEG02
COM1
SEG01
COM1
SEG00
COM1
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM1
SEG15
LCDD05
SEG14
COM1
SEG13
COM1
SEG12
COM1
SEG11
COM1
SEG10
COM1
SEG09
COM1
SEG08
COM1
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM1
SEG23
LCDD06
SEG22
COM1
SEG21
COM1
SEG20
COM1
SEG19
COM1
SEG18
COM1
SEG17
COM1
SEG16
COM1
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM1
SEG31
LCDD07
SEG30
COM1
SEG29
COM1
SEG28
COM1
SEG27
COM1
SEG26
COM1
SEG25
COM1
SEG24
COM1
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM1(2)
SEG07
LCDD08
SEG06
COM2
SEG05
COM2
SEG04
COM2
SEG03
COM2
SEG02
COM2
SEG01
COM2
SEG00
COM2
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM2
SEG15
LCDD09
SEG14
COM2
SEG13
COM2
SEG12
COM2
SEG11
COM2
SEG10
COM2
SEG09
COM2
SEG08
COM2
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM2
SEG23
LCDD10
SEG22
COM2
SEG21
COM2
SEG20
COM2
SEG19
COM2
SEG18
COM2
SEG17
COM2
SEG16
COM2
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM2
SEG31
SEG30
SEG29
COM2
SEG28
COM2
SEG27
COM2
SEG26
COM2
SEG25
COM2
SEG24
COM2
LCDD11
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM2(2) COM2(2)
SEG07
COM3
SEG06
COM3
SEG05
COM3
SEG04
COM3
SEG03
COM3
SEG02
COM3
SEG01
COM3
SEG00
COM3
LCDD12
LCDD13
LCDD14
LCDD15
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
SEG15
COM3
SEG14
COM3
SEG13
COM3
SEG12
COM3
SEG11
COM3
SEG10
COM3
SEG09
COM3
SEG08
COM3
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
SEG23
COM3
SEG22
COM3
SEG21
COM3
SEG20
COM3
SEG19
COM3
SEG18
COM3
SEG17
COM3
SEG16
COM3
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
SEG31
SEG30
SEG29
SEG28
COM3
SEG27
COM3
SEG26
COM3
SEG25
COM3
SEG24
COM3
11Fh
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
COM3(2) COM3(2) COM3(2)
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the LCD Module.
Note 1: These bits are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
2: These pixels do not display, but can be used as general purpose RAM.
DS30444E - page 102
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST), intended to keep
the chip in reset until the crystal oscillator is stable.The
other is the Power-up Timer (PWRT), which provides a
fixed delay of 72 ms (nominal) on power-up only,
designed to keep the part in reset while the power sup-
ply stabilizes. With these two timers on-chip, most
applications need no external reset circuitry.
14.0 SPECIAL FEATURES OF THE
CPU
What sets a microcontroller apart from other proces-
sors are special circuits to deal with the needs of
real-time applications. The PIC16CXXX family has a
host of such features intended to maximize system reli-
ability, minimize cost through elimination of external
components, provide power saving operating modes
and offer code protection. These are:
SLEEP mode is designed to offer a very low current
power-down mode.The user can wake-up from SLEEP
through external reset, Watchdog Timer Wake-up or
through an interrupt. Several oscillator options are also
made available to allow the part to fit the application.
The RC oscillator option saves system cost while the
LP crystal option saves power. A set of configuration
bits are used to select various options.
• Oscillator selection
• Reset
- Power-on Reset (POR)
- Power-up Timer (PWRT)
- Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
• Interrupts
14.1
Configuration Bits
• Watchdog Timer (WDT)
• SLEEP
The configuration bits can be programmed (read as '0')
or left unprogrammed (read as '1') to select various
device configurations. These bits are mapped in pro-
gram memory location 2007h.
• Code protection
• ID locations
The user will note that address 2007h is beyond the
user program memory space. In fact, it belongs to the
special test/configuration memory space (2000h -
3FFFh), which can be accessed only during program-
ming.
• In-circuit serial programming
The PIC16CXXX has a Watchdog Timer which can be
shut off only through configuration bits. It runs off its
own RC oscillator for added reliability. There are two
timers that offer necessary delays on power-up. One is
FIGURE 14-1: CONFIGURATION WORD
CP1
CP0
CP1
CP0
CP1
CP0
—
—
CP1
CP0 PWRTE WDTE FOSC1 FOSC0
bit0
Register: CONFIG
Address 2007h
bit13
(1)
bit 13-8 CP1:CP0 Code protection bits
5-4: 11 = Code protection off
10 = Upper half of program memory code protected
01 = Upper 3/4 of program memory code protected
00 = All memory is code protected
bit 6:
bit 3:
Unimplemented: Read as '1'
PWRTE: Power-up Timer Enable bit
1 = PWRT disabled
0 = PWRT enabled
bit 2:
WDTE: Watchdog Timer Enable bit
1 = WDT enabled
0 = WDT disabled
bit 1-0: FOSC1:FOSC0: Oscillator Selection bits
11= RC oscillator
10= HS oscillator
01= XT oscillator
00= LP oscillator
Note 1: All of the CP1:CP0 bits have to be given the same value to enable the code protection scheme listed.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 103
PIC16C9XX
14.2
Oscillator Configurations
TABLE 14-1: CERAMIC RESONATORS
Ranges Tested:
14.2.1 OSCILLATOR TYPES
The PIC16CXXX can be operated in four different oscil-
lator modes. The user can program two configuration
bits (FOSC1 and FOSC0) to select one of these four
modes:
Mode
XT
Freq
OSC1
OSC2
455 kHz
2.0 MHz
4.0 MHz
68 - 100 pF
15 - 68 pF
15 - 68 pF
68 - 100 pF
15 - 68 pF
15 - 68 pF
• LP
• XT
• HS
• RC
Low Power Crystal
HS
8.0 MHz
10 - 68 pF
10 - 68 pF
Crystal/Resonator
These values are for design guidance only. See
notes at bottom of page.
High Speed Crystal/Resonator
Resistor/Capacitor
Resonators Used:
455 kHz Panasonic EFO-A455K04B ± 0.3%
14.2.2 CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR/CERAMIC
RESONATORS
2.0 MHz Murata Erie CSA2.00MG
4.0 MHz Murata Erie CSA4.00MG
8.0 MHz Murata Erie CSA8.00MT
± 0.5%
± 0.5%
± 0.5%
In XT, LP or HS modes a crystal or ceramic resonator
is connected to the OSC1/CLKIN and OSC2/CLKOUT
pins to establish oscillation (Figure 14-2). The
PIC16CXXX oscillator design requires the use of a par-
allel cut crystal. Use of a series cut crystal may give a
frequency out of the crystal manufacturers specifica-
tions. When in XT, LP or HS modes, the device can
have an external clock source to drive the OSC1/CLKIN
pin (Figure 14-3).
All resonators used did not have built-in capacitors.
TABLE 14-2: CAPACITOR SELECTION FOR
CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR
Crystal
Freq
Cap. Range
C1
Cap. Range
C2
Osc Type
LP
32 kHz
200 kHz
200 kHz
1 MHz
33 pF
15 pF
33 pF
15 pF
FIGURE 14-2: CRYSTAL/CERAMIC
RESONATOR OPERATION
(HS, XT OR LP
XT
HS
47-68 pF
15 pF
47-68 pF
15 pF
OSC CONFIGURATION)
4 MHz
15 pF
15 pF
4 MHz
15 pF
15 pF
OSC1
8 MHz
15-33 pF
15-33 pF
To internal
logic
C1
C2
These values are for design guidance only. See
notes at bottom of page.
XTAL
OSC2
SLEEP
RF
Crystals Used
32 kHz
200 kHz
1 MHz
4 MHz
8 MHz
Epson C-001R32.768K-A
STD XTL 200.000KHz
ECS ECS-10-13-1
± 20 PPM
± 20 PPM
± 50 PPM
± 50 PPM
± 30 PPM
RS
Note1
PIC16CXXX
ECS ECS-40-20-1
See Table 14-1 and Table 14-2 for recommended
values of C1 and C2.
EPSON CA-301 8.000M-C
Note 1: A series resistor may be required for AT
strip cut crystals.
Note 1: Recommended values of C1 and C2 are
identical to the ranges tested (Table 14-1).
2: Higher capacitance increases the stability
of oscillator but also increases the start-up
time.
FIGURE 14-3: EXTERNAL CLOCK INPUT
OPERATION (HS, XT OR LP
OSC CONFIGURATION)
3: Since each resonator/crystal has its own
characteristics, the user should consult the
resonator/crystal manufacturer for appropri-
ate values of external components.
4: Rs may be required in HS mode as well as
XT mode to avoid overdriving crystals with
low drive level specification.
OSC1
OSC2
Clock from
ext. system
PIC16CXXX
Open
DS30444E - page 104
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
14.2.3 EXTERNAL CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR
CIRCUIT
14.2.4 RC OSCILLATOR
For timing insensitive applications the “RC” device
option offers additional cost savings. The RC oscillator
frequency is a function of the supply voltage, the resis-
tor (REXT) and capacitor (CEXT) values, and the operat-
ing temperature. In addition to this, the oscillator
frequency will vary from unit to unit due to normal pro-
cess parameter variation. Furthermore, the difference
in lead frame capacitance between package types will
also affect the oscillation frequency, especially for low
CEXT values. The user also needs to take into account
variation due to tolerance of external R and C compo-
nents used. Figure 14-6 shows how the R/C combina-
tion is connected to the PIC16CXXX. For REXT values
below 2.2 kΩ, the oscillator operation may become
unstable, or stop completely. For very high REXT values
(e.g. 1 MΩ), the oscillator becomes sensitive to noise,
humidity and leakage. Thus, we recommend to keep
Rext between 3 kΩ and 100 kΩ.
Either a prepackaged oscillator can be used or a simple
oscillator circuit with TTL gates can be built. Prepack-
aged oscillators provide a wide operating range and
better stability. A well-designed crystal oscillator will
provide good performance with TTL gates.Two types of
crystal oscillator circuits can be used; one with series
resonance, or one with parallel resonance.
Figure 14-4 shows implementation of a parallel reso-
nant oscillator circuit. The circuit is designed to use the
fundamental frequency of the crystal. The 74AS04
inverter performs the 180-degree phase shift that a par-
allel oscillator requires.The 4.7 kΩ resistor provides the
negative feedback for stability.The 10 kΩ potentiometer
biases the 74AS04 in the linear region. This could be
used for external oscillator designs.
FIGURE 14-4: EXTERNAL PARALLEL
RESONANT CRYSTAL
Although the oscillator will operate with no external
capacitor (CEXT = 0 pF), we recommend using values
above 20 pF for noise and stability reasons. With no or
small external capacitance, the oscillation frequency
can vary dramatically due to changes in external
capacitances, such as PCB trace capacitance or pack-
age lead frame capacitance.
OSCILLATOR CIRCUIT
+5V
To Other
Devices
10k
74AS04
4.7k
PIC16CXXX
74AS04
CLKIN
See characterization data for desired device for RC fre-
quency variation from part to part due to normal pro-
cess variation.The variation is larger for larger R (since
leakage current variation will affect RC frequency more
for large R) and for smaller C (since variation of input
capacitance will affect RC frequency more).
10k
XTAL
10k
See characterization data for desired device for varia-
tion of oscillator frequency due to VDD for given
REXT/CEXT values as well as frequency variation due to
operating temperature for given R, C, and VDD values.
20 pF
20 pF
Figure 14-5 shows a series resonant oscillator circuit.
This circuit is also designed to use the fundamental fre-
quency of the crystal. The inverter performs a
180-degree phase shift in a series resonant oscillator
circuit. The 330 kΩ resistors provide the negative feed-
back to bias the inverters in their linear region.
The oscillator frequency, divided by 4, is available on
the OSC2/CLKOUT pin, and can be used for test pur-
poses or to synchronize other logic (see Figure 3-3 for
waveform).
FIGURE 14-6: RC OSCILLATOR MODE
FIGURE 14-5: EXTERNAL SERIES
RESONANT CRYSTAL
VDD
OSCILLATOR CIRCUIT
REXT
Internal
OSC1
clock
To Other
Devices
330 kΩ
330 kΩ
CEXT
VSS
PIC16CXXX
74AS04
74AS04
74AS04
CLKIN
OSC2/CLKOUT
0.1 µF
Fosc/4
XTAL
PIC16CXXX
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 105
PIC16C9XX
the resumption of normal operation. The TO and PD
bits are set or cleared differently in different reset situ-
ations as indicated in Table 14-4. These bits are used
in software to determine the nature of the reset. See
Table 14-6 for a full description of reset states of all reg-
isters.
14.3
Reset
The PIC16CXX differentiates between various kinds of
reset:
• Power-on Reset (POR)
• MCLR Reset during normal operation
• MCLR Reset during SLEEP
• WDT Reset (normal operation)
A simplified block diagram of the on-chip reset circuit is
shown in Figure 14-7.
Some registers are not affected in any reset condition;
their status is unknown on POR and unchanged in any
other reset. Most other registers are reset to a “reset
state” on Power-on Reset (POR), on the MCLR and
WDT Reset, and on MCLR Reset during SLEEP. They
are not affected by a WDT Wake-up, which is viewed as
The devices all have a MCLR noise filter in the MCLR
reset path.The filter will detect and ignore small pulses.
It should be noted that a WDT Reset does not drive
MCLR pin low.
FIGURE 14-7: SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT
External
Reset
MCLR
SLEEP
WDT
WDT
Module
Time-out
VDD rise
detect
Power-on Reset
VDD
S
R
OST/PWRT
OST
Chip_Reset
Q
10-bit Ripple counter
OSC1
(1)
PWRT
On-chip
RC OSC
10-bit Ripple counter
(2)
Enable PWRT
(2)
Enable OST
Note 1: This is a separate oscillator from the RC oscillator of the CLKIN pin.
2: See Table 14-3 for time-out situations.
DS30444E - page 106
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
14.4.3 OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER (OST)
14.4
Power-on Reset (POR), Power-up
Timer (PWRT) and Oscillator Start-up
Timer (OST)
The Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) provides 1024
oscillator cycle (from OSC1 input) delay after the
PWRT delay is over.This ensures that the crystal oscil-
lator or resonator has started and stabilized.
14.4.1 POWER-ON RESET (POR)
A Power-on Reset pulse is generated on-chip when
VDD rise is detected (in the range of 1.5V - 2.1V). To
take advantage of the POR, just tie the MCLR pin
directly (or through a resistor) to VDD. This will elimi-
nate external RC components usually needed to create
a Power-on Reset. A maximum rise time for VDD is
specified. See Electrical Specifications for details.
The OST time-out is invoked only for XT, LP and HS
modes and only on Power-on Reset or wake-up from
SLEEP.
14.4.4 TIME-OUT SEQUENCE
On power-up the time-out sequence is as follows: First
PWRT time-out is invoked after the POR time delay has
expired. Then OST is activated. The total time-out will
vary based on oscillator configuration and the status of
the PWRT. For example, in RC mode with the PWRT
disabled, there will be no time-out at all. Figure 14-8,
Figure 14-9, and Figure 14-10 depict time-out
sequences on power-up.
When the device starts normal operation (exits the
reset condition), device operating parameters (voltage,
frequency, temperature, ...) must be met to ensure
operation. If these conditions are not met, the device
must be held in reset until the operating conditions are
met.
For additional information, refer to Application Note
AN607, “Power-up Trouble Shooting.”
Since the time-outs occur from the POR pulse, if MCLR
is kept low long enough, the time-outs will expire. Then
bringing MCLR high will begin execution immediately
(Figure 14-9). This is useful for testing purposes or to
synchronize more than one PIC16CXXX device operat-
ing in parallel.
14.4.2 POWER-UP TIMER (PWRT)
The Power-up Timer provides a fixed 72 ms nominal
time-out on power-up only, from the POR. The
Power-up Timer operates on an internal RC oscillator.
The chip is kept in reset as long as the PWRT is active.
The PWRT’s time delay allows VDD to rise to an accept-
able level. A configuration bit is provided to enable/dis-
able the PWRT.
Table 14-5 shows the reset conditions for some special
function registers, while Table 14-6 shows the reset
conditions for all the registers.
14.4.5 POWER CONTROL/STATUS REGISTER
(PCON)
The power-up time delay will vary from chip to chip due
to VDD, temperature, and process variation. See DC
parameters for details.
Bit1 is Power-on Reset Status bit POR. It is cleared on
a Power-on Reset and unaffected otherwise. The user
must set this bit following a Power-on Reset.
TABLE 14-3: TIME-OUT IN VARIOUS SITUATIONS
Oscillator Configuration
PWRTE = 1
Power-up
Wake-up from SLEEP
PWRTE = 0
72 ms + 1024TOSC
72 ms
XT, HS, LP
RC
1024TOSC
—
1024 TOSC
—
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 107
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 14-4: STATUS BITS AND THEIR SIGNIFICANCE
POR
TO
PD
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
x
0
0
u
1
1
x
0
1
0
u
0
Power-on Reset
Illegal, TO is set on POR
Illegal, PD is set on POR
WDT Reset
WDT Wake-up
MCLR Reset during normal operation
MCLR Reset during SLEEP or interrupt wake-up from SLEEP
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown
TABLE 14-5: RESET CONDITION FOR SPECIAL REGISTERS
Program
Counter
STATUS
Register
PCON
Register
Condition
Power-on Reset
000h
0001 1xxx
000u uuuu
0001 0uuu
0000 1uuu
uuu0 0uuu
uuu1 0uuu
---- --0-
---- --u-
---- --u-
---- --u-
---- --u-
---- --u-
MCLR Reset during normal operation
MCLR Reset during SLEEP
WDT Reset
000h
000h
000h
WDT Wake-up
PC + 1
PC + 1
(1)
Interrupt wake-up from SLEEP
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown, -= unimplemented bit read as '0'.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded
with the interrupt vector (0004h).
TABLE 14-6: INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS
Register
Applicable Devices
Power-on Reset
MCLR Resets
WDT Reset
Wake-up via
WDT or
Interrupt
W
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
xxxx xxxx
N/A
uuuu uuuu
N/A
uuuu uuuu
N/A
INDF
TMR0
PCL
xxxx xxxx
0000h
uuuu uuuu
0000h
uuuu uuuu
(2)
PC + 1
(3)
(3)
STATUS
FSR
0001 1xxx
xxxx xxxx
--xx xxxx
000q quuu
uuuq quuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
PORTA
PORTA
PORTB
PORTC
(5)
(5)
--0x 0000
--0u 0000
xxxx xxxx
--xx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, -= unimplemented bit, read as '0', q= value depends on condition
Note 1: One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIR1 will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector
(0004h).
3: See Table 14-5 for reset value for specific condition.
4: Bits PIE1<6> and PIR1<6> are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
5: PORTA values when read.
DS30444E - page 108
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 14-6: INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (Cont.’d)
Register
Applicable Devices
Power-on Reset
MCLR Resets
WDT Reset
Wake-up via
WDT or
Interrupt
PORTD
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
923
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
924
0000 0000
0000 0000
---0 0000
0000 000x
00-- 0000
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
--00 0000
0000 0000
-000 0000
xxxx xxxx
0000 0000
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
--00 0000
xxxx xxxx
0000 00-0
1111 1111
--11 1111
1111 1111
--11 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
00-- 0000
---- --0-
1111 1111
0000 0000
0000 0000
---- -000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
---0 0000
0000 000u
00-- 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
0000 0000
-000 0000
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--00 0000
uuuu uuuu
0000 00-0
1111 1111
--11 1111
1111 1111
--11 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
00-- 0000
---- --u-
1111 1111
0000 0000
0000 0000
---- -000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---u uuuu
PORTE
PCLATH
INTCON
(1)
uuuu uuuu
(4)
(1)
PIR1
uu-- uuuu
TMR1L
TMR1H
T1CON
TMR2
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uu-u
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uu-- uuuu
---- --u-
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---- -uuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T2CON
SSPBUF
SSPCON
CCPR1L
CCPR1H
CCP1CON
ADRES
ADCON0
OPTION
TRISA
TRISB
TRISC
TRISD
TRISE
(4)
PIE1
PCON
PR2
SSPADD
SSPSTAT
ADCON1
PORTF
PORTG
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, -= unimplemented bit, read as '0', q= value depends on condition
Note 1: One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIR1 will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector
(0004h).
3: See Table 14-5 for reset value for specific condition.
4: Bits PIE1<6> and PIR1<6> are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
5: PORTA values when read.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 109
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 14-6: INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (Cont.’d)
Register
Applicable Devices
Power-on Reset
MCLR Resets
WDT Reset
Wake-up via
WDT or
Interrupt
LCDSE
923
923
923
923
924
924
924
924
1111 1111
---- 0000
00-0 0000
xxxx xxxx
1111 1111
---- 0000
00-0 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---- uuuu
uu-u uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDPS
LCDCON
LCDD00
to
LCDD15
TRISF
TRISG
923
923
924
924
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, -= unimplemented bit, read as '0', q= value depends on condition
Note 1: One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIR1 will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector
(0004h).
3: See Table 14-5 for reset value for specific condition.
4: Bits PIE1<6> and PIR1<6> are reserved on the PIC16C923, always maintain these bits clear.
5: PORTA values when read.
DS30444E - page 110
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 14-8: TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 1
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
OST TIME-OUT
TOST
INTERNAL RESET
FIGURE 14-9: TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 2
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
FIGURE 14-10:TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR TIED TO VDD)
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 111
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 14-11:EXTERNAL POWER-ON
RESET CIRCUIT (FOR SLOW
VDD POWER-UP)
FIGURE 14-12:EXTERNAL BROWN-OUT
PROTECTION CIRCUIT 1
VDD
VDD
33k
VDD
10k
MCLR
D
R
R1
40k
PIC16CXXX
MCLR
PIC16CXXX
C
Note 1: This circuit will activate reset when VDD
goes below (Vz + 0.7V) where Vz = Zener
voltage.
Note 1: External Power-on Reset circuit is required
only if VDD power-up slope is too slow.The
diode D helps discharge the capacitor
quickly when VDD powers down.
2: Resistors should be adjusted for the char-
acteristics of the transistors.
2: R < 40 kΩ is recommended to make sure
that voltage drop across R does not violate
the device’s electrical specification.
3: R1 = 100Ω to 1 kΩ will limit any current
flowing into MCLR from external capacitor
C in the event of MCLR/VPP pin break-
down due to Electrostatic Discharge
(ESD) or Electrical Overstress (EOS).
FIGURE 14-13:EXTERNAL BROWN-OUT
PROTECTION CIRCUIT 2
VDD
VDD
R1
R2
Q1
MCLR
40k
PIC16CXXX
Note 1: This brown-out circuit is less expensive,
albeit less accurate. Transistor Q1 turns
off when VDD is below a certain level
such that:
R1
= 0.7V
VDD •
R1 + R2
2: Resistors should be adjusted for the
characteristics of the transistors.
DS30444E - page 112
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
A global interrupt enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>)
enables (if set) all un-masked interrupts or disables (if
cleared) all interrupts. When bit GIE is enabled, and an
interrupt’s flag bit and mask bit are set, the interrupt will
vector immediately. Individual interrupts can be dis-
abled through their corresponding enable bits in various
registers. Individual interrupt bits are set regardless of
the status of the GIE bit.The GIE bit is cleared on reset.
14.5
Interrupts
The PIC16C9XX family has up to 9 sources of interrupt:
Applicable
Devices
Interrupt Sources
External interrupt RB0/INT
TMR0 overflow interrupt
923 924
923 924
923 924
The “return from interrupt” instruction, RETFIE, exits
the interrupt routine as well as sets the GIE bit, which
re-enables interrupts.
PORTB change interrupts
(pins RB7:RB4)
The RB0/INT pin interrupt, the RB port change interrupt
and the TMR0 overflow interrupt flags are contained in
the INTCON register.
A/D Interrupt
923 924
923 924
923 924
923 924
923 924
923 924
TMR1 overflow interrupt
TMR2 matches period interrupt
CCP1 interrupt
The peripheral interrupt flags are contained in the spe-
cial function register PIR1.The corresponding interrupt
enable bits are contained in special function register
PIE1, and the peripheral interrupt enable bit is con-
tained in special function register INTCON.
Synchronous serial port interrupt
LCD Module interrupt
The interrupt control register (INTCON) records individ-
ual interrupt requests in flag bits. It also has individual
and global interrupt enable bits.
When an interrupt is responded to, the GIE bit is
cleared to disable any further interrupts, the return
address is pushed onto the stack and the PC is loaded
with 0004h. Once in the interrupt service routine the
source(s) of the interrupt can be determined by polling
the interrupt flag bits. The interrupt flag bit(s) must be
cleared in software before re-enabling interrupts to
avoid recursive interrupts.
Note: Individual interrupt flag bits are set regard-
less of the status of their corresponding
mask bit or the GIE bit.
For external interrupt events, such as the RB0/INT pin
or RB Port change interrupt, the interrupt latency will be
three or four instruction cycles. The exact latency
depends when the interrupt event occurs
(Figure 14-15). The latency is the same for one or two
cycle instructions. Individual interrupt flag bits are set
regardless of the status of their corresponding mask bit
or the GIE bit.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 113
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 14-14:INTERRUPT LOGIC
TMR1IF
TMR1IE
Wake-up (If in SLEEP mode)
Interrupt to CPU
T0IF
T0IE
INTF
INTE
TMR2IF
TMR2IE
RBIF
RBIE
LCDIF
LCDIE
PEIF
PEIE
GIE
CCP1IF
CCP1IE
SSPIF
SSPIE
ADIF
ADIE
The A/D module interrupt is implemented on the PIC16C924 only.
FIGURE 14-15:INT PIN INTERRUPT TIMING
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
OSC1
CLKOUT
3
4
INT pin
1
1
Interrupt Latency
INTF flag
(INTCON<1>)
5
2
GIE bit
(INTCON<7>)
INSTRUCTION FLOW
PC
0004h
PC+1
PC+1
—
0005h
PC
Instruction
fetched
Inst (PC)
Inst (PC+1)
Inst (0004h)
Inst (0005h)
Inst (0004h)
Instruction
executed
Dummy Cycle
Dummy Cycle
Inst (PC)
Inst (PC-1)
Note
1: INTF flag is sampled here (every Q1).
2: Interrupt latency = 3-4 TCY where TCY = instruction cycle time.
Latency is the same whether Inst (PC) is a single cycle or a 2-cycle instruction.
3: CLKOUT is available only in RC oscillator mode.
4: For minimum width of INT pulse, refer to AC specs.
5: INTF can be set anytime during the Q4-Q1 cycles.
DS30444E - page 114
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
14.5.1 INT INTERRUPT
14.6
Context Saving During Interrupts
During an interrupt, only the return PC value is saved
on the stack.Typically, users may wish to save key reg-
isters during an interrupt i.e., W register and STATUS
register. This will have to be implemented in software.
External interrupt on RB0/INT pin is edge triggered:
either rising if bit INTEDG (OPTION<6>) is set, or fall-
ing, if the INTEDG bit is clear. When a valid edge
appears on the RB0/INT pin, flag bit INTF
(INTCON<1>) is set. This interrupt can be disabled by
clearing enable bit INTE (INTCON<4>). Flag bit INTF
must be cleared in software in the interrupt service rou-
tine before re-enabling this interrupt. The INT interrupt
can wake-up the processor from SLEEP, if bit INTE was
set prior to going into SLEEP.The status of global inter-
rupt enable bit GIE decides whether or not the proces-
sor branches to the interrupt vector following wake-up.
See Section 14.8 for details on SLEEP mode.
Example 14-1 stores and restores the STATUS, W, and
PCLATH registers. The register, W_TEMP, must be
defined in each bank and must be defined at the same
offset from the bank base address (i.e., if W_TEMP is
defined at 0x20 in bank 0, it must also be defined at
0xA0 in bank 1).
The example:
a) Stores the W register.
b) Stores the STATUS register in bank 0.
c) Stores the PCLATH register.
d) Executes the ISR code.
14.5.2 TMR0 INTERRUPT
An overflow (FFh → 00h) in the TMR0 register will set
flag bit T0IF (INTCON<2>). The interrupt can be
enabled/disabled by setting/clearing enable bit T0IE
(INTCON<5>). (Section 7.0)
e) Restores the STATUS register (and bank select
bit).
f) Restores the W and PCLATH registers.
14.5.3 PORTB INTCON CHANGE
An input change on PORTB<7:4> sets flag bit RBIF
(INTCON<0>). The interrupt can be enabled/disabled
by setting/clearing enable bit RBIE (INTCON<4>).
(Section 5.2)
EXAMPLE 14-1: SAVING STATUS, W, AND PCLATH REGISTERS IN RAM
MOVWF
SWAPF
CLRF
MOVWF
MOVF
MOVWF
CLRF
BCF
W_TEMP
STATUS,W
STATUS
STATUS_TEMP
PCLATH, W
PCLATH_TEMP
PCLATH
STATUS, IRP
FSR, W
;Copy W to TEMP register, could be bank one or zero
;Swap status to be saved into W
;bank 0, regardless of current bank, Clears IRP,RP1,RP0
;Save status to bank zero STATUS_TEMP register
;Only required if using pages 1, 2 and/or 3
;Save PCLATH into W
;Page zero, regardless of current page
;Return to Bank 0
;Copy FSR to W
MOVF
MOVWF
:
FSR_TEMP
;Copy FSR from W to FSR_TEMP
:(ISR)
:
MOVF
MOVWF
SWAPF
PCLATH_TEMP, W
PCLATH
STATUS_TEMP,W
;Restore PCLATH
;Move W into PCLATH
;Swap STATUS_TEMP register into W
;(sets bank to original state)
;Move W into STATUS register
;Swap W_TEMP
MOVWF
SWAPF
SWAPF
STATUS
W_TEMP,F
W_TEMP,W
;Swap W_TEMP into W
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 115
PIC16C9XX
assigned to the WDT under software control by writing
to the OPTION register. Thus, time-out periods up to
2.3 seconds can be realized.
14.7
Watchdog Timer (WDT)
The Watchdog Timer is as a free running on-chip RC
oscillator which does not require any external compo-
nents.This RC oscillator is separate from the RC oscil-
lator of the OSC1/CLKIN pin.That means that the WDT
will run, even if the clock on the OSC1/CLKIN and
OSC2/CLKOUT pins of the device has been stopped,
for example, by execution of a SLEEPinstruction. Dur-
ing normal operation, a WDT time-out generates a
device RESET (Watchdog Timer Reset). If the device is
in SLEEP mode, a WDT time-out causes the device to
wake-up and continue with normal operation (Watch-
dog Timer Wake-up). The WDT can be permanently
disabled by clearing configuration bit WDTE
(Section 14.1).
The CLRWDT and SLEEP instructions clear the WDT
and the postscaler, if assigned to the WDT, and prevent
it from timing out and generating a device RESET con-
dition.
The TO bit in the STATUS register will be cleared upon
a Watchdog Timer time-out.
14.7.2 WDT PROGRAMMING CONSIDERATIONS
It should also be taken into account that under worst
case conditions (VDD = Min., Temperature = Max., and
max. WDT prescaler) it may take several seconds
before a WDT time-out occurs.
14.7.1 WDT PERIOD
Note: When a CLRWDT instruction is executed
and the prescaler is assigned to the WDT,
the prescaler count will be cleared, but the
prescaler assignment is not changed.
The WDT has a nominal time-out period of 18 ms, (with
no prescaler). The time-out periods vary with tempera-
DD
ture, V and process variations from part to part (see
DC specs). If longer time-out periods are desired, a
prescaler with a division ratio of up to 1:128 can be
FIGURE 14-16:WATCHDOG TIMER BLOCK DIAGRAM
From TMR0 Clock Source
(Figure 7-6)
0
Postscaler
8
M
1
U
WDT Timer
X
8 - to - 1 MUX
PS2:PS0
PSA
WDT
Enable Bit
To TMR0 (Figure 7-6)
0
1
MUX
PSA
WDT
Time-out
Note: PSA and PS2:PS0 are bits in the OPTION register.
FIGURE 14-17:SUMMARY OF WATCHDOG TIMER REGISTERS
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
(1)
2007h
Config. bits
(1)
(1)
CP1
CP0
PWRTE
PSA
WDTE
PS2
FOSC1
PS1
FOSC0
PS0
81h, 181h OPTION
RBPU
INTEDG
T0CS T0SE
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by the Watchdog Timer.
Note 1: See Figure 14-1 for operation of these bits.
DS30444E - page 116
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
Other peripherals can not generate interrupts since
during SLEEP, no on-chip Q clocks are present.
14.8
Power-down Mode (SLEEP)
Power-down mode is entered by executing a SLEEP
When the SLEEPinstruction is being executed, the next
instruction (PC + 1) is pre-fetched. For the device to
wake-up through an interrupt event, the corresponding
interrupt enable bit must be set (enabled). Wake-up is
regardless of the state of the GIE bit. If the GIE bit is
clear (disabled), the device continues execution at the
instruction after the SLEEPinstruction. If the GIE bit is
set (enabled), the device executes the instruction after
the SLEEP instruction and then branches to the inter-
rupt address (0004h). In cases where the execution of
the instruction following SLEEP is not desirable, the
user should have a NOPafter the SLEEPinstruction.
instruction.
If enabled, the Watchdog Timer will be cleared but
keeps running, the PD bit (STATUS<3>) is cleared, the
TO (STATUS<4>) bit is set, and the oscillator driver is
turned off. The I/O ports maintain the status they had,
before the SLEEP instruction was executed (driving
high, low, or hi-impedance).
For lowest current consumption in this mode, place all
I/O pins at either VDD, or VSS, ensure no external cir-
cuitry is drawing current from the I/O pin, power-down
the A/D, disable external clocks. Pull all I/O pins, that
are hi-impedance inputs, high or low externally to avoid
switching currents caused by floating inputs.TheT0CKI
input should also be at VDD or VSS for lowest current
consumption.The contribution from on-chip pull-ups on
PORTB should be considered.
14.8.2 WAKE-UP USING INTERRUPTS
When global interrupts are disabled (GIE cleared) and
any interrupt source has both its interrupt enable bit
and interrupt flag bit set, one of the following will occur:
The MCLR pin must be at a logic high level (VIHMC).
14.8.1 WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP
• If the interrupt occurs before the execution of a
SLEEPinstruction, the SLEEPinstruction will com-
plete as a NOP. Therefore, the WDT and WDT
postscaler will not be cleared, the TO bit will not
be set and PD bits will not be cleared.
The device can wake up from SLEEP through one of
the following events:
1. External reset input on MCLR pin.
• If the interrupt occurs during or after the execu-
tion of a SLEEPinstruction, the device will immedi-
ately wake up from sleep. The SLEEPinstruction
will be completely executed before the wake-up.
Therefore, the WDT and WDT postscaler will be
cleared, the TO bit will be set and the PD bit will
be cleared.
2. Watchdog Timer Wake-up (if WDT was
enabled).
3. Interrupt from RB0/INT pin, RB port change, or
some peripheral interrupts.
External MCLR Reset will cause a device reset. All
other events are considered a continuation of program
execution and cause a “wake-up”. The TO and PD bits
in the STATUS register can be used to determine the
cause of device reset. The PD bit, which is set on
power-up is cleared when SLEEPis invoked.The TO bit
is cleared if a WDT time-out occurred (and caused
wake-up).
Even if the flag bits were checked before executing a
SLEEP instruction, it may be possible for flag bits to
become set before the SLEEPinstruction completes.To
determine whether a SLEEPinstruction executed, test
the PD bit. If the PD bit is set, the SLEEPinstruction was
executed as a NOP.
To ensure that the WDT is cleared, a CLRWDTinstruc-
tion should be executed before a SLEEPinstruction.
The following peripheral interrupts can wake the device
from SLEEP:
1. TMR1 interrupt.Timer1 must be operating as an
asynchronous counter.
2. SSP (Start/Stop) bit detect interrupt.
2
3. SSP transmit or receive in slave mode (SPI/I C).
4. CCP capture mode interrupt.
5. A/D conversion (when A/D clock source is RC).
6. Special event trigger (Timer1 in asynchronous
mode using an external clock).
7. LCD module.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 117
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 14-18:WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP THROUGH INTERRUPT
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
OSC1
CLKOUT(4)
INT pin
TOST(2)
INTF flag
(INTCON<1>)
Interrupt Latency
(Note 2)
GIE bit
(INTCON<7>)
Processor in
SLEEP
INSTRUCTION FLOW
PC
PC
PC+1
PC+2
PC+2
PC + 2
0004h
0005h
Instruction
Inst(0004h)
Inst(PC + 1)
Inst(PC + 2)
Inst(0005h)
Inst(PC) = SLEEP
Inst(PC - 1)
fetched
Instruction
executed
Dummy cycle
Dummy cycle
SLEEP
Inst(PC + 1)
Inst(0004h)
Note 1: XT, HS or LP oscillator mode assumed.
2: TOST = 1024TOSC (drawing not to scale) This delay will not be there for RC osc mode.
3: GIE = '1' assumed. In this case after wake- up, the processor jumps to the interrupt routine. If GIE = '0', execution will continue in-line.
4: CLKOUT is not available in these osc modes, but shown here for timing reference.
After reset, to place the device into program/verify
mode, the program counter (PC) is at location 00h. A
6-bit command is then supplied to the device. Depend-
ing on the command, 14-bits of program data are then
supplied to or from the device, depending if the com-
mand was a load or a read. For complete details of
serial programming, please refer to the PIC16C6X/7X
Programming Specifications (Literature #DS30228).
14.9
Program Verification/Code Protection
If the code protection bit(s) have not been pro-
grammed, the on-chip program memory can be read
out for verification purposes.
Note: Microchip does not recommend code pro-
tecting windowed devices.
14.10 ID Locations
FIGURE 14-19:TYPICAL IN-CIRCUIT SERIAL
PROGRAMMING
Four memory locations (2000h - 2003h) are designated
as ID locations where the user can store checksum or
other code-identification numbers. These locations are
not accessible during normal execution but are read-
able and writable during program/verify. It is recom-
mended that only the 4 least significant bits of the ID
location are used.
CONNECTION
To Normal
Connections
External
Connector
Signals
PIC16CXXX
14.11 In-Circuit Serial Programming
+5V
0V
VDD
PIC16CXXX microcontrollers can be serially pro-
grammed while in the end application circuit. This is
simply done with two lines for clock and data, and three
other lines for power, ground, and the programming
voltage. This allows customers to manufacture boards
with unprogrammed devices, and then program the
microcontroller just before shipping the product. This
also allows the most recent firmware or a custom firm-
ware to be programmed.
VSS
VPP
MCLR/VPP
RB6
RB7
CLK
Data I/O
VDD
To Normal
Connections
The device is placed into a program/verify mode by
holding the RB6 and RB7 pins low while raising the
MCLR (VPP) pin from VIL to VIHH (see programming
specification). RB6 becomes the programming clock
and RB7 becomes the programming data. Both RB6
and RB7 are Schmitt Trigger inputs in this mode.
DS30444E - page 118
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 15-1: OPCODE FIELD DESCRIPTIONS
15.0 INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
Each PIC16CXXX instruction is a 14-bit word divided
into an OPCODE which specifies the instruction type
and one or more operands which further specify the
operation of the instruction. The PIC16CXX instruction
set summary in Table 15-2 lists byte-oriented, bit-ori-
ented, and literal and control operations. Table 15-1
shows the opcode field descriptions.
Field
Description
f
W
b
k
x
Register file address (0x00 to 0x7F)
Working register (accumulator)
Bit address within an 8-bit file register
Literal field, constant data or label
Don't care location (= 0 or 1)
For byte-oriented instructions, 'f' represents a file reg-
ister designator and 'd' represents a destination desig-
nator. The file register designator specifies which file
register is to be used by the instruction.
The assembler will generate code with x = 0. It is the
recommended form of use for compatibility with all
Microchip software tools.
d
Destination select; d = 0: store result in W,
d = 1: store result in file register f.
Default is d = 1
The destination designator specifies where the result of
the operation is to be placed. If 'd' is zero, the result is
placed in the W register. If 'd' is one, the result is placed
in the file register specified in the instruction.
label
TOS
Label name
Top of Stack
PC
For bit-oriented instructions, 'b' represents a bit field
designator which selects the number of the bit affected
by the operation, while 'f' represents the number of the
file in which the bit is located.
Program Counter
Program Counter High Latch
Global Interrupt Enable bit
Watchdog Timer/Counter
Time-out bit
PCLATH
GIE
WDT
TO
For literal and control operations, 'k' represents an
eight or eleven bit constant or literal value.
PD
Power-down bit
The instruction set is highly orthogonal and is grouped
into three basic categories:
dest Destination either the W register or the specified
register file location
• Byte-oriented operations
• Bit-oriented operations
[ ] Options
Contents
( )
→
• Literal and control operations
Assigned to
FIGURE 15-1: GENERAL FORMAT FOR
INSTRUCTIONS
Register bit field
In the set of
< >
Byte-oriented file register operations
User defined term (font is courier)
italics
13
8
7
6
0
0
OPCODE
d
f (FILE #)
All instructions are executed within one single instruc-
tion cycle, unless a conditional test is true or the pro-
gram counter is changed as a result of an instruction. In
this case, the execution takes two instruction cycles
with the second cycle executed as a NOP. One instruc-
tion cycle consists of four oscillator periods.Thus, for an
oscillator frequency of 4 MHz, the normal instruction
execution time is 1 µs. If a conditional test is true or the
program counter is changed as a result of an instruc-
tion, the instruction execution time is 2 µs.
d = 0 for destination W
d = 1 for destination f
f = 7-bit file register address
Bit-oriented file register operations
13 10 9
b (BIT #)
7
6
OPCODE
f (FILE #)
b = 3-bit bit address
f = 7-bit file register address
Table 15-2 lists the instructions recognized by the
MPASM assembler.
Literal and control operations
Figure 15-1 shows the general formats that the instruc-
tions can have.
General
13
8
7
0
0
Note: To maintain upward compatibility with
future PIC16CXXX products, do not use
the OPTIONand TRISinstructions.
OPCODE
k (literal)
k = 8-bit immediate value
All examples use the following format to represent a
hexadecimal number:
CALLand GOTOinstructions only
13 11 10
OPCODE
k = 11-bit immediate value
0xhh
k (literal)
where h signifies a hexadecimal digit.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 119
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 15-2: PIC16CXXX INSTRUCTION SET
14-Bit Opcode
Mnemonic,
Operands
Description
Cycles
Status
Affected
Notes
MSb
LSb
BYTE-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
0111 dfff ffff
0101 dfff ffff
0001 lfff ffff
0001 0xxx xxxx
1001 dfff ffff
0011 dfff ffff
1011 dfff ffff
1010 dfff ffff
1111 dfff ffff
0100 dfff ffff
1000 dfff ffff
0000 lfff ffff
0000 0xx0 0000
1101 dfff ffff
1100 dfff ffff
0010 dfff ffff
1110 dfff ffff
0110 dfff ffff
ADDWF
ANDWF
CLRF
CLRW
COMF
DECF
f, d
f, d
f
Add W and f
AND W with f
Clear f
Clear W
Complement f
Decrement f
Decrement f, Skip if 0
Increment f
Increment f, Skip if 0
Inclusive OR W with f
Move f
1
1
1
1
1
1
1(2)
1
1(2)
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
C,DC,Z
1,2
1,2
2
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
-
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f
1,2
1,2
1,2,3
1,2
1,2,3
1,2
DECFSZ
INCF
Z
INCFSZ
IORWF
MOVF
MOVWF
NOP
RLF
RRF
SUBWF
SWAPF
XORWF
Z
Z
1,2
Move W to f
No Operation
-
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
Rotate Left f through Carry
Rotate Right f through Carry
Subtract W from f
Swap nibbles in f
Exclusive OR W with f
C
C
1,2
1,2
1,2
1,2
1,2
C,DC,Z
Z
BIT-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS
BCF
BSF
BTFSC
BTFSS
f, b
f, b
f, b
f, b
Bit Clear f
Bit Set f
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
1
1
01
01
00bb bfff ffff
01bb bfff ffff
10bb bfff ffff
11bb bfff ffff
1,2
1,2
3
1 (2) 01
1 (2) 01
3
LITERAL AND CONTROL OPERATIONS
ADDLW
ANDLW
CALL
CLRWDT
GOTO
IORLW
MOVLW
RETFIE
RETLW
RETURN
SLEEP
SUBLW
XORLW
k
k
k
-
k
k
k
-
k
-
-
k
k
Add literal and W
AND literal with W
Call subroutine
Clear Watchdog Timer
Go to address
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
2
2
2
1
1
1
11
11
10
00
10
11
11
00
11
00
00
11
11
111x kkkk kkkk C,DC,Z
1001 kkkk kkkk
0kkk kkkk kkkk
Z
0000 0110 0100 TO,PD
1kkk kkkk kkkk
Inclusive OR literal with W
Move literal to W
1000 kkkk kkkk
00xx kkkk kkkk
0000 0000 1001
01xx kkkk kkkk
0000 0000 1000
Z
Return from interrupt
Return with literal in W
Return from Subroutine
Go into standby mode
Subtract W from literal
Exclusive OR literal with W
0000 0110 0011 TO,PD
110x kkkk kkkk C,DC,Z
1010 kkkk kkkk
Z
Note 1: When an I/O register is modified as a function of itself ( e.g., MOVF PORTB, 1), the value used will be that value present
on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is '1' for a pin configured as input and is driven low by an external
device, the data will be written back with a '0'.
2: If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and, where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if assigned
to the Timer0 Module.
3: If Program Counter (PC) is modified or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second cycle is
executed as a NOP.
DS30444E - page 120
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
15.1
Instruction Descriptions
Add Literal and W
ADDWF
Syntax:
Add W and f
ADDLW
[label] ADDWF f,d
Syntax:
[label] ADDLW
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
k
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
d
[0,1]
(W) + k → (W)
C, DC, Z
Operation:
(W) + (f) → (destination)
Status Affected:
Encoding:
C, DC, Z
11
111x
kkkk
kkkk
00
0111
dfff
ffff
The contents of the W register are
added to the eight bit literal 'k' and the
result is placed in the W register.
Description:
Add the contents of the W register with
register 'f'. If 'd' is 0 the result is stored
in the W register. If 'd' is 1 the result is
stored back in register 'f'.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Words:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Cycles:
Decode
Read
literal 'k'
Process
data
Write to
W
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
ADDLW
0x15
Example:
Before Instruction
ADDWF
FSR,
W
=
0x10
0x25
0
Example
After Instruction
Before Instruction
W
=
W
=
0x17
0xC2
FSR =
After Instruction
W
FSR =
=
0xD9
0xC2
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 121
PIC16C9XX
ANDWF
Syntax:
AND W with f
[label] ANDWF f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
ANDLW
AND Literal with W
Syntax:
[label] ANDLW
k
Operands:
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
d
[0,1]
(W) .AND. (k) → (W)
Operation:
(W) .AND. (f) → (destination)
Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
11
1001
kkkk
kkkk
00
0101
dfff
ffff
The contents of W register are
Description:
AND the W register with register 'f'. If 'd'
is 0 the result is stored in the W regis-
ter. If 'd' is 1 the result is stored back in
register 'f'.
AND’ed with the eight bit literal 'k'.The
result is placed in the W register.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Words:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Cycles:
Decode
Read
literal "k"
Process
data
Write to
W
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
ANDLW
0x5F
Example
Before Instruction
ANDWF
FSR,
1
Example
W
=
0xA3
0x03
After Instruction
Before Instruction
W
=
W
=
0x17
0xC2
FSR =
After Instruction
W
FSR =
=
0x17
0x02
BCF
Bit Clear f
Syntax:
Operands:
[label] BCF f,b
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0 ≤ b ≤ 7
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
0 → (f<b>)
None
01
00bb
bfff
ffff
Description:
Words:
Bit 'b' in register 'f' is cleared.
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write
register 'f'
BCF
FLAG_REG, 7
Example
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG = 0xC7
After Instruction
FLAG_REG = 0x47
DS30444E - page 122
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
BTFSC
Bit Test, Skip if Clear
BSF
Bit Set f
Syntax:
[label] BTFSC f,b
Syntax:
Operands:
[label] BSF f,b
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0 ≤ b ≤ 7
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0 ≤ b ≤ 7
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 0
None
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
1 → (f<b>)
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
01
10bb
bfff
ffff
01
01bb
bfff
ffff
If bit 'b' in register 'f' is '1' then the next
instruction is executed.
If bit 'b', in register 'f', is '0' then the next
instruction is discarded, and a NOP is
executed instead, making this a 2TCY
instruction.
Description:
Bit 'b' in register 'f' is set.
Description:
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Words:
1
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write
register 'f'
Cycles:
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
BSF
FLAG_REG,
7
Example
Decode
Read
register 'f'
Process
data
No-
Operation
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG = 0x0A
After Instruction
If Skip:
(2nd Cycle)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
FLAG_REG = 0x8A
No-
No-
No-
No-
Operation Operation Operation Operation
HERE
FALSE
TRUE
BTFSC
GOTO
•
•
•
FLAG,1
PROCESS_CODE
Example
Before Instruction
PC
=
address HERE
After Instruction
if FLAG<1> = 0,
PC =
address TRUE
if FLAG<1>=1,
PC =
address FALSE
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 123
PIC16C9XX
BTFSS
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
CALL
Call Subroutine
[ label ] CALL k
0 ≤ k ≤ 2047
Syntax:
[label] BTFSS f,b
Syntax:
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0 ≤ b < 7
Operands:
Operation:
(PC)+ 1→ TOS,
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 1
None
k → PC<10:0>,
(PCLATH<4:3>) → PC<12:11>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
01
11bb
bfff
ffff
10
0kkk
kkkk
kkkk
If bit 'b' in register 'f' is '0' then the next
instruction is executed.
If bit 'b' is '1', then the next instruction is
discarded and a NOP is executed
instead, making this a 2TCY instruction.
Description:
Call Subroutine. First, return address
(PC+1) is pushed onto the stack. The
eleven bit immediate address is loaded
into PC bits <10:0>. The upper bits of
the PC are loaded from PCLATH. CALL
is a two cycle instruction.
Description:
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Words:
1
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Cycles:
Decode
Read
register 'f'
Process
data
No-
Operation
Q Cycle Activity:
1st Cycle
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
Process
data
Write to
PC
If Skip:
(2nd Cycle)
literal 'k',
Push PC
to Stack
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No-
No-
No-
No-
No-
No-
No-
No-
2nd Cycle
Example
Operation Operation Operation Operation
Operation Operation Operation Operation
HERE
FALSE
TRUE
BTFSC
GOTO
FLAG,1
PROCESS_CODE
HERE
CALL
Example
THERE
•
•
•
Before Instruction
PC
=
Address HERE
After Instruction
PC
= Address THERE
Before Instruction
TOS = Address HERE+1
PC
=
address HERE
After Instruction
if FLAG<1> = 0,
PC =
address FALSE
if FLAG<1> = 1,
PC =
address TRUE
DS30444E - page 124
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
CLRF
Clear f
CLRW
Clear W
Syntax:
[label] CLRF
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
f
Syntax:
[ label ] CLRW
None
Operands:
Operation:
Operands:
Operation:
00h → (f)
1 → Z
00h → (W)
1 → Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
00
0001
1fff
ffff
00
0001
0xxx
xxxx
The contents of register 'f' are cleared
and the Z bit is set.
Description:
W register is cleared. Zero bit (Z) is
set.
Description:
Words:
1
1
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write
register 'f'
Decode
No-
Operation
Process
data
Write to
W
CLRW
Example
CLRF
FLAG_REG
Example
Before Instruction
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG
After Instruction
W
=
0x5A
=
0x5A
After Instruction
W
=
0x00
1
FLAG_REG
Z
=
=
0x00
1
Z
=
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 125
PIC16C9XX
COMF
Complement f
[ label ] COMF f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
CLRWDT
Syntax:
Clear Watchdog Timer
Syntax:
Operands:
[ label ] CLRWDT
None
Operands:
Operation:
d
[0,1]
00h → WDT
0 → WDT prescaler,
1 → TO
Operation:
(f) → (destination)
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
1 → PD
00
1001
dfff
ffff
Status Affected:
Encoding:
TO, PD
The contents of register 'f' are comple-
mented. If 'd' is 0 the result is stored in
W. If 'd' is 1 the result is stored back in
register 'f'.
Description:
00
0000
0110
0100
CLRWDTinstruction resets the Watch-
dog Timer. It also resets the prescaler
of the WDT. Status bits TO and PD are
set.
Description:
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Words:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Cycles:
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No-
Operation
Process
data
Clear
WDT
COMF
REG1,0
Counter
Example
Before Instruction
CLRWDT
REG1
After Instruction
REG1
=
0x13
Example
Before Instruction
After Instruction
=
=
0x13
0xEC
WDT counter
=
=
?
W
WDT counter
WDT prescaler=
TO
PD
0x00
DECF
Decrement f
[label] DECF f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0
1
1
=
=
Syntax:
Operands:
d
[0,1]
Operation:
(f) - 1 → (destination)
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
00
0011
dfff
ffff
Description:
Decrement register 'f'. If 'd' is 0 the
result is stored in the W register. If 'd' is
1 the result is stored back in register 'f'.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
DECF
CNT,
1
Example
Before Instruction
CNT
=
0x01
Z
=
0
After Instruction
CNT
Z
=
=
0x00
1
DS30444E - page 126
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
DECFSZ
Syntax:
Decrement f, Skip if 0
[ label ] DECFSZ f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
GOTO
Unconditional Branch
[ label ] GOTO k
0 ≤ k ≤ 2047
Syntax:
Operands:
Operands:
Operation:
d
[0,1]
k → PC<10:0>
Operation:
(f) - 1 → (destination);
PCLATH<4:3> → PC<12:11>
skip if result = 0
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
10
1kkk
kkkk
kkkk
00
1011
dfff
ffff
GOTOis an unconditional branch. The
eleven bit immediate value is loaded
into PC bits <10:0>. The upper bits of
PC are loaded from PCLATH<4:3>.
GOTOis a two cycle instruction.
Description:
The contents of register 'f' are decre-
mented. If 'd' is 0 the result is placed in the
W register. If 'd' is 1 the result is placed
back in register 'f'.
Description:
If the result is 1, the next instruction, is
executed. If the result is 0, then a NOP is
executed instead making it a 2TCY instruc-
tion.
Words:
1
2
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
1st Cycle
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Words:
1
Decode
Read
literal 'k'
Process
data
Write to
PC
Cycles:
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No-
No-
No-
No-
2nd Cycle
Operation Operation Operation Operation
Decode
Read
register 'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
GOTO THERE
Example
If Skip:
(2nd Cycle)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
After Instruction
PC
=
Address THERE
No-
No-
No-
No-
Operation Operation Operation Operation
HERE
DECFSZ
GOTO
CNT, 1
LOOP
Example
CONTINUE •
•
•
Before Instruction
PC
=
address HERE
After Instruction
CNT
if CNT =
PC
if CNT ≠
PC
=
CNT - 1
0,
address CONTINUE
0,
address HERE+1
=
=
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 127
PIC16C9XX
INCF
Increment f
INCFSZ
Syntax:
Increment f, Skip if 0
[ label ] INCFSZ f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Syntax:
Operands:
[ label ] INCF f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Operands:
d
[0,1]
d
[0,1]
Operation:
(f) + 1 → (destination)
Operation:
(f) + 1 → (destination),
skip if result = 0
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
00
1010
dfff
ffff
00
1111
dfff
ffff
The contents of register 'f' are incre-
mented. If 'd' is 0 the result is placed in
the W register. If 'd' is 1 the result is
placed back in register 'f'.
Description:
The contents of register 'f' are incre-
mented. If 'd' is 0 the result is placed in
the W register. If 'd' is 1 the result is
placed back in register 'f'.
Description:
If the result is 1, the next instruction is
executed. If the result is 0, a NOP is
executed instead making it a 2TCY
instruction.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Words:
1
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
Cycles:
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register 'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
INCF
CNT,
1
Example
Before Instruction
If Skip:
(2nd Cycle)
CNT
Z
=
=
0xFF
0
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
After Instruction
No-
No-
No-
No-
Operation Operation Operation Operation
CNT
Z
=
=
0x00
1
HERE
INCFSZ
GOTO
CNT, 1
LOOP
Example
CONTINUE •
•
•
Before Instruction
PC
=
address HERE
After Instruction
CNT
=
CNT + 1
if CNT=
0,
PC
if CNT≠
=
address CONTINUE
0,
PC
=
address HERE +1
DS30444E - page 128
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
IORLW
Inclusive OR Literal with W
[ label ] IORLW k
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
IORWF
Inclusive OR W with f
[ label ] IORWF f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Syntax:
Syntax:
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
Operands:
d
[0,1]
(W) .OR. k → (W)
Z
Operation:
(W) .OR. (f) → (destination)
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
11
1000
kkkk
kkkk
00
0100
dfff
ffff
The contents of the W register is
OR’ed with the eight bit literal 'k'. The
result is placed in the W register.
Inclusive OR the W register with regis-
ter 'f'. If 'd' is 0 the result is placed in the
W register. If 'd' is 1 the result is placed
back in register 'f'.
Description:
Words:
1
1
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal 'k'
Process
data
Write to
W
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
IORLW
0x35
Example
Before Instruction
IORWF
RESULT, 0
Example
W
=
0x9A
After Instruction
Before Instruction
W
=
0xBF
1
RESULT =
W
0x13
0x91
Z
=
=
After Instruction
RESULT =
0x13
0x93
1
W
Z
=
=
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 129
PIC16C9XX
MOVF
Move f
MOVWF
Move W to f
[ label ] MOVWF
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
(W) → (f)
Syntax:
Operands:
[ label ] MOVF f,d
Syntax:
f
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
d
[0,1]
Operation:
(f) → (destination)
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
00
0000
1fff
ffff
00
1000
dfff
ffff
Move data from W register to register
'f'.
The contents of register f is moved to a
destination dependant upon the status
of d. If d = 0, destination is W register. If
d = 1, the destination is file register f
itself. d = 1 is useful to test a file regis-
ter since status flag Z is affected.
Description:
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Words:
1
1
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write
register 'f'
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
MOVWF
OPTION_REG
Example
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
Before Instruction
OPTION =
0xFF
0x4F
W
=
MOVF
FSR,
After Instruction
0
Example
OPTION =
W
0x4F
0x4F
After Instruction
=
W = value in FSR register
Z
= 1
MOVLW
Move Literal to W
[ label ] MOVLW k
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Syntax:
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
k → (W)
None
11
00xx
kkkk
kkkk
The eight bit literal 'k' is loaded into W
register.The don’t cares will assemble
as 0’s.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal 'k'
Process
data
Write to
W
MOVLW
0x5A
Example
After Instruction
W
=
0x5A
DS30444E - page 130
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
NOP
No Operation
[ label ] NOP
None
RETFIE
Return from Interrupt
[ label ] RETFIE
None
Syntax:
Syntax:
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
Words:
Operands:
Operation:
No operation
None
TOS → PC,
1 → GIE
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
00
0000
0xx0
0000
00
0000
0000
1001
No operation.
Return from Interrupt. Stack is POPed
and Top of Stack (TOS) is loaded in the
PC. Interrupts are enabled by setting
Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE
(INTCON<7>). This is a two cycle
instruction.
Description:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No-
No-
No-
Operation Operation Operation
Words:
1
2
Cycles:
NOP
Example
Q Cycle Activity:
1st Cycle
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No-
Set the
Pop from
the Stack
Operation GIE bit
No-
No- No-
No-
2nd Cycle
Operation Operation Operation Operation
RETFIE
Example
After Interrupt
PC
GIE =
=
TOS
1
OPTION
Syntax:
Load Option Register
[ label ] OPTION
None
Operands:
Operation:
(W) → OPTION
Status Affected: None
00
0000
0110
0010
Encoding:
The contents of the W register are
loaded in the OPTION register. This
instruction is supported for code com-
patibility with PIC16C5X products.
Since OPTION is a readable/writable
register, the user can directly address
it.
Description:
Words:
Cycles:
Example
1
1
To maintain upward compatibility
with future PIC16CXX products, do
not use this instruction.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 131
PIC16C9XX
RETLW
Return with Literal in W
RETURN
Return from Subroutine
[ label ] RETURN
None
Syntax:
[ label ] RETLW k
Syntax:
Operands:
Operation:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
k → (W);
TOS → PC
TOS → PC
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
00
0000
0000
1000
11
01xx
kkkk
kkkk
Return from subroutine. The stack is
POPed and the top of the stack (TOS)
is loaded into the program counter.This
is a two cycle instruction.
The W register is loaded with the eight
bit literal 'k'. The program counter is
loaded from the top of the stack (the
return address). This is a two cycle
instruction.
Description:
Words:
1
2
Cycles:
Words:
1
2
Q Cycle Activity:
1st Cycle
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Cycles:
Decode
No-
No-
Pop from
Q Cycle Activity:
1st Cycle
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Operation Operation the Stack
Decode
Read
No-
WritetoW,
No-
No- No- No-
2nd Cycle
literal 'k' Operation Pop from
the Stack
Operation Operation Operation Operation
No-
No-
No-
No-
2nd Cycle
Example
RETURN
Operation Operation Operation Operation
Example
After Interrupt
PC
=
TOS
CALL TABLE ;W contains table
;offset value
•
;W now has table value
•
•
TABLE
ADDWF PC
RETLW k1
RETLW k2
•
;W = offset
;Begin table
;
•
•
RETLW kn
; End of table
Before Instruction
W
=
0x07
After Instruction
W
=
value of k8
DS30444E - page 132
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
RLF
Rotate Left f through Carry
RRF
Rotate Right f through Carry
[ label ] RRF f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Syntax:
Operands:
[ label ]
RLF f,d
Syntax:
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d
[0,1]
d
[0,1]
Operation:
See description below
C
Operation:
See description below
C
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
00
1101
dfff
ffff
00
1100
dfff
ffff
The contents of register 'f' are rotated
one bit to the left through the Carry
Flag. If 'd' is 0 the result is placed in the
W register. If 'd' is 1 the result is stored
back in register 'f'.
The contents of register 'f' are rotated
one bit to the right through the Carry
Flag. If 'd' is 0 the result is placed in the
W register. If 'd' is 1 the result is placed
back in register 'f'.
Description:
Description:
C
Register f
C
Register f
Words:
1
1
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
RLF
REG1,0
RRF
Example
REG1,0
Example
Before Instruction
Before Instruction
REG1
C
=
=
1110 0110
0
REG1
C
=
=
1110 0110
0
After Instruction
After Instruction
REG1
W
C
=
=
=
1110 0110
1100 1100
1
REG1
W
C
=
=
=
1110 0110
0111 0011
0
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 133
PIC16C9XX
SLEEP
SUBLW
Subtract W from Literal
Syntax:
[ label ]
SUBLW k
Syntax:
[ label ] SLEEP
Operands:
Operation:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
Operation:
None
k - (W) → (W)
00h → WDT,
0 → WDT prescaler,
1 → TO,
Status Affected: C, DC, Z
Encoding:
11
110x
kkkk
kkkk
0 → PD
The W register is subtracted (2’s comple-
ment method) from the eight bit literal 'k'.
The result is placed in the W register.
Description:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
TO, PD
00
0000
0110
0011
The power-down status bit, PD is
cleared. Time-out status bit, TO is
set. Watchdog Timer and its pres-
caler are cleared.
The processor is put into SLEEP
mode with the oscillator stopped. See
Section 14.8 for more details.
Description:
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal 'k'
Process Write to W
data
Words:
1
1
Example 1:
SUBLW
0x02
Cycles:
Before Instruction
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
W
C
Z
=
=
=
1
?
?
Decode
No-
No-
Go to
Operation Operation Sleep
After Instruction
Example:
SLEEP
W
C
Z
=
=
=
1
1; result is positive
0
Example 2:
Before Instruction
W
C
Z
=
=
=
2
?
?
After Instruction
W
C
Z
=
=
=
0
1; result is zero
1
Example 3:
Before Instruction
W
C
Z
=
=
=
3
?
?
After Instruction
W
C
=
=
0xFF
0; result is nega-
tive
Z
=
0
DS30444E - page 134
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
SUBWF
Syntax:
Subtract W from f
SWAPF
Syntax:
Swap Nibbles in f
[ label ]
SUBWF f,d
[ label ] SWAPF f,d
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d
[0,1]
d
[0,1]
Operation:
(f) - (W) → (destination)
Operation:
(f<3:0>) → (destination<7:4>),
(f<7:4>) → (destination<3:0>)
Status Affected: C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Encoding:
00
0010
dfff
ffff
00
1110
dfff
ffff
Subtract (2’s complement method) W reg-
ister from register 'f'. If 'd' is 0 the result is
stored in the W register. If 'd' is 1 the
result is stored back in register 'f'.
Description:
The upper and lower nibbles of register
'f' are exchanged. If 'd' is 0 the result is
placed in W register. If 'd' is 1 the result
is placed in register 'f'.
Description:
Words:
1
1
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register 'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
Decode
Read
register 'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
Example 1:
SUBWF
REG1,1
SWAPF
REG,
0
Example
Before Instruction
Before Instruction
REG1
REG1
=
=
=
=
3
2
?
?
W
C
Z
=
0xA5
After Instruction
REG1
W
=
=
0xA5
0x5A
After Instruction
REG1
=
1
2
W
C
Z
=
=
=
1; result is positive
0
Example 2:
Before Instruction
TRIS
Load TRIS Register
REG1
=
=
=
=
2
2
?
?
Syntax:
[label] TRIS
f
W
C
Z
Operands:
Operation:
5 ≤ f ≤ 7
(W) → TRIS register f;
After Instruction
Status Affected: None
REG1
=
0
2
00
0000 0110
0fff
Encoding:
W
C
Z
=
=
=
1; result is zero
1
The instruction is supported for code
compatibility with the PIC16C5X prod-
ucts. Since TRIS registers are read-
able and writable, the user can directly
address them.
Description:
Example 3:
Before Instruction
REG1
=
=
=
=
1
2
?
?
W
C
Z
Words:
Cycles:
Example
1
1
After Instruction
REG1
=
0xFF
2
0; result is negative
0
To maintain upward compatibility
with future PIC16CXX products, do
not use this instruction.
W
C
Z
=
=
=
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 135
PIC16C9XX
XORLW
Exclusive OR Literal with W
[label] XORLW k
XORWF
Syntax:
Exclusive OR W with f
[label] XORWF f,d
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Syntax:
Operands:
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
d
[0,1]
(W) .XOR. k → (W)
Operation:
(W) .XOR. (f) → (destination)
Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
11
1010 kkkk kkkk
00
0110
dfff
ffff
The contents of the W register are
XOR’ed with the eight bit literal 'k'.
The result is placed in the W regis-
ter.
Exclusive OR the contents of the W
register with register 'f'. If 'd' is 0 the
result is stored in the W register. If 'd' is
1 the result is stored back in register 'f'.
Description:
Words:
1
1
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
Process Write to
literal 'k'
data
W
Decode
Read
register
'f'
Process
data
Write to
destination
Example:
XORLW
0xAF
REG
Before Instruction
1
Example
XORWF
W
=
0xB5
0x1A
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
0xAF
0xB5
After Instruction
W
=
After Instruction
REG
W
=
=
0x1A
0xB5
DS30444E - page 136
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
16.3
ICEPIC: Low-Cost PIC16CXXX
In-Circuit Emulator
16.0 DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
16.1
Development Tools
ICEPIC is a low-cost in-circuit emulator solution for the
Microchip PIC16C5X and PIC16CXXX families of 8-bit
OTP microcontrollers.
The PICmicrο microcontrollers are supported with a
full range of hardware and software development tools:
• PICMASTER/PICMASTER CE Real-Time
In-Circuit Emulator
ICEPIC is designed to operate on PC-compatible
machines ranging from 286-AT through Pentium
based machines under Windows 3.x environment.
ICEPIC features real time, non-intrusive emulation.
• ICEPIC Low-Cost PIC16C5X and PIC16CXXX
In-Circuit Emulator
• PRO MATE II Universal Programmer
16.4
PRO MATE II: Universal Programmer
• PICSTART Plus Entry-Level Prototype
Programmer
The PRO MATE II Universal Programmer is a full-fea-
tured programmer capable of operating in stand-alone
mode as well as PC-hosted mode.
• PICDEM-1 Low-Cost Demonstration Board
• PICDEM-2 Low-Cost Demonstration Board
• PICDEM-3 Low-Cost Demonstration Board
• MPASM Assembler
The PRO MATE II has programmable VDD and VPP
supplies which allows it to verify programmed memory
at VDD min and VDD max for maximum reliability. It has
an LCD display for displaying error messages, keys to
enter commands and a modular detachable socket
assembly to support various package types. In stand-
alone mode the PRO MATE II can read, verify or pro-
• MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
• MPLAB-C (C Compiler)
• Fuzzy Logic Development System
(fuzzyTECH −MP)
gram
PIC12CXXX,
PIC14C000,
PIC16C5X,
16.2
PICMASTER: High Performance
Universal In-Circuit Emulator with
MPLAB IDE
PIC16CXXX and PIC17CXX devices. It can also set
configuration and code-protect bits in this mode.
16.5
PICSTART Plus Entry Level
Development System
The PICMASTER Universal In-Circuit Emulator is
intended to provide the product development engineer
with a complete microcontroller design tool set for all
microcontrollers in the PIC12CXXX, PIC14C000,
PIC16C5X, PIC16CXXX and PIC17CXX families.
PICMASTER is supplied with the MPLAB Integrated
Development Environment (IDE), which allows editing,
“make” and download, and source debugging from a
single environment.
The PICSTART programmer is an easy-to-use, low-
cost prototype programmer. It connects to the PC via
one of the COM (RS-232) ports. MPLAB Integrated
Development Environment software makes using the
programmer simple and efficient. PICSTART Plus is not
recommended for production programming.
PICSTART Plus supports all PIC12CXXX, PIC14C000,
PIC16C5X, PIC16CXXX and PIC17CXX devices with
up to 40 pins. Larger pin count devices such as the
PIC16C923 and PIC16C924 may be supported with an
adapter socket.
Interchangeable target probes allow the system to be
easily reconfigured for emulation of different proces-
sors. The universal architecture of the PICMASTER
allows expansion to support all new Microchip micro-
controllers.
The PICMASTER Emulator System has been designed
as a real-time emulation system with advanced fea-
tures that are generally found on more expensive devel-
opment tools. The PC compatible 386 (and higher)
machine platform and Microsoft Windows 3.x environ-
ment were chosen to best make these features avail-
able to you, the end user.
A CE compliant version of PICMASTER is available for
European Union (EU) countries.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 137
PIC16C9XX
an RS-232 interface, push-button switches, a potenti-
ometer for simulated analog input, a thermistor and
separate headers for connection to an external LCD
module and a keypad. Also provided on the PICDEM-3
board is an LCD panel, with 4 commons and 12 seg-
ments, that is capable of displaying time, temperature
and day of the week. The PICDEM-3 provides an addi-
tional RS-232 interface and Windows 3.1 software for
showing the demultiplexed LCD signals on a PC. A sim-
ple serial interface allows the user to construct a hard-
ware demultiplexer for the LCD signals.
16.6
PICDEM-1 Low-Cost PICmicro
Demonstration Board
The PICDEM-1 is a simple board which demonstrates
the capabilities of several of Microchip’s microcontrol-
lers. The microcontrollers supported are: PIC16C5X
(PIC16C54 to PIC16C58A), PIC16C61, PIC16C62X,
PIC16C71, PIC16C8X, PIC17C42, PIC17C43 and
PIC17C44. All necessary hardware and software is
included to run basic demo programs. The users can
program the sample microcontrollers provided with
the PICDEM-1 board, on a PRO MATE II or
PICSTART-Plus programmer, and easily test firm-
ware. The user can also connect the PICDEM-1
board to the PICMASTER emulator and download
the firmware to the emulator for testing. Additional pro-
totype area is available for the user to build some addi-
tional hardware and connect it to the microcontroller
socket(s). Some of the features include an RS-232
interface, a potentiometer for simulated analog input,
push-button switches and eight LEDs connected to
PORTB.
16.9
MPLAB™ Integrated Development
Environment Software
The MPLAB IDE Software brings an ease of software
development previously unseen in the 8-bit microcon-
troller market. MPLAB is a windows based application
which contains:
• A full featured editor
• Three operating modes
- editor
- emulator
- simulator
• A project manager
• Customizable tool bar and key mapping
• A status bar with project information
• Extensive on-line help
16.7
PICDEM-2 Low-Cost PIC16CXX
Demonstration Board
The PICDEM-2 is a simple demonstration board that
supports the PIC16C62, PIC16C64, PIC16C65,
PIC16C73 and PIC16C74 microcontrollers. All the
necessary hardware and software is included to
run the basic demonstration programs. The user
can program the sample microcontrollers provided
with the PICDEM-2 board, on a PRO MATE II pro-
grammer or PICSTART-Plus, and easily test firmware.
The PICMASTER emulator may also be used with the
PICDEM-2 board to test firmware. Additional prototype
area has been provided to the user for adding addi-
tional hardware and connecting it to the microcontroller
socket(s). Some of the features include a RS-232 inter-
face, push-button switches, a potentiometer for simu-
lated analog input, a Serial EEPROM to demonstrate
MPLAB allows you to:
• Edit your source files (either assembly or ‘C’)
• One touch assemble (or compile) and download
to PICmicro tools (automatically updates all
project information)
• Debug using:
- source files
- absolute listing file
• Transfer data dynamically via DDE (soon to be
replaced by OLE)
• Run up to four emulators on the same PC
The ability to use MPLAB with Microchip’s simulator
allows a consistent platform and the ability to easily
switch from the low cost simulator to the full featured
emulator with minimal retraining due to development
tools.
2
usage of the I C bus and separate headers for connec-
tion to an LCD module and a keypad.
16.8
PICDEM-3 Low-Cost PIC16CXXX
Demonstration Board
16.10 Assembler (MPASM)
The PICDEM-3 is a simple demonstration board that
supports the PIC16C923 and PIC16C924 in the PLCC
package. It will also support future 44-pin PLCC
microcontrollers with a LCD Module. All the neces-
sary hardware and software is included to run the
basic demonstration programs. The user can pro-
gram the sample microcontrollers provided with
the PICDEM-3 board, on a PRO MATE II program-
mer or PICSTART Plus with an adapter socket, and
easily test firmware. The PICMASTER emulator may
also be used with the PICDEM-3 board to test firmware.
Additional prototype area has been provided to the
user for adding hardware and connecting it to the
microcontroller socket(s). Some of the features include
The MPASM Universal Macro Assembler is a PC-
hosted symbolic assembler. It supports all microcon-
troller series including the PIC12C5XX, PIC14000,
PIC16C5X, PIC16CXXX, and PIC17CXX families.
MPASM offers full featured Macro capabilities, condi-
tional assembly, and several source and listing formats.
It generates various object code formats to support
Microchip's development tools as well as third party
programmers.
MPASM allows full symbolic debugging from
PICMASTER, Microchip’s Universal Emulator System.
DS30444E - page 138
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
MPASM has the following features to assist in develop-
ing software for specific use applications.
16.14 MP-DriveWay – Application Code
Generator
• Provides translation of Assembler source code to
object code for all Microchip microcontrollers.
MP-DriveWay is an easy-to-use Windows-based Appli-
cation Code Generator. With MP-DriveWay you can
visually configure all the peripherals in a PICmicro
device and, with a click of the mouse, generate all the
initialization and many functional code modules in C
language. The output is fully compatible with Micro-
chip’s MPLAB-C C compiler. The code produced is
highly modular and allows easy integration of your own
code. MP-DriveWay is intelligent enough to maintain
your code through subsequent code generation.
• Macro assembly capability.
• Produces all the files (Object, Listing, Symbol,
and special) required for symbolic debug with
Microchip’s emulator systems.
• Supports Hex (default), Decimal and Octal source
and listing formats.
MPASM provides a rich directive language to support
programming of the PICmicro. Directives are helpful in
making the development of your assemble source code
shorter and more maintainable.
16.15 SEEVAL Evaluation and
Programming System
16.11 Software Simulator (MPLAB-SIM)
The SEEVAL SEEPROM Designer’s Kit supports all
Microchip 2-wire and 3-wire Serial EEPROMs. The kit
includes everything necessary to read, write, erase or
program special features of any Microchip SEEPROM
product including Smart Serials and secure serials.
The Total Endurance Disk is included to aid in trade-
off analysis and reliability calculations. The total kit can
significantly reduce time-to-market and result in an opti-
mized system.
The MPLAB-SIM Software Simulator allows code
development in a PC host environment. It allows the
user to simulate the PICmicro series microcontrollers
on an instruction level. On any given instruction, the
user may examine or modify any of the data areas or
provide external stimulus to any of the pins. The input/
output radix can be set by the user and the execution
can be performed in; single step, execute until break, or
in a trace mode.
16.16 KEELOQ Evaluation and
Programming Tools
MPLAB-SIM fully supports symbolic debugging using
MPLAB-C and MPASM. The Software Simulator offers
the low cost flexibility to develop and debug code out-
side of the laboratory environment making it an excel-
lent multi-project software development tool.
KEELOQ evaluation and programming tools support
Microchips HCS Secure Data Products.The HCS eval-
uation kit includes an LCD display to show changing
codes, a decoder to decode transmissions, and a pro-
gramming interface to program test transmitters.
16.12 C Compiler (MPLAB-C)
The MPLAB-C Code Development System is a
complete ‘C’ compiler and integrated development
environment for Microchip’s PICmicro family of micro-
controllers. The compiler provides powerful integration
capabilities and ease of use not found with other
compilers.
For easier source level debugging, the compiler pro-
vides symbol information that is compatible with the
MPLAB IDE memory display.
16.13 Fuzzy Logic Development System
(fuzzyTECH-MP)
fuzzyTECH-MP fuzzy logic development tool is avail-
able in two versions - a low cost introductory version,
MP Explorer, for designers to gain a comprehensive
working knowledge of fuzzy logic system design; and a
full-featured version, fuzzyTECH-MP, edition for imple-
menting more complex systems.
Both versions include Microchip’s fuzzyLAB demon-
stration board for hands-on experience with fuzzy logic
systems implementation.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 139
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 16-1: DEVELOPMENT TOOLS FROM MICROCHIP
ufzy
D e m o B o a r d s
E m u l a t o r P r o d u c t s
S o f t w a r e T o o l s
P r o g r a m m e r s
DS30444E - page 140
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
17.0 ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Absolute Maximum Ratings †
Ambient temperature under bias............................................................................................................ .-55˚C to +125˚C
Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65˚C to +150˚C
Voltage on any pin with respect to VSS (except VDD, MCLR, and RA4)..........................................-0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V)
Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ......................................................................................................... -0.3V to +7.5V
Voltage on MCLR with respect to VSS............................................................................................................. 0V to +14V
Voltage on RA4 with respect to Vss ................................................................................................................ 0V to +14V
Total power dissipation (Note 1)................................................................................................................................1.0W
Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA
Maximum current into VDD pin ..............................................................................................................................250 mA
Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD).....................................................................................................................± 20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDD).............................................................................................................± 20 mA
Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin .........................................................................................................10 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin ...................................................................................................10 mA
Maximum current sunk by all Ports combined ......................................................................................................200 mA
Maximum current sourced by all Ports combined ................................................................................................200 mA
Note 1: Power dissipation is calculated as follows: PDIS = VDD x {IDD - ∑ IOH} + ∑ {(VDD - VOH) x IOH} + ∑(VOl x IOL)
† NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the
device.This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those
indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability.
TABLE 17-1: CROSS REFERENCE OF DEVICE SPECS FOR OSCILLATOR CONFIGURATIONS AND
FREQUENCIES OF OPERATION (COMMERCIAL DEVICES)
PIC16C923-04
PIC16C924-04
PIC16C923-08
PIC16C924-08
PIC16LC923-04
PIC16LC924-04
OSC
CL Devices
VDD: 4.0V to 6.0V
VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V
VDD: 2.5V to 6.0V
VDD: 2.5V to 6.0V
IDD: 5 mA max. at 5.5V
IPD: 21 µA max. at 4V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
IDD: 2.7 mA typ. at 5.5V
IPD: 1.5 µA typ. at 4V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
IDD: 3.8 mA max. at 3.0V
IPD: 5 µA max. at 3V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
IDD: 5 mA max. at 5.5V
IPD: 21 µA max. at 4V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
RC
VDD: 4.0V to 6.0V
VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V
VDD: 2.5V to 6.0V
VDD: 2.5V to 6.0V
IDD: 5 mA max. at 5.5V
IPD: 21 µA max. at 4V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
IDD: 2.7 mA typ. at 5.5V
IPD: 1.5 µA typ. at 4V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
IDD: 3.8 mA max. at 3.0V
IPD: 5 µA max. at 3V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
IDD: 5 mA max. at 5.5V
IPD: 21 µA max. at 4V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
XT
HS
VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V
VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V
VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V
IDD: 3.5 mA typ. at 5.5V
IPD: 1.5 µA typ. at 4.5V
Freq: 4 MHz max.
IDD: 7 mA max. at 5.5V
IPD: 1.5 µA typ. at 4.5V
Freq: 8 MHz max.
IDD: 7 mA max. at 5.5V
IPD: 1.5 µA typ. at 4.5V
Freq: 8 MHz max.
Do not use in HS mode
VDD: 4.0V to 6.0V
IDD: 22.5 µA typ.
at 32 kHz, 4.0V
IPD: 1.5 µA typ. at 4.0V
Freq: 200 kHz max.
VDD: 2.5V to 6.0V
IDD: 30 µA max.
at 32 kHz, 3.0V
IPD: 5 µA max. at 3.0V
Freq: 200 kHz max.
VDD: 2.5V to 6.0V
IDD: 30 µA max. at 32 kHz, 3.0V
IPD: 5 µA max. at 3.0V
Freq: 200 kHz max.
LP
Do not use in LP mode
The shaded sections indicate oscillator selections which are tested for functionality, but not for MIN/MAX specifications.
It is recommended that the user select the device type that ensures the specifications required.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 141
PIC16C9XX
17.1
DC Characteristics:
PIC16C923/924-04 (Commercial, Industrial)
PIC16C923/924-08 (Commercial, Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40˚C
0˚C
≤ TA ≤ +85˚C for industrial and
≤ TA ≤ +70˚C for commercial
Param
No.
Characteristic
Sym
Min Typ† Max Units
Conditions
D001 Supply Voltage
D001A
VDD
4.0
4.5
-
-
6.0
5.5
V
V
XT, RC and LP osc configuration
HS osc configuration
D002* RAM Data Retention
Voltage (Note 1)
VDR
-
1.5
-
V
D003
VDD start voltage to
ensure internal
VPOR
-
VSS
-
V
See Power-on Reset section for details
Power-on Reset signal
D004* VDD rise rate to ensure SVDD
internal Power-on
0.05
-
-
V/ms (Note 6) See Power-on Reset section for
details
Reset signal
D010 Supply Current (Note 2) IDD
-
-
-
2.7
5
mA XT and RC osc configuration
FOSC = 4 MHz, VDD = 5.5V (Note 4)
µA LP osc configuration,
FOSC = 32 kHz, VDD = 4.0V
mA HS osc configuration
D011
D012
22.5 48
3.5
1.5
7
FOSC = 8 MHz, VDD = 5.5V
D020 Power-down Current
(Note 3)
IPD
-
21
µA VDD = 4.0V
Module Differential Cur-
rent (Note 5)
D021 Watchdog Timer
∆IWDT
-
-
6.0
40
20
55
µA VDD = 4.0V
D022* LCDVoltage Generation ∆ILCDRC
w/internal RC osc
µA VDD = 4.0V (Note 7)
enabled
D024* LCDVoltage Generation ∆ILCDT1
-
33
60
µA VDD = 4.0V (Note 7)
w/Timer1 @ 32.768 kHz
D025* Timer1 oscillator
D026* A/D Converter
∆IT1OSC
∆IAD
-
-
10.6 17
1.0
µA VDD = 4.0V
-
µA A/D on, not converting
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25˚C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only
and are not tested.
Note 1: This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered in SLEEP mode without losing RAM data.
2: The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern, and temperature also have an
impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail to rail; all I/O pins tristated, pulled to VDD
MCLR = VDD.
3: The power-down current in SLEEP mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is
measured with the part in SLEEP mode, with all I/O pins in hi-impedance state and tied to VDD and VSS.
4: For RC osc configuration, current through Rext is not included. The current through the resistor can be esti-
mated by the formula Ir = VDD/2Rext (mA) with Rext in kOhm.
5: The ∆ current is the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. This current should be
added to the base IDD or IPD measurement.
6: PWRT must be enabled for slow ramps.
7: ∆ΙLCDT1 and ∆ΙLCDRC includes the current consumed by the LCD Module and the voltage generation cir-
cuitry. This does not include current dissipated by the LCD panel.
DS30444E - page 142
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
17.2
DC Characteristics:
PIC16LC923/924-04 (Commercial, Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40˚C
0˚C
≤ TA ≤ +85˚C for industrial and
≤ TA ≤ +70˚C for commercial
Param
No.
Characteristic
Sym
Min Typ† Max Units
Conditions
D001 Supply Voltage
VDD
2.5
-
-
6.0
-
V
V
LP, XT, RC osc configuration
D002* RAM Data Retention
Voltage (Note 1)
VDR
1.5
D003
VDD start voltage to
ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
VPOR
-
VSS
-
-
-
V
See Power-on Reset section for details
D004* VDD rise rate to ensure SVDD
internal Power-on
0.05
V/ms (Note 6) See Power-on Reset section for
details
Reset signal
D010 Supply Current (Note 2) IDD
-
-
2.0 3.8 mA XT and RC osc configuration
FOSC = 4 MHz, VDD = 3.0V (Note 4)
D011
13.5 30
µA LP osc configuration,
FOSC = 32 kHz, VDD = 4.0V
D020 Power-down Current
(Note 3)
IPD
-
0.9
5
µA VDD = 3.0V
Module Differential Cur-
rent (Note 5)
D021 Watchdog Timer
∆IWDT
-
-
6.0
36
20
50
µA VDD = 3.0V
D022* LCDVoltage Generation ∆ILCDRC
w/internal RC osc
µA VDD = 3.0V (Note 7)
enabled
D024* LCDVoltage Generation ∆ILCDT1
-
15
29
µA VDD = 3.0V (Note 7)
w/Timer1 @ 32.768 kHz
D025* Timer1 oscillator
D026* A/D Converter
∆IT1OSC
∆IAD
-
-
3.1 6.5
1.0
µA VDD = 3.0V
-
µA A/D on, not converting
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25˚C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only
and are not tested.
Note 1: This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered in SLEEP mode without losing RAM data.
2: The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern, and temperature also have an
impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail to rail; all I/O pins tristated, pulled to VDD
MCLR = VDD.
3: The power-down current in SLEEP mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is
measured with the part in SLEEP mode, with all I/O pins in hi-impedance state and tied to VDD and VSS.
4: For RC osc configuration, current through Rext is not included. The current through the resistor can be esti-
mated by the formula Ir = VDD/2Rext (mA) with Rext in kOhm.
5: The ∆ current is the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. This current should be
added to the base IDD or IPD measurement.
6: PWRT must be enabled for slow ramps.
7: ∆ΙLCDT1 and ∆ΙLCDRC includes the current consumed by the LCD Module and the voltage generation cir-
cuitry. This does not include current dissipated by the LCD panel.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 143
PIC16C9XX
17.3
DC Characteristics:
PIC16C923/924-04 (Commercial, Industrial)
PIC16C923/924-08 (Commercial, Industrial)
PIC16LC923/924-04 (Commercial, Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40˚C ≤ TA ≤ +85˚C for industrial and
0˚C ≤ TA ≤ +70˚C for commercial
Operating voltage VDD range as described in DC spec
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Characteristic
Sym
Min Typ Max Units
†
Conditions
Input Low Voltage
I/O ports
VIL
D030
D031
with TTL buffer
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
-
-
-
-
-
0.15VDD
0.8V
0.2VDD
0.2VDD
0.3VDD
V
V
V
V
V
For entire VDD range
4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
D032 MCLR, OSC1 (in RC mode)
D033 OSC1 (in XT, HS and LP)
Input High Voltage
Note1
I/O ports
VIH
-
-
-
D040
D040A
with TTL buffer
2.0
VDD
VDD
V
V
4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
For entire VDD range
0.25VDD
+ 0.8V
0.8VDD
0.8VDD
0.7VDD
0.9VDD
50
D041
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
D042 MCLR
-
-
-
-
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
V
V
V
V
D042A OSC1 (XT, HS and LP)
D043 OSC1 (in RC mode)
D070 PORTB weak pull-up current
Input Leakage Current
(Notes 2, 3)
D060 I/O ports
D061 MCLR, RA4/T0CKI
D063 OSC1
Note1
IPURB
IIL
250 400
µA VDD = 5V, VPIN = VSS
-
-
-
-
-
-
±1.0
±5
±5
µA Vss ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD, Pin at hi-Z
µA Vss ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
µA Vss ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD, XT, HS and LP osc
configuration
Output Low Voltage
D080 I/O ports
D083 OSC2/CLKOUT (RC osc mode)
VOL
-
-
-
-
0.6
0.6
V
V
IOL = 4.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V
IOL = 1.6 mA, VDD = 4.5V
Output High Voltage
D090 I/O ports (Note 3)
D092 OSC2/CLKOUT (RC osc mode)
Capacitive Loading Specs on
Output Pins
VOH VDD - 0.7 -
VDD - 0.7 -
-
-
V
V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V
IOH = -1.3 mA, VDD = 4.5V
D100* OSC2 pin
COSC2
-
-
15
pF In XT, HS and LP modes when exter-
nal clock is used to drive OSC1.
D101* All I/O pins and OSC2 (in RC)
CIO
CB
-
-
-
-
50
400
pF
pF
2
D102*
SCL, SDA in I C mode
D150* Open -Drain High Voltage
VDD
-
-
14
V
RA4 pin
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only
and are not tested.
Note 1: In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKIN pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that the
PIC16C9XX be driven with external clock in RC mode.
2: The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified lev-
els represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input volt-
ages.
3: Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
DS30444E - page 144
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-1: LCD VOLTAGE WAVEFORM
D223
D224
VLCD3
VLCD2
VLCD1
VSS
TABLE 17-2: LCD MODULE ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Parameter
No.
Sym
VLCD3
VLCD2
VLCD1
VOH
Characteristic
Min
VDD - 0.3
—
Typ†
Max
Vss + 7.0
VLCD3
Units
Conditions
D200
LCD Voltage on pin
VLCD3
—
V
V
V
V
V
D201
LCD Voltage on pin
VLCD2
—
D202
LCD Voltage on pin
VLCD1
—
—
VDD
D220*
D221*
D222*
D223*
Output High
Voltage
Max VLCDN -
0.1
—
Max VLCDN
COM outputs IOH = 25 µA
SEG outputs IOH = 3 µA
VOL
Output Low Voltage
Min VLCDN
—
Min VLCDN +
0.1
COM outputs IOL = 25 µA
SEG outputs IOL = 3 µA
FLCDRC LCDRC Oscillator Fre-
quency
5
15
—
50
kHz VDD = 5V, -40˚C to +85˚C
TrLCD
Output Rise Time
—
200
µs
µs
COM outputs Cload = 5,000 pF
SEG outputs Cload = 500 pF
VDD = 5.0V, T = 25°C
D224*
TfLCD
Output Fall Time (1)
—
—
200
COM outputs Cload = 5,000 pF
SEG outputs Cload = 500 pF
VDD = 5.0V, T = 25°C
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
(1) 0 ohm source impedance at VLCD.
TABLE 17-3: VLCD CHARGE PUMP ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Parameter
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
No.
D250*
D252*
D265*
IVADJ
VLCDADJ regulated current output
—
—
10
—
—
—
0.1/1
2.3
µA
µA/V
V
∆ IVADJ/∆ VDD VLCDADJ current VDD Rejection
VVADJ
VLCDADJ voltage limits PIC16C92X
PIC16LC92X
1.0
1.0
VDD -
0.7V
V
VDD < 3V
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
Note 1: For design guidance only.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 145
PIC16C9XX
17.4
Timing Parameter Symbology
The timing parameter symbols have been created following one of the following formats:
2
1. TppS2ppS
3. TCC:ST
4. Ts
(I C specifications only)
2
2. TppS
(I C specifications only)
T
F
Frequency
T
Time
Lowercase letters (pp) and their meanings:
pp
cc
CCP1
CLKOUT
CS
osc
rd
OSC1
RD
ck
cs
di
rw
sc
ss
t0
RD or WR
SCK
SDI
do
dt
SDO
SS
Data in
I/O port
MCLR
T0CKI
T1CKI
WR
io
t1
mc
wr
Uppercase letters and their meanings:
S
F
H
I
Fall
P
R
V
Z
Period
High
Rise
Invalid (Hi-impedance)
Low
Valid
L
Hi-impedance
2
I C only
AA
output access
Bus free
High
Low
High
Low
BUF
2
TCC:ST (I C specifications only)
CC
HD
ST
DAT
STA
Hold
SU
Setup
DATA input hold
START condition
STO
STOP condition
DS30444E - page 146
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-2: LOAD CONDITIONS
Load condition 1
Load condition 2
VDD/2
RL
CL
CL
Pin
Pin
VSS
VSS
RL = 464Ω
CL = 50 pF for all pins except OSC2 unless otherwise noted.
15 pF for OSC2 output
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 147
PIC16C9XX
17.5
Timing Diagrams and Specifications
FIGURE 17-3: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
4
Q1
OSC1
1
3
3
4
2
CLKOUT
TABLE 17-4: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Parameter
No.
Sym Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units Conditions
Fosc External CLKIN Frequency
DC
DC
DC
DC
0.1
4
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
4
8
MHz XT and RC osc mode
MHz HS osc mode
kHz LP osc mode
MHz RC osc mode
MHz XT osc mode
MHz HS osc mode
kHz LP osc mode
(Note 1)
200
4
Oscillator Frequency
(Note 1)
4
8
5
200
—
1
Tosc External CLKIN Period
250
125
5
ns
ns
µs
ns
ns
ns
µs
ns
ns
µs
ns
ns
ns
ns
XT and RC osc mode
HS osc mode
LP osc mode
RC osc mode
XT osc mode
HS osc mode
LP osc mode
TCY = 4/FOSC
XT oscillator
LP oscillator
(Note 1)
—
—
Oscillator Period
(Note 1)
250
250
125
5
—
10,000
250
—
2
3
TCY
Instruction Cycle Time (Note 1)
500
50
DC
—
TosL, External Clock in (OSC1) High or
TosH Low Time
2.5
10
—
—
HS oscillator
XT oscillator
LP oscillator
4
TosR, External Clock in (OSC1) Rise or
TosF Fall Time
—
25
50
15
—
—
HS oscillator
†
Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25˚C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time-base period. All specified values are based on
characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the device executing code.
Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current con-
sumption. All devices are tested to operate at "min." values with an external clock applied to the OSC1/CLKIN pin.
When an external clock input is used, the "Max." cycle time limit is "DC" (no clock) for all devices.
DS30444E - page 148
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-4: CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
OSC1
11
10
CLKOUT
13
14
12
16
18
19
I/O Pin
(input)
15
17
I/O Pin
new value
old value
(output)
20, 21
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 17-5: CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Parameter Sym
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units Conditions
10*
11*
12*
13*
14*
15*
16*
17*
TosH2ckL OSC1↑ to CLKOUT↓
TosH2ckH OSC1↑ to CLKOUT↑
—
—
—
—
—
75
75
35
35
—
—
—
50
200
200
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Note 1
Note 1
Note 1
Note 1
Note 1
Note 1
Note 1
TckR
TckF
CLKOUT rise time
CLKOUT fall time
100
100
TckL2ioV CLKOUT ↓ to Port out valid
TioV2ckH Port in valid before CLKOUT ↑
0.5TCY + 20
—
Tosc + 200
TckH2ioI
Port in hold after CLKOUT ↑
0
—
TosH2ioV OSC1↑ (Q1 cycle) to
—
150
Port out valid
18*
TosH2ioI
OSC1↑ (Q2 cycle) to
Port input invalid (I/O in
hold time)
PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
100
200
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
19*
20*
TioV2osH Port input valid to OSC1↑ (I/O in setup time)
0
—
—
10
—
10
—
—
—
—
40
80
40
80
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
TioR
Port output rise time
Port output fall time
INT pin high or low time
PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
—
21*
TioF
—
—
22††*
23††*
Tinp
Trbp
TCY
TCY
RB7:RB4 change INT high or low time
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25˚C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
††
These parameters are asynchronous events not related to any internal clock edges.
Note 1: Measurements are taken in RC Mode where CLKOUT output is 4 x TOSC.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 149
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-5: RESET,WATCHDOGTIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UPTIMER AND POWER-UPTIMER
TIMING
VDD
MCLR
30
Internal
POR
33
PWRT
Time-out
32
OSC
Time-out
Internal
RESET
Watchdog
Timer
RESET
31
34
34
I/O Pins
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 17-6: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND POWER-UP TIMER
REQUIREMENTS
Parameter
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max Units
Conditions
30
TmcL MCLR Pulse Width (low)
2
7
—
—
µs
ms VDD = 5V, -40˚C to +85˚C
31*
Twdt
Watchdog Timer Time-out Period
18
33
(No Prescaler)
32
33*
34
Tost
Oscillation Start-up Timer Period
—
28
—
1024TOSC
—
132
2.1
—
TOSC = OSC1 period
Tpwrt Power-up Timer Period
72
—
ms VDD = 5V, -40˚C to +85˚C
TIOZ
µs
I/O Hi-impedance from MCLR Low
or Watchdog Timer Reset
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25˚C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
DS30444E - page 150
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-6: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMINGS
RA4/T0CKI
41
46
40
45
42
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
47
48
TMR0 or
TMR1
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 17-7: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK REQUIREMENTS
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Typ† Max Units Conditions
40*
Tt0H
T0CKI High Pulse Width
No Prescaler
0.5TCY + 20
—
—
ns Must also meet
parameter 42
With Prescaler
No Prescaler
10
0.5TCY + 20
10
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
41*
42*
Tt0L
Tt0P
T0CKI Low Pulse Width
T0CKI Period
ns Must also meet
parameter 42
With Prescaler
No Prescaler
With Prescaler
ns
ns
TCY + 40
Greater of:
20 or TCY + 40
ns N = prescale value
(2, 4, ..., 256)
N
0.5TCY + 20
15
45*
46*
47*
Tt1H
Tt1L
Tt1P
T1CKI High Time Synchronous, Prescaler = 1
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns Must also meet
parameter 47
ns
PIC16C923/924
Synchronous,
Prescaler =
2,4,8
PIC16LC923/924
25
ns
PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
Asynchronous
30
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
50
ns
T1CKI Low Time
Synchronous, Prescaler = 1
0.5TCY + 20
ns Must also meet
parameter 47
ns
PIC16C923/924
Synchronous,
Prescaler =
2,4,8
15
25
PIC16LC923/924
ns
PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
PIC16C923/924
Asynchronous
30
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
50
ns
T1CKI input period Synchronous
Greater of:
30 OR TCY + 40
ns N = prescale value
(1, 2, 4, 8)
N
PIC16LC923/924
Greater of:
50 OR TCY + 40
N = prescale value
(1, 2, 4, 8)
N
60
PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
Asynchronous
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
100
DC
Ft1
Timer1 oscillator input frequency range
200
kHz
(oscillator enabled by setting bit T1OSCEN)
48
*
TCKEZtmr1 Delay from external clock edge to timer increment
2Tosc
—
7Tosc
—
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25˚C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 151
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-7: CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM TIMINGS
RC2/CCP1
(Capture Mode)
50
51
52
RC2/CCP1
(Compare or PWM Mode)
53
54
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 17-8: CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM REQUIREMENTS
Parameter Sym Characteristic
No.
Min
Typ† Max Units Conditions
50*
TccL Input Low Time No Prescaler
With Prescaler PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
0.5TCY + 20
—
—
ns
10
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
20
51*
TccH
No Prescaler
0.5TCY + 20
Input High Time
With Prescaler PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
10
20
52*
53*
TccP
3TCY + 40
N
ns N = prescale value
(1,4 or 16)
Input Period
TccR Output Rise Time
TccF Output Fall Time
PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
PIC16C923/924
PIC16LC923/924
—
—
—
—
10
25
10
25
25
45
25
45
ns
ns
ns
ns
54*
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25˚C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
DS30444E - page 152
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-8: SPI MASTER MODE TIMING (CKE = 0)
SS
70
SCK
(CKP = 0)
71
72
78
79
79
SCK
(CKP = 1)
78
80
BIT6 - - - - - -1
MSb
LSb
SDO
SDI
75, 76
MSb IN
74
BIT6 - - - -1
LSb IN
73
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
FIGURE 17-9: SPI MASTER MODE TIMING (CKE = 1)
SS
81
SCK
(CKP = 0)
71
72
79
78
73
SCK
(CKP = 1)
80
LSb
MSb
BIT6 - - - - - -1
BIT6 - - - -1
SDO
SDI
75, 76
MSb IN
74
LSb IN
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 153
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-10:SPI SLAVE MODE TIMING (CKE = 0)
SS
70
SCK
(CKP = 0)
83
71
72
78
79
79
SCK
(CKP = 1)
78
80
MSb
LSb
SDO
SDI
BIT6 - - - - - -1
77
75, 76
MSb IN
74
BIT6 - - - -1
LSb IN
73
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
FIGURE 17-11:SPI SLAVE MODE TIMING (CKE = 1)
82
SS
70
SCK
83
(CKP = 0)
71
72
SCK
(CKP = 1)
80
MSb
BIT6 - - - - - -1
BIT6 - - - -1
LSb
SDO
SDI
75, 76
77
MSb IN
74
LSb IN
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
DS30444E - page 154
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 17-9: SPI MODE REQUIREMENTS
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
—
Max
—
Units
ns
Conditions
70*
TssL2scH,
TssL2scL
SS↓ to SCK↓ or SCK↑ input
TCY
71*
TscH
SCK input high time (slave
mode)
Continuous
1.25TCY +
30
—
—
ns
71A*
72*
Single Byte
Continuous
40
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
TscL
SCK input low time (slave
mode)
1.25TCY +
30
72A*
73*
Single Byte
40
50
TdiV2scH,
TdiV2scL
Setup time of SDI data input to SCK edge
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
74*
TscH2diL,
TscL2diL
Hold time of SDI data input to SCK edge
50
75*
76*
77*
78*
79*
80*
TdoR
SDO data output rise time
—
—
10
—
—
—
10
10
—
10
10
—
25
25
50
25
25
50
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
TdoF
SDO data output fall time
TssH2doZ
TscR
SS↑ to SDO output hi-impedance
SCK output rise time (master mode)
SCK output fall time (master mode)
SDO data output valid after SCK edge
TscF
TscH2doV,
TscL2doV
81*
TdoV2scH,
TdoV2scL
SDO data output setup to SCK edge
TCY
—
—
ns
82*
83*
TssL2doV
SDO data output valid after SS↓ edge
SS ↑ after SCK edge
—
—
—
50
—
ns
ns
TscH2ssH,
TscL2ssH
1.5TCY + 40
84*
Tb2b
Delay between consecutive bytes
1.5TCY + 40
—
—
ns
*
Characterized but not tested.
†
Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25˚C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 155
PIC16C9XX
2
FIGURE 17-12:I C BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING
SCL
93
91
90
92
SDA
STOP
Condition
START
Condition
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
2
TABLE 17-10:I C BUS START/STOP BITS REQUIREMENTS
Parameter
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min Typ Max Units
Conditions
90*
91*
92*
93*
TSU:STA START condition
Setup time
100 kHz mode
100 kHz mode
100 kHz mode
100 kHz mode
4700
4000
4700
4000
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Only relevant for repeated START
condition
ns
ns
ns
ns
THD:STA START condition
Hold time
After this period the first clock
pulse is generated
TSU:STO STOP condition
Setup time
THD:STO STOP condition
Hold time
*
Characterized but not tested.
DS30444E - page 156
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
2
FIGURE 17-13:I C BUS DATA TIMING
103
102
100
101
SCL
90
106
107
91
92
SDA
In
110
109
109
SDA
Out
Refer to Figure 17-2 for load conditions.
2
TABLE 17-11:I C BUS DATA REQUIREMENTS
Parameter
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
100*
101*
102*
THIGH
Clock high time
100 kHz mode
4.0
—
µs
µs
ns
Device must operate at a mini-
mum of 1.5 MHz
SSP Module
1.5TCY
4.7
—
—
TLOW
Clock low time
100 kHz mode
Device must operate at a mini-
mum of 1.5 MHz
SSP Module
1.5TCY
—
—
TR
TF
SDA and SCL rise
time
100 kHz mode
1000
103*
90*
SDA and SCL fall time 100 kHz mode
—
300
—
ns
TSU:STA START condition
setup time
100 kHz mode
4.7
µs
Only relevant for repeated
START condition
91*
THD:STA START condition hold 100 kHz mode
time
4.0
—
µs
After this period the first clock
pulse is generated
106*
107*
92*
THD:DAT Data input hold time
100 kHz mode
0
—
—
—
ns
ns
µs
TSU:DAT Data input setup time 100 kHz mode
250
4.7
TSU:STO STOP condition setup 100 kHz mode
time
109*
110*
TAA
Output valid from
clock
100 kHz mode
—
3500
—
ns
Note 1
TBUF
Bus free time
100 kHz mode
4.7
µs
Time the bus must be free
before a new transmission can
start
D102*
Cb
Bus capacitive loading
—
400
pF
*
Characterized but not tested.
Note 1: As a transmitter, the device must provide this internal minimum delay time to bridge the undefined region (min. 300 ns) of
the falling edge of SCL to avoid unintended generation of START or STOP conditions.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 157
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 17-12:A/D CONVERTER CHARACTERISTICS:
PIC16C924-04 (COMMERCIAL, INDUSTRIAL)
PIC16LC924-04 (COMMERCIAL, INDUSTRIAL)
Param Sym Characteristic
No.
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
A01
NR Resolution
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
8-bits
bit VREF = VDD = 5.12V,
VSS ≤ VAIN ≤ VREF
VREF = VDD = 5.12V,
VSS ≤ VAIN ≤ VREF
A02 EABS Total Absolute error
< ± 1
< ± 1
< ± 1
< ± 1
< ± 1
LSb
LSb
LSb
LSb
LSb
A03
A04
A05
EIL Integral linearity error
EDL Differential linearity error
EFS Full scale error
VREF = VDD = 5.12V,
VSS ≤ VAIN ≤ VREF
VREF = VDD = 5.12V,
VSS ≤ VAIN ≤ VREF
VREF = VDD = 5.12V,
VSS ≤ VAIN ≤ VREF
A06 EOFF Offset error
VREF = VDD = 5.12V,
VSS ≤ VAIN ≤ VREF
A10
—
Monotonicity
—
3.0V
guaranteed
—
—
V
VSS ≤ VAIN ≤ VREF
A20 VREF Reference voltage
—
—
—
VDD + 0.3
VREF + 0.3
10.0
A25
A30
VAIN Analog input voltage
VSS - 0.3
—
V
ZAIN Recommended impedance of
analog voltage source
kΩ
A40
A50
IAD A/D conversion current PIC16C924
—
—
180
90
—
—
µA Average current consump-
(VDD)
tion when A/D is on.
(Note 1)
PIC16LC924
µA
IREF VREF input current (Note 2)
10
—
1000
µA During VAIN acquisition.
Based on differential of
VHOLD to VAIN to charge
CHOLD, see Section 12.1.
—
—
10
µA During A/D Conversion
cycle
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
Note 1: When A/D is off, it will not consume any current other than minor leakage current.
The power-down current spec includes any such leakage from the A/D module.
2: VREF current is from RA3 pin or VDD pin, whichever is selected as reference input.
DS30444E - page 158
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 17-14:A/D CONVERSION TIMING
BSF ADCON0, GO
1 TCY
(TOSC/2) (1)
134
131
130
Q4
132
A/D CLK
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
A/D DATA
NEW_DATA
OLD_DATA
ADRES
ADIF
GO
DONE
SAMPLING STOPPED
SAMPLE
Note 1: If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the
SLEEPinstruction to be executed.
TABLE 17-13:A/D CONVERSION REQUIREMENTS
Param Sym Characteristic
No.
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
PIC16C924
PIC16LC924
PIC16C924
PIC16LC924
130
TAD A/D clock period
1.6
2.0
2.0
3.0
—
—
—
—
—
µs
TOSC based, VREF ≥ 3.0V
µs TOSC based, VREF full range
µs A/D RC Mode
µs A/D RC Mode
TAD
4.0
6.0
9.5
6.0
9.0
—
131
132
TCNV Conversion time (not including S/H time)
(Note 1)
TACQ Acquisition time
Note 2
5*
20
—
—
—
µs
µs The minimum time is the amplifier
settling time. This may be used if
the "new" input voltage has not
changed by more than 1 LSb (i.e.,
20.0 mV @ 5.12V) from the last
sampled voltage (as stated on
CHOLD).
134
135
TGO Q4 to A/D clock start
—
TOSC/2 §
—
—
—
If the A/D clock source is selected
as RC, a time of TCY is added
before the A/D clock starts. This
allows the SLEEPinstruction to be
executed.
TSWC Switching from convert → sample time
1.5 §
—
TAD
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
§
This specification ensured by design.
Note 1: ADRES register may be read on the following TCY cycle.
2: See Section 12.1 for min conditions.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 159
PIC16C9XX
NOTES:
DS30444E - page 160
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
18.0 DC AND AC CHARACTERISTICS GRAPHS AND TABLES
The graphs and tables provided in this section are for design guidance and are not tested or guaranteed.
In some graphs or tables the data presented are outside specified operating range (i.e., outside specified VDD
range). This is for information only and devices are guaranteed to operate properly only within the specified
range.
Note: The data presented in this section is a statistical summary of data collected on units from different lots over
a period of time and process characterization samples. 'Typical' represents the mean of the distribution at,
25°C, while 'max' or 'min' represents (mean +3σ) and (mean -3σ) respectively where σ is standard devia-
tion.
FIGURE 18-1: TYPICAL IPD vs. VDD (WDT
DISABLED, RC MODE @
25°C)
FIGURE 18-3: TYPICAL IPD vs. VDD (WDT
ENABLED, RC MODE @
25°C)
280
25.0
260
240
220
200
180
20.0
15.0
10.0
5.0
160
140
0.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
120
100
FIGURE 18-4: MAXIMUM IPD vs. VDD (WDT
ENABLED, RC MODE -40°C TO
+85°C)
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
40.0
35.0
30.0
25.0
FIGURE 18-2: MAXIMUM IPD vs. VDD (WDT
DISABLED, RC MODE -40°C
TO +85°C)
3.5
20.0
15.0
3.0
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.0
10.0
5.0
0.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
0.5
0.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 161
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 18-5: TYPICAL IPD vs. VDD (LCD
FIGURE 18-7: TYPICAL IPD vs. VDD (LCD
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
ON , INTERNAL RC , RC
ON ,TIMER1 (32 kHz ), RC
MODE @ 25°C)
MODE @ 25°C)
90
60
55
50
80
70
60
50
40
45
40
35
30
30
20
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
C Spec @ 4.0V = 41
LC Spec @ 3.0V = 37
10
0
FIGURE 18-6: MAXIMUM IPD vs. VDD (LCD ON
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
(1)
VDD (VOLTS)
(32 kHz ), INTERNAL RC (32
(2)
kHz ), RC MODE -40°C TO
+85°C)
70
FIGURE 18-8: MAXIMUM IPD vs. VDD (LCD
(1)
(2)
ON ,TIMER1(32 kHz ), RC
MODE -40°C TO +85°C)
65
60
55
50
180
160
140
120
100
80
45
40
35
30
60
40
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
C Spec @ 4.0V = 45
LC Spec @ 3.0V = 40
20
0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
Note 1: The LCD module is turned on, internal charge pump enabled, 1/4 MUX, 32 Hz frame frequency and no load
on LCD segments/commons. IPD will increase depending on the LCD panel connected to the PIC16C9XX.
Note 2: Indicates the clock source to the LCD module.
DS30444E - page 162
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 18-9: TYPICAL RC OSCILLATOR
FREQUENCY vs. VDD
FIGURE 18-12:TYPICAL IPD vs.TIMER1
ENABLED (32 kHz, RC0/RC1 =
33 pF/33 pF, RC MODE)
Cext = 22 pF,T = 25°C
6.0
5.5
5.0
30
25
20
15
10
5
4.5
R = 5k
4.0
3.5
3.0
R = 10k
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.0
R = 100k
0.5
0.0
2.5
0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
VDD (VOLTS)
Shaded area is beyond recommended range.
FIGURE 18-13:MAXIMUM IPD vs.TIMER1
ENABLED
FIGURE 18-10:TYPICAL RC OSCILLATOR
FREQUENCY vs. VDD
(32 kHz, RC0/RC1 = 33 pF/33
Cext = 100 pF,T = 25°C
pF, 85°C TO -40°C, RC MODE)
2.4
2.2
R = 3.3k
2.0
45
40
35
30
1.8
1.6
R = 5k
1.4
1.2
1.0
25
20
15
10
5
R = 10k
0.8
0.6
0.4
R = 100k
0.2
0.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
VDD (Volts)
FIGURE 18-11:TYPICAL RC OSCILLATOR
FREQUENCY vs. VDD
Cext = 300 pF,T = 25°C
1000
900
800
R = 3.3k
700
600
R = 5k
500
400
R = 10k
300
200
R = 100k
5.5 6.0
100
0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
VDD (VOLTS)
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 163
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 18-14:TYPICAL IDD vs. FREQUENCY (RC MODE @ 20 pF, 25°C)
2500
6.0V
5.5V
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
3.5V
2000
1500
1000
500
0
3.0V
2.5V
0.0
1.00
2.00
3.00
Frequency (MHz)
4.00
Shaded area is
beyond recommended range
5.00
Typical 2.7 mA @ 4 MHz, 5.5V
FIGURE 18-15:MAXIMUM IDD vs. FREQUENCY (RC MODE @ 20 pF, -40°C TO +85°C)
3500
6.0V
3000
2500
2000
5.5V
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
1500
1000
500
0
0.0
1.00
2.00
3.00
Frequency (MHz)
4.00
Shaded area is
5.00
Maximum 5.0 mA @ 4 MHz, 5.5V
beyond recommended range
DS30444E - page 164
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 18-16:TYPICAL IDD vs. FREQUENCY (RC MODE @ 100 pF, 25°C)
1400
6.0V
5.5V
1200
1000
800
600
400
200
0
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
0
200
Shaded area is
beyond recommended range
400
600
800
1000
1200
1400
1600
Frequency (kHz)
FIGURE 18-17:MAXIMUM IDD vs. FREQUENCY (RC MODE @ 100 pF, -40°C TO +85°C)
1600
6.0V
5.5V
1400
1200
1000
800
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
600
400
200
0
0
200
Shaded area is
beyond recommended range
400
600
800
1000
1200
1400
1600
Frequency (kHz)
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 165
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 18-18:TYPICAL IDD vs. FREQUENCY (RC MODE @ 300 pF, 25°C)
1200
6.0V
5.5V
1000
800
600
400
200
0
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
0
100
200
300
400
500
600
700
Frequency (kHz)
FIGURE 18-19:MAXIMUM IDD vs. FREQUENCY (RC MODE @ 300 pF, -40°C TO +85°C)
1400
6.0V
1200
5.5V
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
3.5V
1000
800
3.0V
2.5V
600
400
200
0
0
100
200
300
400
500
600
700
Frequency (kHz)
DS30444E - page 166
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
TABLE 18-1: RC OSCILLATOR
FREQUENCIES
FIGURE 18-20:TRANSCONDUCTANCE(gm)
OF HS OSCILLATOR vs. VDD
Average
Cext
Rext
4.0
Max -40°C
Fosc @ 5V, 25°C
3.5
22 pF
5k
10k
100k
3.3k
5k
4.12 MHz
2.35 MHz
268 kHz
1.80 MHz
1.27 MHz
688 kHz
77.2 kHz
707 kHz
501 kHz
269 kHz
28.3 kHz
± 1.4%
3.0
± 1.4%
± 1.1%
± 1.0%
± 1.0%
± 1.2%
± 1.0%
± 1.4%
± 1.2%
± 1.6%
± 1.1%
2.5
Typ 25°C
2.0
100 pF
300 pF
Min 85°C
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
10k
100k
3.3k
5k
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
6.5
7.0
VDD (VOLTS)
Shaded area is
beyond recommended range
10k
100k
FIGURE 18-21:TRANSCONDUCTANCE(gm)
OF LP OSCILLATOR vs. VDD
The percentage variation indicated here is part to
part variation due to normal process distribution.The
variation indicated is ±3 standard deviation from
average value for VDD = 5V.
110
100
Max -40°C
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
Typ 25°C
Min 85°C
2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0
VDD (VOLTS)
Shaded areas are
beyond recommended range
FIGURE 18-22:TRANSCONDUCTANCE(gm)
OF XT OSCILLATOR vs. VDD
1000
900
Max -40°C
800
700
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
Typ 25°C
Min 85°C
2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0
VDD (VOLTS)
Shaded areas are
beyond recommended range
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 167
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 18-23:TYPICAL XTAL STARTUPTIME
FIGURE 18-26:TYPICAL IDD vs. VDD
vs. VDD (LP MODE, 25°C)
(LP MODE @ 25°C)
3.5
3.0
2.5
140
120
100
200 kHz, 15 pF/15 pF
2.0
80
32 kHz, 33 pF/33 pF
1.5
60
40
20
1.0
0.5
0.0
200 kHz, 15 pF/15 pF
32 kHz, 33 pF/33 pF
0
2.5
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
VDD (VOLTS)
FIGURE 18-24:TYPICAL XTAL STARTUPTIME
LC Spec -> Typical = 22.5 µA, 32 kHz, 4.0V
vs. VDD (HS MODE, 25°C)
7
6
5
4
FIGURE 18-27:MAXIMUM IDD vs. VDD
(LP MODE -40°C TO +85°C)
140
120
100
8 MHz, 33 pF/33 pF
3
8 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
2
200 kHz, 15 pF/15 pF
1
4.0
80
60
40
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
FIGURE 18-25:TYPICAL XTAL STARTUPTIME
vs. VDD (XT MODE, 25°C)
70
20
0
60
50
32 kHz, 33 pF/33 pF
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
40
200 kHz, 68 pF/68 pF
LC Spec -> Maximum = 48 µA, 32 kHz, 4.0V
30
200 kHz, 47 pF/47 pF
20
1 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
10
4 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
DS30444E - page 168
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
FIGURE 18-28:TYPICAL IDD vs. VDD
FIGURE 18-30:TYPICAL IDD vs. VDD
(XT MODE @ 25°C)
(HS MODE @ 25°C)
7
6
5
1600
1400
1200
4 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
1000
4
3
2
800
8 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
1 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
600
400
200
1
0
200 kHz, 33 pF/33 pF
0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
VDD (VOLTS)
Typical = 2.7 µA, 4 MHz, 5.5V
Typical = 3.5 mA, 8 MHz, 5.5V
FIGURE 18-29:MAXIMUM IDD vs. VDD
(XT MODE -40°C TO +85°C)
FIGURE 18-31:MAXIMUM IDD vs. VDD
(HS MODE -40°C TO +85°C)
2500
2000
1500
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
4 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
1 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
1000
500
0
200 kHz, 33 pF/33 pF
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
8 MHz, 15 pF/15 pF
VDD (VOLTS)
Maximum = 5 mA, 4 MHz, 5.5V
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
VDD (VOLTS)
Maximum = 7 mA, 8 MHz, 5.5V
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 169
PIC16C9XX
NOTES:
DS30444E - page 170
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
19.0 PACKAGING INFORMATION
19.1
64-Lead Plastic Surface Mount (TQFP 10x10x1 mm Body 1.0/0.10 mm Lead Form))
D1
D
D/2
e/2
A
A
E1
E
DETAIL A
e
E/2
See Detail A
8 Places
0° min.
11/13°
A
A2
A1
See Detail B
Datum Plane
0.25
0-7°
b
0.08
R min.
with Lead Finish
Base Metal
Gauge Plane
0.20 min.
0.09/0.20
0.09/0.16
L
1.00 ref.
b1
DETAIL B
Package Group: Plastic TQFP
Millimeters
Nominal
Inches
Symbol
Min
Max
Min
Nominal
Max
α
A
0°
-
7°
1.20
0.15
1.05
0.27
0.23
-
0°
-
7°
-
-
-
-
0.047
A1
A2
b
0.05
0.10
1.00
0.22
0.20
12.00
10.00
12.00
10.00
0.50
0.60
64
0.002
0.004
0.039
0.009
0.008
0.472
0.394
0.472
0.394
0.020
0.024
64
0.006
0.95
0.037
0.041
0.17
0.007
0.011
b1
D
0.17
0.007
0.009
-
-
-
D1
E
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
E1
e
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
L
0.45
64
0.75
64
0.018
64
0.030
64
N
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 171
PIC16C9XX
19.2
64-Lead Plastic Dual In-line (750 mil)
N
α
E1
E
C
eA
eB
Pin No. 1
Indicator Area
D
S
S1
e1
Base
Plane
Seating
Plane
L
B1
B
A
A2
A1
D1
Package Group: Plastic Dual In-Line (PLA)
Millimeters
Inches
Symbol
Min
Max
Notes
Min
Max
Notes
α
0°
15°
5.08
–
0°
15°
0.200
–
A
–
–
A1
A2
B
0.51
3.38
0.38
.076
0.20
57.40
55.12
19.05
16.76
1.73
19.05
19.05
3.05
64
0.020
0.133
0.015
0.030
0.008
2.260
2.170
0.750
0.660
0.068
0.750
0.750
0.120
64
4.27
0.56
1.27
0.30
57.91
55.12
19.69
17.27
1.83
19.05
21.08
3.43
64
0.168
0.022
0.050
0.012
2.280
2.170
0.775
0.680
0.072
0.750
0.830
0.135
64
B1
C
Typical
Typical
Typical
Typical
D
D1
E
Reference
Reference
E1
e1
eA
eB
L
Typical
Typical
Reference
Reference
N
S
1.19
0.686
–
0.047
0.027
–
S1
–
–
DS30444E - page 172
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
19.3
68-Lead Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier (Square)
D
0.812/0.661
N Pics
.032/.026
1.27
.050
2 Sides
0.177
.007
S
B D-E S
-A-
0.177
.007
2 Sides
-H-
B A S
9
S
A
D1
A1
-D-
3
D3/E3
D2
0.101
.004
Seating
Plane
D
0.38
.015
-C-
F-G
E2
S
S
3
-G-
4
4
3
-F-
8
E1
E
0.38
.015
F-G
-B-
-E-
3
0.177
.007
A F-G S
S
10
0.812/0.661
.032/.026
3
0.254
.010
0.254
.010
11
Max
Max
11
1.524
.060
0.508
.020
0.508
.020
Min
-H-
2
-H-
2
6
6
-C-
5
1.651
.065
1.651
.065
0.64
.025
0.533/0.331
.021/.013
Min
R
R
1.14/0.64
.045/.025
1.14/0.64
.045/.025
0.177
.007
D-E
S
F-G S ,
A
M
Package Group: Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier (PLCC)
Millimeters
Inches
Max
Symbol
Min
Max
Notes
Min
Notes
A
A1
D
4.191
2.286
25.019
24.130
22.860
20.320
25.019
24.130
22.860
20.320
68
4.699
2.794
25.273
24.334
23.622
-
0.165
0.090
0.985
0.950
0.900
0.800
0.985
0.950
0.900
0.800
68
0.185
0.110
0.995
0.958
0.930
-
D1
D2
D3
E
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
25.273
24.334
23.622
-
0.995
0.958
0.930
-
E1
E2
E3
N
-
-
CP
LT
-
0.102
0.254
-
0.004
0.010
0.203
0.008
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 173
PIC16C9XX
19.4
Package Marking Information
68-Lead CERQUAD Windowed
Example
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
AABBCDE
PIC16C924-04/CL
9650CAE
64-Lead TQFP
Example
MMMMMMMMMM
MMMMMMM
PIC16C923
-08I/PT
AABBCDE
9712CAE
68-Lead PLCC
Example
MMMMMMMMMM
MMMMMMM
PIC16C924
-08/L
AABBCDE
9648CAE
64-Lead SDIP (Shrink DIP)
Example
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
AABBCDE
PIC16C924-04I/SP
9736CAE
Legend:
MM...M
XX...X
AA
Microchip part number information
Customer specific information*
Year code (last 2 digits of calender year)
Week code (week of January 1 is week '01’)
BB
C
Facility code of the plant at which wafer is manufactured.
C = Chandler, Arizona, U.S.A.
S = Tempe, Arizona, U.S.A.
D
1
E
Mask revision number for microcontroller
Assembly code of the plant or country of origin in which
part was assembled.
In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one
line, it will be carried over to the next line thus limiting the number of
available characters for customer specific information.
Note:
*
Standard OTP marking consists of Microchip part number, year code, week code,
facility code, mask revision number, and assembly code. For OTP marking beyond
this, certain price adders apply. Please check with your Microchip Sales Office.
For QTP devices, any special marking adders are included in QTP price.
DS30444E - page 174
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
APPENDIX A:
APPENDIX B: COMPATIBILITY
The following are the list of modifications over the
PIC16C5X microcontroller family:
To convert code written for PIC16C5X to PIC16CXX,
the user should take the following steps:
1. Instruction word length is increased to 14-bits.
This allows larger page sizes both in program
memory (4K now as opposed to 512 before) and
register file (192 bytes now versus 32 bytes
before).
1. Remove any program memory page select oper-
ations (PA2, PA1, PA0 bits) for CALL, GOTO.
2. Revisit any computed jump operations (write to
PC or add to PC, etc.) to make sure page bits are
set properly under the new scheme.
2. A PC high latch register (PCLATH) is added to
handle program memory paging. Bits PA2, PA1,
PA0 are removed from STATUS register.
3. Eliminate any data memory page switching.
Redefine data variables to reallocate them.
4. Verify all writes to STATUS, OPTION, and FSR
registers since these have changed.
3. Data memory paging is redefined slightly. STA-
TUS register is modified.
5. Change reset vector to 0000h.
4. Four new instructions have been added:
RETURN, RETFIE, ADDLW, and SUBLW.
Two instructions TRIS and OPTION are being
phased out although they are kept for compati-
bility with PIC16C5X.
5. OPTION and TRIS registers are made address-
able.
6. Interrupt capability is added. Interrupt vector is
at 0004h.
7. Stack size is increased to 8 deep.
8. Reset vector is changed to 0000h.
9. Reset of all registers is revisited. Five different
reset (and wake-up) types are recognized. Reg-
isters are reset differently.
10. Wake up from SLEEP through interrupt is
added.
11. Two separate timers, Oscillator Start-up Timer
(OST) and Power-up Timer (PWRT) are
included for more reliable power-up. These tim-
ers are invoked selectively to avoid unnecessary
delays on power-up and wake-up.
12. PORTB has weak pull-ups and interrupt on
change feature.
13. T0CKI pin is also a port pin (RA4) now.
14. FSR is made a full eight bit register.
15. “In-circuit programming” is made possible. The
user can program PIC16CXX devices using only
five pins: VDD, VSS, MCLR/VPP, RB6 (clock) and
RB7 (data in/out).
16. PCON status register is added with a Power-on
Reset status bit (POR).
17. Code protection scheme is enhanced such that
portions of the program memory can be pro-
tected, while the remainder is unprotected.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 175
PIC16C9XX
18 - TosH2ioL
30 - TmcL
34 - Tioz
200 ns Min (LC devices)
2 µs Min
APPENDIX C:WHAT’S NEW
Figure 13-13 (Resistor Ladder and Charge Pump) in
LCD Section.
2.1 µs Max
Parameter D150 - Open Drain High Voltage.
Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock Timings - Various.
DC and AC Characterization Graphs and Tables.
53 - TccR,
54 - TccF
APPENDIX D:WHAT’S CHANGED
Various descriptions for clarity.
73 - TdiV2scH
74 - TscH2diL
50 ns Min
50 ns Min
Example code for Changing prescaler assignment
between Timer0 and the WDT.
Combined A/D specification tables for Standard and
Extended Voltage devices.
The A/D section has many changes that provide
greater clarification of A/D operation.
The Instruction Set has Q-cycle activity listings for
every instruction.
The following Electrical Characteristic Parameter val-
ues have changed to:
D011 (Standard Voltage Devices, C)
Typical
Max
22.5
48
µA
µA
D022 (Standard Voltage Devices)
Typical
Max
40
55
µA
µA
D024 (Standard Voltage Devices)
Typical
Max
33
60
µA
µA
D001 (Extended Voltage Devices, LC)
Min 2.5
V
D011 (Extended Voltage Devices, LC)
Typical
Max
13.5
30
µA
µA
D022 (Extended Voltage Devices, LC)
Typical
Max
36
50
µA
µA
D024 (Extended Voltage Devices, LC)
Typical
Max
15
29
µA
µA
D030 (with TTL)
Max
Max
0.5VDD
0.8V
V (ENTIRE RANGE)
V (4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V)
D201, D202
Deleted D210 and D211, D251, D253, D260, D271
D222
Min
Typical
Max
5
15
50
kHz
kHz
kHz
D223, D224 - units to ns.
Added D265 (VLCDADJ voltage limits.
Changed parameters:
12 - TckR
35 ns Typical
13 - TckF
35 ns Typical
15 - TioV2ckH
Tosc + 200 ns Min
DS30444E - page 176
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
PORTF ........................................................................39
PORTG........................................................................40
PWM............................................................................59
RA3:RA0 and RA5 Port Pins.......................................31
RA4/T0CKI Pin ............................................................31
RB3:RB0 Port Pins......................................................33
RB7:RB4 Port Pins......................................................33
RC Oscillator ............................................................ 105
INDEX
A
A/D
Accuracy/Error ............................................................ 86
ADCON0............................................................... 79, 80
ADCON1............................................................... 79, 80
ADIF............................................................................ 80
Analog-to-Digital Converter......................................... 79
Configuring Analog Port.............................................. 83
Connection Considerations......................................... 87
Conversion time.......................................................... 85
Conversions................................................................ 84
Converter Characteristics ......................................... 158
Faster Conversion - Lower Resolution Tradeoff ......... 85
GO/DONE................................................................... 80
Internal Sampling Switch (Rss) Impedance................ 82
Operation During Sleep .............................................. 86
Sampling Requirements.............................................. 82
Sampling Time............................................................ 82
Source Impedance...................................................... 82
Transfer Function........................................................ 87
A/D Conversion Clock......................................................... 83
Registers
Section........................................................................ 19
Absolute Maximum Ratings .............................................. 141
ACK............................................................. 70, 74, 75, 76, 77
ADCON0 Register............................................................... 19
ADCON1 Register............................................................... 20
ADIE bit............................................................................... 26
ADIF bit............................................................................... 27
ADRES............................................................ 19, 79, 80, 109
ALU....................................................................................... 9
Application Notes
2
SSP (I C Mode)...........................................................73
SSP (SPI Mode) ..........................................................65
Timer0 .........................................................................45
Timer0/WDT Prescaler................................................48
Timer1 .........................................................................52
Timer2 .........................................................................55
Watchdog Timer ....................................................... 116
Brown-out Protection Circuit............................................. 112
C
C bit .....................................................................................23
Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP)
Capture Mode..............................................................58
CCP1...........................................................................57
CCP1CON................................................................ 109
CCPR1H................................................................... 109
CCPR1L ................................................................... 109
Compare Mode............................................................58
Compare Mode Block Diagram ...................................58
Prescaler .....................................................................58
PWM Block Diagram ...................................................59
PWM Mode..................................................................59
PWM, Example Frequencies/Resolutions ...................60
Section.........................................................................57
Carry bit.................................................................................9
CCP1CON Register.............................................................19
CCP1IE bit...........................................................................26
CCP1IF bit...........................................................................27
CCPR1H Register ...............................................................19
CCPR1L Register................................................................19
Clocking Scheme.................................................................15
Code Examples
AN546......................................................................... 79
AN552......................................................................... 33
AN556......................................................................... 29
AN578......................................................................... 63
AN594......................................................................... 57
AN607....................................................................... 107
Architecture
Harvard ......................................................................... 9
Overview....................................................................... 9
von Neumann................................................................ 9
Assembler
Call of a Subroutine in Page 1 from Page 0 ................30
Changing Between Capture Prescalers ......................58
Changing Prescaler (Timer0 to WDT) .........................49
Changing Prescaler (WDT to Timer0) .........................49
Doing an A/D Conversion............................................84
I/O Programming .........................................................41
2
MPASM Assembler................................................... 138
I C Module Operation..................................................78
Indirect Addressing......................................................30
Initializing PORTA .......................................................31
Initializing PORTB .......................................................33
Initializing PORTC .......................................................35
Initializing PORTD .......................................................36
Initializing PORTE .......................................................38
Initializing PORTF........................................................39
Initializing PORTG.......................................................40
Loading the SSPBUF register .....................................65
Reading a 16-bit Free-running Timer ..........................53
Code Protection........................................................ 103, 118
Computed GOTO ................................................................29
Configuration Bits ............................................................. 103
B
BF ....................................................................................... 74
Block Diagrams
A/D.............................................................................. 81
Capture Mode ............................................................. 58
Compare Mode ........................................................... 58
External Brown-out1 ................................................. 112
External Brown-out2 ................................................. 112
External Parallel Cystal Oscillator............................. 105
External Power-on Reset.......................................... 112
External Series Crystal Oscillator ............................. 105
Interrupt Logic........................................................... 114
LCD Module................................................................ 90
On-Chip Reset Circuit............................................... 106
PIC16C923 ................................................................. 10
PIC16C924 ................................................................. 11
PORTC ....................................................................... 35
PORTD ................................................................. 36, 37
PORTE........................................................................ 38
D
DC bit...................................................................................23
DC Characteristics.................................................... 142, 143
Development Support....................................................... 137
Development Tools........................................................... 137
Digit Carry bit.........................................................................9
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 177
PIC16C9XX
Direct Addressing................................................................30
NOP.......................................................................... 131
OPTION.................................................................... 131
RETFIE..................................................................... 131
RETLW..................................................................... 132
RETURN................................................................... 132
RLF........................................................................... 133
RRF .......................................................................... 133
SLEEP...................................................................... 134
SUBLW..................................................................... 134
SUBWF..................................................................... 135
SWAPF..................................................................... 135
TRIS ......................................................................... 135
XORLW .................................................................... 136
XORWF .................................................................... 136
Section...................................................................... 119
INT Interrupt...................................................................... 115
INTCON............................................................ 109, 113, 115
INTCON Register................................ 19, 20, 21, 22, 25, 102
INTEDG ............................................................................ 115
INTEDG bit ......................................................................... 24
E
Electrical Characteristics...................................................141
External Power-on Reset Circuit.......................................112
F
Family of Devices
PIC16C9XX...................................................................6
FSR...................................................................................108
FSR Register...............................................19, 20, 21, 22, 30
Fuzzy Logic Dev. System (fuzzyTECH -MP)...................139
G
GIE....................................................................................113
I
I/O Ports
Section........................................................................31
I/O Programming Considerations........................................41
2
I C
2
Addressing I C Devices..............................................70
2
Arbitration....................................................................72
BF .........................................................................74, 75
CKP.............................................................................76
Clock Synchronization ................................................72
Combined Format .......................................................71
Inter-Integrated Circuit (I C) ............................................... 63
Internal Sampling Switch (Rss) Impedance........................ 82
Interrupt Flag .................................................................... 113
Interrupts................................................................... 103, 113
RB7:RB4 Port Change ............................................... 33
IRP bit................................................................................. 23
2
I C Overview...............................................................69
Initiating and Terminating Data Transfer.....................69
Master-Receiver Sequence ........................................71
Master-Transmitter Sequence ....................................71
Multi-master ................................................................72
START ........................................................................69
STOP ....................................................................69, 70
Transfer Acknowledge ................................................70
ICEPIC Low-Cost PIC16CXXX In-Circuit Emulator ..........137
IDLE_MODE .......................................................................78
In-Circuit Serial Programming...................................103, 118
INDF..................................................................................108
INDF Register .............................................19, 20, 21, 22, 30
Indirect Addressing .............................................................30
Instruction Cycle..................................................................15
Instruction Flow/Pipelining ..................................................15
Instruction Format .............................................................119
Instruction Set
K
KeeLoq Evaluation and Programming Tools ................. 139
L
Loading of PC..................................................................... 29
M
MCLR........................................................................ 106, 108
Memory
Data Memory.............................................................. 17
Maps, PIC16C9XX ..................................................... 17
Program Memory........................................................ 17
MP-DriveWay™ - Application Code Generator ................ 139
MPLAB C.......................................................................... 139
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software.. 138
O
One-Time-Programmable Devices ....................................... 7
OPCODE .......................................................................... 119
OPTION.................................................................... 109, 115
OPTION Register.................................................... 20, 22, 24
Orthogonal............................................................................ 9
OSC selection................................................................... 103
Oscillator
HS..................................................................... 104, 107
LP ..................................................................... 104, 107
Oscillator Configurations................................................... 104
Output of TMR2 .................................................................. 55
ADDLW.....................................................................121
ADDWF.....................................................................121
ANDLW.....................................................................122
ANDWF.....................................................................122
BCF...........................................................................122
BSF...........................................................................123
BTFSC ......................................................................123
BTFSS ......................................................................124
CALL.........................................................................124
CLRF.........................................................................125
CLRW .......................................................................125
CLRWDT...................................................................126
COMF .......................................................................126
DECF ........................................................................126
DECFSZ....................................................................127
GOTO .......................................................................127
INCF..........................................................................128
INCFSZ.....................................................................128
IORLW ......................................................................129
IORWF......................................................................129
MOVF........................................................................130
MOVLW ....................................................................130
MOVWF ....................................................................130
P
Paging, Program Memory................................................... 29
PC..................................................................................... 108
PCL Register .............................................. 19, 20, 21, 22, 29
PCLATH............................................................................ 109
PCLATH Register ....................................... 19, 20, 21, 22, 29
PCON ............................................................................... 109
PCON Register................................................................... 28
PD............................................................................. 106, 108
PD bit.................................................................................. 23
PICDEM-1 Low-Cost PICmicro Demo Board ................... 138
PICDEM-2 Low-Cost PIC16CXX Demo Board................. 138
PICDEM-3 Low-Cost PIC16CXXX Demo Board .............. 138
DS30444E - page 178
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
PICMASTER In-Circuit Emulator ................................... 137
PICSTART Plus Entry Level Development System ....... 137
PIE1 .................................................................................. 113
PIE1 Register........................................................ 20, 26, 102
Pin Functions
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)........................ 103, 107
Power Control Register (PCON)............................... 107
Power-on Reset (POR)............................. 103, 107, 108
Power-up Timer (PWRT).................................. 103, 107
Power-Up-Timer (PWRT) ......................................... 107
Time-out Sequence .................................................. 107
Time-out Sequence on Power-up............................. 111
TO..................................................................... 106, 108
POR bit................................................................................28
Port RB Interrupt............................................................... 115
PORTA Register........................................................... 19, 31
PORTB ....................................................................... 77, 108
PORTB Register..................................................... 19, 21, 33
PORTC............................................................................. 108
PORTC Register........................................................... 19, 35
PORTD............................................................................. 109
PORTD Register..................................................................36
PORTE ............................................................................. 109
PORTE Register..................................................................38
PORTF Register..................................................................39
PORTG Register .................................................................40
Ports
PORTA ........................................................................31
PORTB ........................................................................33
PORTC........................................................................35
PORTD........................................................................36
PORTE ........................................................................38
PORTF ........................................................................39
PORTG........................................................................40
Power-down Mode (SLEEP)............................................. 117
PR2................................................................................... 109
PR2 Register .......................................................................20
Prescaler, Switching Between Timer0 and WDT.................49
PRO MATE II Universal Programmer............................ 137
Program Branches.................................................................9
Program Memory Maps, PIC16C9XX..................................17
PS0 bit.................................................................................24
PS1 bit.................................................................................24
PS2 bit.................................................................................24
PSA bit.................................................................................24
PUSH...................................................................................29
MCLRVPP.................................................................... 12
OSC1/CLKIN............................................................... 12
OSC2/CLKOUT........................................................... 12
RA0/AN0..................................................................... 12
RA1/AN1..................................................................... 12
RA2/AN2..................................................................... 12
RA3/AN3/VREF............................................................ 12
RA4/T0CKI.................................................................. 12
RA5/AN4/SS ............................................................... 12
RB0/INT ...................................................................... 12
RB1............................................................................. 12
RB2............................................................................. 12
RB3............................................................................. 12
RB4............................................................................. 12
RB5............................................................................. 12
RB6............................................................................. 12
RB7............................................................................. 12
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI .................................................... 12
RC1/T1OSI ................................................................. 12
RC2/CCP1 .................................................................. 12
RC3/SCK/SCL ............................................................ 12
RC4/SDI/SDA ............................................................. 12
RC5/SDO.................................................................... 12
RD0/SEG00 ................................................................ 13
RD1/SEG01 ................................................................ 13
RD2/SEG02 ................................................................ 13
RD3/SEG03 ................................................................ 13
RD4/SEG04 ................................................................ 13
RD5/SEG29/COM3..................................................... 13
RD6/SEG30/COM2..................................................... 13
RD7/SEG31/COM1..................................................... 13
RE0/SEG05 ................................................................ 13
RE1/SEG06 ................................................................ 13
RE2/SEG07 ................................................................ 13
RE3/SEG08 ................................................................ 13
RE4/SEG09 ................................................................ 13
RE5/SEG10 ................................................................ 13
RE6/SEG11 ................................................................ 13
RE7/SEG27 ................................................................ 13
RF0/SEG12................................................................. 13
RF1/SEG13................................................................. 13
RF2/SEG14................................................................. 13
RF3/SEG15................................................................. 13
RF4/SEG16................................................................. 13
RF5/SEG17................................................................. 13
RF6/SEG18................................................................. 13
RF7/SEG19................................................................. 13
RG0/SEG20................................................................ 13
RG1/SEG21................................................................ 13
RG2/SEG22................................................................ 13
RG3/SEG23................................................................ 13
RG4/SEG24................................................................ 13
RG5/SEG25................................................................ 13
RG6/SEG26................................................................ 13
RG7/SEG28................................................................ 13
VDD ............................................................................. 14
VSS.............................................................................. 14
PIR1.................................................................................. 113
PIR1 Register.............................................................. 19, 102
POP .................................................................................... 29
POR .......................................................................... 107, 108
Q
Quick-Turnaround-Production ...............................................7
R
R/W bit.............................................................. 70, 74, 75, 76
RBIF bit....................................................................... 33, 115
RBPU bit..............................................................................24
RC Oscillator .................................................... 104, 105, 107
RCV_MODE ........................................................................78
Read-Modify-Write...............................................................41
Register File ........................................................................17
Reset ........................................................................ 103, 106
RP0 bit.......................................................................... 17, 23
RP1 bit.................................................................................23
S
SCL......................................................................... 74, 76, 77
SDA .............................................................................. 76, 77
SEEVAL Evaluation and Programming System ............ 139
Serialized Quick-Turnaround-Production ..............................7
Slave Mode
SCL..............................................................................74
SDA .............................................................................74
SLEEP...................................................................... 103, 106
Software Simulator (MPLAB-SIM).................................... 139
Special Features of the CPU............................................ 103
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 179
PIC16C9XX
Special Function Registers, Section ...................................19
SPI
Interrupt Timing .................................................. 46
Overview............................................................. 43
Prescaler ............................................................ 48
Prescaler Block Diagram.................................... 48
Section................................................................ 45
Synchronization.................................................. 47
Timing................................................................. 45
Master Mode...............................................................66
Serial Clock.................................................................65
Serial Data In ..............................................................65
Serial Data Out ...........................................................65
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) .................................63
Slave Select................................................................65
SPI clock.....................................................................66
SPI Mode ....................................................................65
SSP
Timer1
Capacitor Selection ............................................ 53
Overview............................................................. 43
Switching Prescaler Assignment ........................ 49
SSPADD .......................................................73, 74, 109
SSPBUF............................................66, 73, 74, 76, 109
SSPCON...........................................64, 73, 75, 76, 109
SSPIF bit...................................................74, 75, 76, 77
SSPOV bit...................................................................74
SSPSR............................................................66, 74, 76
SSPSTAT..........................................63, 73, 75, 76, 109
Timer2
Overview............................................................. 43
Timing Diagrams
A/D Conversion ........................................................ 159
Timer0 ........................................................................ 45
Timer0 Interrupt Timing .............................................. 46
Timer0 with External Clock......................................... 47
Timing Diagrams and Specifications ................................ 148
TMR0 Register.............................................................. 19, 21
TMR1H Register................................................................. 19
TMR1IE bit.......................................................................... 26
TMR1IF bit.......................................................................... 27
TMR1L Register.................................................................. 19
TMR2 Register.................................................................... 19
TMR2IE bit.......................................................................... 26
TMR2IF bit.......................................................................... 27
TO bit.................................................................................. 23
TRISA Register....................................................... 20, 22, 31
TRISB ............................................................................... 109
TRISB Register....................................................... 20, 22, 33
TRISC......................................................................... 77, 109
TRISC Register....................................................... 20, 35, 68
TRISD............................................................................... 109
TRISD Register................................................................... 36
TRISE ............................................................................... 109
TRISE Register....................................................... 38, 39, 40
Two’s Complement............................................................... 9
2
SSP I C
Addressing..................................................................74
Multi-master Mode ......................................................77
Reception....................................................................75
2
SSP I C Operation......................................................73
START ........................................................................76
START (S) ..................................................................77
STOP (P) ....................................................................77
Transmission...............................................................76
SSPADD Register...............................................................20
SSPBUF Register ...............................................................19
SSPCON Register...............................................................19
SSPIE bit.............................................................................26
SSPIF bit.............................................................................27
SSPOV................................................................................74
SSPSTAT Register .............................................................20
Stack ...................................................................................29
Overflows....................................................................29
Underflow....................................................................29
STATUS............................................................................108
STATUS Register..............................................19, 20, 21, 22
U
T
UV Erasable Devices............................................................ 7
T0CS bit ..............................................................................24
T1CON Register..........................................................19, 102
T2CON Register..................................................................19
TAD......................................................................................83
Timer Modules, Overview ...................................................43
Timer0
RTCC........................................................................108
T0IF...........................................................................115
TMR0 Interrupt..........................................................115
Timer1
Resetting of Timer1 Registers ....................................54
Resetting Timer1 using a CCP Trigger Output ...........54
T1CON................................................................51, 109
TMR1H......................................................................109
TMR1L ......................................................................109
Timer2
T2CON................................................................55, 109
TIMER2 (TMR2) Module.............................................55
TMR2 ........................................................................109
Timers
W
W ...................................................................................... 108
W Register
ALU............................................................................... 9
Wake-up from SLEEP....................................................... 117
Watchdog Timer (WDT)............................ 103, 106, 108, 116
WDT.................................................................................. 108
Period ....................................................................... 116
Programming Considerations................................... 116
Timeout..................................................................... 108
X
XMIT_MODE ...................................................................... 78
XT ............................................................................. 104, 107
Z
Z bit..................................................................................... 23
Zero bit.................................................................................. 9
Timer0
Block Diagram.....................................................45
External Clock.....................................................47
External Clock Timing.........................................47
Increment Delay..................................................47
Interrupt...............................................................45
DS30444E - page 180
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
Figure 8-1:
T1CON: Timer1 Control Register (Address
10h) .............................................................51
Timer1 Block Diagram.................................52
Timer2 Block Diagram.................................55
T2CON: Timer2 Control Register (Address
12h) .............................................................55
List of Equations And Examples
Figure 8-2:
Figure 9-1:
Figure 9-2:
Example 3-1: Instruction Pipeline Flow............................. 15
Example 4-1: Call of a Subroutine in Page 1 from Page 030
Example 4-2: Indirect Addressing..................................... 30
Example 5-1: Initializing PORTA....................................... 31
Example 5-2: Initializing PORTB....................................... 33
Example 5-3: Initializing PORTC ...................................... 35
Example 5-4: Initializing PORTD ...................................... 36
Example 5-5: Initializing PORTE....................................... 38
Example 5-6: Initializing PORTF....................................... 39
Example 5-7: Initializing PORTG ...................................... 40
Example 5-8: Read-Modify-Write Instructions on an
Figure 10-1: CCP1CON Register (Address 17h).............57
Figure 10-2: Capture Mode Operation Block Diagram ....58
Figure 10-3: Compare Mode Operation Block Diagram ..58
Figure 10-4: Simplified PWM Block Diagram...................59
Figure 10-5: PWM Output................................................59
Figure 11-1: SSPSTAT: Sync Serial Port Status Register
(Address 94h)..............................................63
Figure 11-2: SSPCON: Sync Serial Port Control Register
(Address 14h)..............................................64
Figure 11-3: SSP Block Diagram (SPI Mode)..................65
Figure 11-4: SPI Master/Slave Connection .....................66
Figure 11-5: SPI Mode Timing, Master Mode..................67
Figure 11-6: SPI Mode Timing
I/O Port ....................................................... 41
Example 7-1: Changing Prescaler (Timer0→WDT).......... 49
Example 7-2: Changing Prescaler (WDT→Timer0).......... 49
Example 8-1: Reading a 16-bit Free-Running Timer ........ 53
Example 10-1: Changing Between Capture Prescalers...... 58
Example 10-2: PWM Period and Duty Cycle Calculation ... 60
Example 11-1: Loading the SSPBUF (SSPSR) Register.... 65
Equation 12-1: A/D Minimum Charging Time...................... 82
Example 12-1: Calculating the Minimum Required
(Slave Mode With CKE = 0) ........................67
Figure 11-7: SPI Mode Timing
(Slave Mode With CKE = 1) ........................68
Figure 11-8: Start and Stop Conditions ...........................69
Figure 11-9: 7-bit Address Format...................................70
Figure 11-10: I C 10-bit Address Format...........................70
Figure 11-11: Slave-receiver Acknowledge.......................70
Figure 11-12: Data Transfer Wait State.............................70
Figure 11-13: Master-transmitter Sequence......................71
Figure 11-14: Master-receiver Sequence ..........................71
Figure 11-15: Combined Format........................................71
Figure 11-16: Multi-master Arbitration
Sample Time............................................... 82
Example 12-2: Doing an A/D Conversion ........................... 84
Example 12-3: 4-bit vs. 8-bit Conversion Times ................. 85
Example 13-1: Static MUX with 32 Segments .................. 100
Example 13-2: 1/3 MUX with 13 Segments ...................... 100
Example 14-1: Saving STATUS, W, and PCLATH
2
Registers in RAM...................................... 115
List of Figures
(Two Masters) .............................................72
Figure 3-1:
Figure 3-2:
Figure 3-3:
Figure 4-1:
Figure 4-2:
Figure 4-3:
PIC16C923 Block Diagram......................... 10
PIC16C924 Block Diagram......................... 11
Clock/Instruction Cycle ............................... 15
Program Memory Map and Stack............... 17
Register File Map........................................ 18
Status Register (Address 03h, 83h, 103h,
183h)........................................................... 23
OPTION Register (Address 81h, 181h)...... 24
INTCON Register (Address 0Bh, 8Bh,
Figure 11-17: Clock Synchronization.................................72
Figure 11-18: SSP Block Diagram
2
(I C Mode)...................................................73
2
Figure 11-19: I C Waveforms for Reception
(7-bit Address).............................................75
2
Figure 11-20: I C Waveforms for Transmission
(7-bit Address).............................................76
2
Figure 4-4:
Figure 4-5:
Figure 11-21: Operation of the I C Module in IDLE_MODE,
RCV_MODE or XMIT_MODE .....................78
Figure 12-1: ADCON0 Register (Address 1Fh) ...............79
Figure 12-2: ADCON1 Register (Address 9Fh) ...............80
Figure 12-3: A/D Block Diagram......................................81
Figure 12-4: Analog Input Model .....................................82
Figure 12-5: A/D Transfer Function .................................87
Figure 12-6: Flowchart of A/D Operation.........................88
Figure 13-1: LCDCON Register (Address 10Fh).............89
Figure 13-2: LCD Module Block Diagram........................90
Figure 13-3: LCDPS Register (Address 10Eh)................90
Figure 13-4: Waveforms in Static Drive...........................91
Figure 13-5: Waveforms in 1/2 MUX, 1/3 Bias Drive.......92
Figure 13-6: Waveforms in 1/3 MUX, 1/3 Bias ................93
Figure 13-7: Waveforms in 1/4 MUX, 1/3 Bias ................94
Figure 13-8: LCD Clock Generation ................................95
Figure 13-9: Example Waveforms in 1/4 MUX Drive.......97
Figure 13-10: Generic LCDD Register Layout...................98
Figure 13-11: Sleep Entry/exit When SLPEN = 1 or
10Bh, 18Bh)................................................ 25
PIE1 Register (Address 8Ch) ..................... 26
PIR1 Register (Address 0Ch) ..................... 27
PCON Register (Address 8Eh)................... 28
Loading of PC In Different Situations.......... 29
Figure 4-6:
Figure 4-7:
Figure 4-8:
Figure 4-9:
Figure 4-10: Direct/Indirect Addressing........................... 30
Figure 5-1:
Figure 5-2:
Figure 5-3:
Figure 5-4:
Figure 5-5:
Block Diagram of pins RA3:RA0 and RA5.. 31
Block Diagram of RA4/T0CKI Pin............... 31
Block Diagram of RB3:RB0 Pins ................ 33
Block Diagram of RB7:RB4 Pins ................ 33
PORTC Block Diagram (Peripheral Output
Override)..................................................... 35
PORTD<4:0> Block Diagram...................... 36
PORTD<7:5> Block Diagram...................... 37
PORTE Block Diagram............................... 38
PORTF Block Diagram ............................... 39
Figure 5-6:
Figure 5-7:
Figure 5-8:
Figure 5-9:
Figure 5-10: PORTG Block Diagram............................... 40
Figure 5-11: Successive I/O Operation........................... 41
CS1:CS0 = 00 .............................................99
Figure 7-1:
Figure 7-2:
Figure 7-3:
Figure 7-4:
Figure 7-5:
Figure 7-6:
Timer0 Block Diagram ................................ 45
Timer0 Timing: Internal Clock/No Prescale 45
Timer0 Timing: Internal Clock/Prescale 1:2 46
Timer0 Interrupt Timing .............................. 46
Timer0 Timing with External Clock ............. 47
Block Diagram of the Timer0/WDT
Figure 13-12: LCDSE Register (Address 10Dh)............. 100
Figure 13-13: Charge Pump and Resistor Ladder.......... 101
Figure 14-1: Configuration Word .................................. 103
Figure 14-2: Crystal/Ceramic Resonator Operation
(HS, XT or LP OSC Configuration)........... 104
Figure 14-3: External Clock Input Operation
Prescaler..................................................... 48
(HS, XT or LP OSC Configuration)........... 104
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 181
PIC16C9XX
Figure 14-4: External Parallel Resonant Crystal
Oscillator Circuit........................................105
Figure 14-5: External Series Resonant Crystal
Figure 18-14: Typical IDD vs. Frequency
(RC Mode @ 20 pF, 25°C)....................... 164
Figure 18-15: Maximum IDD vs. Frequency
(RC Mode @ 20 pF, -40°C to +85°C)....... 164
Figure 18-16: Typical IDD vs. Frequency
(RC Mode @ 100 pF, 25°C)..................... 165
Figure 18-17: Maximum IDD vs. Frequency
(RC Mode @ 100 pF, -40°C to +85°C)..... 165
Figure 18-18: Typical IDD vs. Frequency
(RC Mode @ 300 pF, 25°C)..................... 166
Figure 18-19: Maximum IDD vs. Frequency
(RC Mode @ 300 pF, -40°C to +85°C)..... 166
Oscillator Circuit........................................105
Figure 14-6: RC Oscillator Mode...................................105
Figure 14-7: Simplified Block Diagram of On-chip
Reset Circuit .............................................106
Figure 14-8: Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR not Tied to VDD): Case 1 ..............111
Figure 14-9: Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Not Tied To VDD): Case 2.............111
Figure 14-10: Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Tied to VDD)..................................111
Figure 14-11: External Power-on Reset Circuit
Figure 18-20: Transconductance(gm) of HS Oscillator
vs. VDD ..................................................... 167
Figure 18-21: Transconductance(gm) of LP Oscillator
vs. VDD ..................................................... 167
Figure 18-22: Transconductance(gm) of XT Oscillator
vs. VDD ..................................................... 167
Figure 18-23: Typical XTAL Startup Time vs. VDD
(LP Mode, 25°C)....................................... 168
Figure 18-24: Typical XTAL Startup Time vs. VDD
(HS Mode, 25°C)...................................... 168
Figure 18-25: Typical XTAL Startup Time vs. VDD
(XT Mode, 25°C) ..................................... 168
Figure 18-26: Typical IDD vs. VDD
(LP Mode @ 25°C)................................... 168
Figure 18-27: Maximum IDD vs. VDD
(LP Mode -40°C to +85°C) ....................... 168
Figure 18-28: Typical IDD vs. VDD
(XT Mode @ 25°C)................................... 169
Figure 18-29: Maximum IDD vs. VDD
(for Slow VDD Power-up)...........................112
Figure 14-12: External Brown-out Protection Circuit 1....112
Figure 14-13: External Brown-out Protection Circuit 2....112
Figure 14-14: Interrupt Logic...........................................114
Figure 14-15: INT Pin Interrupt Timing............................114
Figure 14-16: Watchdog Timer Block Diagram...............116
Figure 14-17: Summary of Watchdog Timer Registers...116
Figure 14-18: Wake-up from Sleep Through Interrupt ....118
Figure 14-19: Typical In-Circuit Serial Programming
Connection................................................118
Figure 15-1: General Format for Instructions................119
Figure 17-1: LCD Voltage Waveform............................145
Figure 17-2: Load Conditions........................................147
Figure 17-3: External Clock Timing...............................148
Figure 17-4: CLKOUT and I/O Timing...........................149
Figure 17-5: Reset, Watchdog Timer, Oscillator Start-up
Timer and Power-up Timer Timing ...........150
Figure 17-6: Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock
Timings .....................................................151
(XT Mode -40°C to +85°C) ....................... 169
Figure 18-30: Typical IDD vs. VDD
Figure 17-7: Capture/Compare/PWM Timings..............152
Figure 17-8: SPI Master Mode Timing (CKE = 0) .........153
Figure 17-9: SPI Master Mode Timing (CKE = 1) .........153
Figure 17-10: SPI Slave Mode Timing (CKE = 0) ...........154
Figure 17-11: SPI Slave Mode Timing (CKE = 1) ...........154
(HS Mode @ 25°C) .................................. 169
Figure 18-31: Maximum IDD vs. VDD
(HS Mode -40°C to +85°C)....................... 169
List of Tables
2
Figure 17-12: I C Bus Start/Stop Bits Timing..................156
2
Table 1-1:
Table 3-1:
Table 4-1:
Table 5-1:
Table 5-2:
PIC16C9XX Family of Devices..................... 6
PIC16C9XX Pinout Description.................. 12
Special Function Register Summary.......... 19
PORTA Functions ...................................... 32
Summary of Registers Associated with
Figure 17-13: I C Bus Data Timing.................................157
Figure 17-14: A/D Conversion Timing.............................159
Figure 18-1: Typical IPD vs. VDD (WDT Disabled,
RC Mode @ 25°C)....................................161
Figure 18-2: Maximum IPD vs. VDD (WDT Disabled,
RC Mode -40°C to +85°C)........................161
PORTA....................................................... 32
PORTB Functions ...................................... 34
Summary of Registers Associated with
Table 5-3:
Table 5-4:
Figure 18-3: Typical IPD vs. VDD (WDT Enabled,
RC Mode @ 25°C)....................................161
PORTB....................................................... 34
PORTC Functions ...................................... 35
Summary of Registers Associated with
PORTC....................................................... 35
PORTD Functions ...................................... 37
Summary of Registers Associated with
Figure 18-4: Maximum IPD vs. VDD (WDT Enabled,
RC Mode -40°C to +85°C)........................161
Figure 18-5: Typical IPD vs. VDD (LCD on(1), Internal
RC(2), RC Mode @ 25°C) ........................162
Figure 18-6: Maximum IPD vs. VDD (LCD on (32 kHz(1)),
Internal RC (32 kHz(2)), RC Mode -40°C to
Table 5-5:
Table 5-6:
Table 5-7:
Table 5-8:
PORTD....................................................... 37
PORTE Functions ...................................... 38
Summary of Registers Associated with
+85°C).......................................................162
Figure 18-7: Typical IPD vs. VDD (LCD On(1), Timer1
(32 kHz(2)), RC Mode @ 25°C)................162
Table 5-9:
Table 5-10:
PORTE....................................................... 38
PORTF Functions....................................... 39
Summary of Registers Associated with
PORTF ....................................................... 39
PORTG Functions...................................... 40
Summary of Registers Associated with
PORTG....................................................... 40
Registers Associated with Timer0.............. 49
Capacitor Selection for the Timer1
Figure 18-8: Maximum IPD vs. VDD (LCD On(1), Timer1
(32 kHz(2)), RC Mode -40°C to +85°C)....162
Table 5-11:
Table 5-12:
Figure 18-9: Typical RC Oscillator Frequency vs. VDD .163
Figure 18-10: Typical RC Oscillator Frequency vs. VDD .163
Figure 18-11: Typical RC Oscillator Frequency vs. VDD .163
Figure 18-12: Typical IPD vs. Timer1 Enabled (32 kHz,
RC0/RC1 = 33 pF/33 pF, RC Mode).........163
Table 5-13:
Table 5-14:
Table 7-1:
Table 8-1:
Figure 18-13: Maximum IPD vs. Timer1 Enabled
(32 kHz, RC0/RC1 = 33 pF/33 pF, 85°C to
Oscillator .................................................... 53
-40°C, RC Mode) ......................................163
DS30444E - page 182
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
Table 8-2:
Table 9-1:
Registers Associated with Timer1 as a
Timer/counter.............................................. 54
Registers Associated with Timer2 as a
Timer/Counter............................................. 56
CCP Mode - Timer Resource ..................... 57
Example PWM Frequencies and
Table 10-1:
Table 10-2:
Resolutions at 8 MHz.................................. 60
Registers Associated with Timer1,
Capture and Compare ................................ 61
Registers Associated with PWM and
Table 10-3:
Table 10-4:
Timer2......................................................... 61
Registers Associated with SPI Operation... 68
I C Bus Terminology................................... 69
Table 11-1:
Table 11-2:
Table 11-3:
Table 11-4:
Table 12-1:
Table 12-2:
Table 13-1:
Table 13-2:
2
Data Transfer Received Byte Actions......... 74
2
Registers Associated with I C Operation.... 77
TAD vs. Device Operating Frequencies ...... 83
Summary of A/D Registers ......................... 88
Frame Frequency Formulas ....................... 96
Approx. Frame Freq in Hz using Timer1 @
32.768 kHz or Fosc @ 8 MHz..................... 96
Approx. Frame Freq in Hz using internal
RC osc @ 14 kHz ....................................... 96
Summary of Registers Associated with
Table 13-3:
Table 13-4:
the LCD Module........................................ 102
Ceramic Resonators................................. 104
Capacitor Selection for Crystal Oscillator . 104
Time-out in Various Situations.................. 107
Status Bits and Their Significance............ 108
Reset Condition for Special Registers...... 108
Initialization Conditions for all Registers... 108
Opcode Field Descriptions........................ 119
PIC16CXXX Instruction Set...................... 120
development tools from microchip............ 140
Cross Reference of Device Specs for
Table 14-1:
Table 14-2:
Table 14-3:
Table 14-4:
Table 14-5:
Table 14-6:
Table 15-1:
Table 15-2:
Table 16-1:
Table 17-1:
Oscillator Configurations and Frequencies
of Operation (Commercial Devices).......... 141
LCD Module Electrical Specifications....... 145
VLCD Charge Pump Electrical
Table 17-2:
Table 17-3:
Specifications............................................ 145
External Clock Timing Requirements ....... 148
CLKOUT and I/O Timing Requirements ... 149
Reset, Watchdog Timer, Oscillator
Table 17-4:
Table 17-5:
Table 17-6:
Start-up Timer and Power-up Timer
Requirements ........................................... 150
Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock
Table 17-7:
Requirements ........................................... 151
Capture/Compare/PWM Requirements.... 152
Table 17-8:
Table 17-9:
SPI Mode Requirements........................... 155
2
Table 17-10: I C Bus Start/Stop Bits Requirements...... 156
2
Table 17-11: I C Bus Data Requirements ..................... 157
Table 17-12: A/D Converter Characteristics:
PIC16C924-04 (Commercial, Industrial)
PIC16LC924-04 (Commercial, Industrial). 158
Table 17-13: A/D Conversion Requirements ................. 159
Table 18-1:
RC Oscillator Frequencies........................ 167
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 183
PIC16C9XX
DS30444E - page 184
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
The procedure to connect will vary slightly from country
to country. Please check with your local CompuServe
agent for details if you have a problem. CompuServe
service allow multiple users various baud rates
depending on the local point of access.
ON-LINE SUPPORT
Microchip provides two methods of on-line support.
These are the Microchip BBS and the Microchip World
Wide Web (WWW) site.
Use Microchip's Bulletin Board Service (BBS) to get
current information and help about Microchip products.
Microchip provides the BBS communication channel for
you to use in extending your technical staff with micro-
controller and memory experts.
The following connect procedure applies in most loca-
tions.
1. Set your modem to 8-bit, No parity, and One stop
(8N1). This is not the normal CompuServe setting
which is 7E1.
To provide you with the most responsive service possi-
ble, the Microchip systems team monitors the BBS,
posts the latest component data and software tool
updates, provides technical help and embedded sys-
tems insights, and discusses how Microchip products
provide project solutions.
2. Dial your local CompuServe access number.
3. Depress the <Enter> key and a garbage string will
appear because CompuServe is expecting a 7E1
setting.
4. Type +, depress the <Enter> key and “Host Name:”
will appear.
The web site, like the BBS, is used by Microchip as a
means to make files and information easily available to
customers.To view the site, the user must have access
to the Internet and a web browser, such as Netscape or
Microsoft Explorer. Files are also available for FTP
download from our FTP site.
5. Type MCHIPBBS, depress the <Enter> key and you
will be connected to the Microchip BBS.
In the United States, to find CompuServe's phone num-
ber closest to you, set your modem to 7E1 and dial
(800) 848-4480 for 300-2400 baud or (800) 331-7166
for 9600-14400 baud connection. After the system
responds with “Host Name:”, type NETWORK, depress
the <Enter> key and follow CompuServe's directions.
ConnectingtotheMicrochipInternetWebSite
The Microchip web site is available by using your favor-
ite Internet browser to attach to:
For voice information (or calling from overseas), you
may call (614) 723-1550 for your local CompuServe
number.
www.microchip.com
The file transfer site is available by using an FTP ser-
vice to connect to:
Microchip regularly uses the Microchip BBS to distrib-
ute technical information, application notes, source
code, errata sheets, bug reports, and interim patches
for Microchip systems software products.For each SIG,
a moderator monitors, scans, and approves or disap-
proves files submitted to the SIG. No executable files
are accepted from the user community in general to
limit the spread of computer viruses.
ftp.mchip.com/biz/mchip
The web site and file transfer site provide a variety of
services. Users may download files for the latest Devel-
opment Tools, Datasheets, Application Notes, User's
Guides, Articles and Sample Programs. A variety of
Microchip specific business information is also avail-
able, including listings of Microchip sales offices, dis-
tributors and factory representatives. Other data
available for consideration is:
Systems Information and Upgrade Hot Line
The Systems Information and Upgrade Line provides
system users a listing of the latest versions of all of
Microchip's development systems software products.
Plus, this line provides information on how customers
can receive any currently available upgrade kits.The
Hot Line Numbers are:
• Latest Microchip Press Releases
• Technical Support Section with Frequently Asked
Questions
• Design Tips
• Device Errata
• Job Postings
• Microchip Consultant Program Member Listing
• Links to other useful web sites related to
Microchip Products
1-800-755-2345 for U.S. and most of Canada, and
1-602-786-7302 for the rest of the world.
Connecting to the Microchip BBS
Trademarks: The Microchip name, logo, PIC, PICSTART,
PICMASTER and PRO MATE are registered trademarks of
Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other
countries. PICmicro, ICSP, MPLAB and fuzzyLAB are
trademarks and SQTP is a service mark of Microchip in
the U.S.A.
Connect worldwide to the Microchip BBS using either
the Internet or the CompuServe communications net-
work.
Internet:
fuzzyTECH is a registered trademark of Inform Software
Corporation. IBM, IBM PC-AT are registered trademarks of
International Business Machines Corp. Pentium is a trade-
mark of Intel Corporation. Windows is a trademark and
MS-DOS, Microsoft Windows are registered trademarks
of Microsoft Corporation. CompuServe is a registered
trademark of CompuServe Incorporated.
You can telnet or ftp to the Microchip BBS at the
address: mchipbbs.microchip.com
CompuServe Communications Network:
When using the BBS via the Compuserve Network, in
most cases, a local call is your only expense. The
Microchip BBS connection does not use CompuServe
membership services, therefore you do not need Com-
puServe membership to join Microchip's BBS. There is
no charge for connecting to the Microchip BBS.
All other trademarks mentioned herein are the property of
their respective companies.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 185
PIC16C9XX
READER RESPONSE
It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip prod-
uct. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation
can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (602) 786-7578.
Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this Data Sheet.
To:
Technical Publications Manager
Reader Response
Total Pages Sent
RE:
From:
Name
Company
Address
City / State / ZIP / Country
Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________
FAX: (______) _________ - _________
Application (optional):
Would you like a reply?
Y
N
Literature Number:
DS30444E
Device:
PIC16C9XX
Questions:
1. What are the best features of this document?
2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs?
3. Do you find the organization of this data sheet easy to follow? If not, why?
4. What additions to the data sheet do you think would enhance the structure and subject?
5. What deletions from the data sheet could be made without affecting the overall usefulness?
6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)?
7. How would you improve this document?
8. How would you improve our software, systems, and silicon products?
DS30444E - page 186
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16C9XX
PIC16C9XX PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery refer to the factory or the listed sales office.
Examples
PART NO. -XX X /XX XXX
Pattern:
QTP, SQTP, ROM Code or Special Requirements
a)
PIC16C924 - 04/P 301
Commercial Temp.,
PDIP Package, 4 MHz,
normal VDD limits, QTP
pattern #301
Package:
SP
PT
CL
L
= 64-pin Shrink PDIP
= TQFP
= 68-pin Windowed CERQUAD
= PLCC
b)
c)
PIC16LC923 - 04/PT
Commercial Temp.,
TQFP package, 4 MHz,
extended VDD limits
Temperature
Range:
-
I
= 0°C to +70°C (T for Tape/Reel)
= -40°C to +85°C (S for Tape/Reel)
Frequency
Range:
04
04
08
= 200 kHz (PIC16C9XX-04)
= 4 MHz
= 8 MHz
PIC16C923 - 08I/CL
Industrial Temp.,
Windowed CERQUAD
package, 8 MHz, normal
VDD limits
Device
PIC16C9XX :VDD range 4.0V to 6.0V
PIC16C9XXT :VDD range 4.0V to 6.0V (Tape/Reel)
PIC16LC9XX :VDD range 2.5V to 6.0V
PIC16LC9XT :VDD range 2.5V to 6.0V (Tape/Reel)
* CL Devices are UV erasable and can be programmed to any device configuration. CL Devices meet the electrical requirement of
each oscillator type (including LC devices).
Sales and Support
Products supported by a preliminary Data Sheet may possibly have an errata sheet describing minor operational differences and
recommended workarounds. To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please contact one of the following:
1. Your local Microchip sales office (see below)
2. The Microchip Corporate Literature Center U.S. FAX: (602) 786-7277
3. The Microchip’s Bulletin Board, via your local CompuServe number (CompuServe membership NOT required).
Please specify which device, revision of silicon and Data Sheet (include Literature #) you are using.
For latest version information and upgrade kits for Microchip Development Tools, please call 1-800-755-2345 or 1-602-786-7302.
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30444E - page 187
PIC16C9XX
DS30444E page 188
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
M
WORLDWIDE SALES & SERVICE
AMERICAS
ASIA/PACIFIC
EUROPE
Corporate Office
Microchip Technology Inc.
2355 West Chandler Blvd.
Chandler, AZ 85224-6199
Hong Kong
Microchip Asia Pacific
RM 3801B, Tower Two
Metroplaza
United Kingdom
Arizona Microchip Technology Ltd.
Unit 6, The Courtyard
Meadow Bank, Furlong Road
Tel: 602-786-7200 Fax: 602-786-7277
Technical Support: 602 786-7627
Web: http://www.microchip.com
223 Hing Fong Road
Kwai Fong, N.T., Hong Kong
Tel: 852-2-401-1200 Fax: 852-2-401-3431
Bourne End, Buckinghamshire SL8 5AJ
Tel: 44-1628-851077 Fax: 44-1628-850259
France
Arizona Microchip Technology SARL
Zone Industrielle de la Bonde
2 Rue du Buisson aux Fraises
91300 Massy, France
Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20 Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
Atlanta
Microchip Technology Inc.
500 Sugar Mill Road, Suite 200B
Atlanta, GA 30350
Tel: 770-640-0034 Fax: 770-640-0307
India
Microchip Technology Inc.
India Liaison Office
No. 6, Legacy, Convent Road
Bangalore 560 025, India
Tel: 91-80-229-4036 Fax: 91-80-559-9840
Boston
Microchip Technology Inc.
5 Mount Royal Avenue
Marlborough, MA 01752
Tel: 508-480-9990 Fax: 508-480-8575
Germany
Arizona Microchip Technology GmbH
Gustav-Heinemann-Ring 125
D-81739 Müchen, Germany
Tel: 49-89-627-144 0 Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Korea
Microchip Technology Korea
168-1, Youngbo Bldg. 3 Floor
Samsung-Dong, Kangnam-Ku
Seoul, Korea
Chicago
Microchip Technology Inc.
333 Pierce Road, Suite 180
Itasca, IL 60143
Italy
Tel: 82-2-554-7200 Fax: 82-2-558-5934
Arizona Microchip Technology SRL
Centro Direzionale Colleoni
Palazzo Taurus 1 V. Le Colleoni 1
20041 Agrate Brianza
Milan, Italy
Tel: 39-39-6899939 Fax: 39-39-6899883
Shanghai
Microchip Technology
RM 406 Shanghai Golden Bridge Bldg.
2077 Yan’an Road West, Hong Qiao District
Shanghai, PRC 200335
Tel: 630-285-0071 Fax: 630-285-0075
Dallas
Microchip Technology Inc.
14651 Dallas Parkway, Suite 816
Dallas, TX 75240-8809
Tel: 972-991-7177 Fax: 972-991-8588
Tel: 86-21-6275-5700
Fax: 86 21-6275-5060
JAPAN
Singapore
Microchip Technology Taiwan
Singapore Branch
200 Middle Road
#10-03 Prime Centre
Microchip Technology Intl. Inc.
Benex S-1 6F
Dayton
Microchip Technology Inc.
Two Prestige Place, Suite 150
Miamisburg, OH 45342
Tel: 937-291-1654 Fax: 937-291-9175
3-18-20, Shinyokohama
Kohoku-Ku, Yokohama-shi
Kanagawa 222 Japan
Singapore 188980
Tel: 65-334-8870 Fax: 65-334-8850
Tel: 81-45-471- 6166 Fax: 81-45-471-6122
Los Angeles
Microchip Technology Inc.
18201 Von Karman, Suite 1090
Irvine, CA 92612
Taiwan, R.O.C
Microchip Technology Taiwan
10F-1C 207
Tung Hua North Road
Taipei, Taiwan, ROC
7/29/97
Tel: 714-263-1888 Fax: 714-263-1338
NewYork
Tel: 886 2-717-7175 Fax: 886-2-545-0139
Microchip Technology Inc.
150 Motor Parkway, Suite 416
Hauppauge, NY 11788
Tel: 516-273-5305 Fax: 516-273-5335
San Jose
Microchip Technology Inc.
2107 North First Street, Suite 590
San Jose, CA 95131
Tel: 408-436-7950 Fax: 408-436-7955
Toronto
Microchip Technology Inc.
5925 Airport Road, Suite 200
Mississauga, Ontario L4V 1W1, Canada
Tel: 905-405-6279 Fax: 905-405-6253
Printed on recycled paper.
All rights reserved. ©1997, Microchip Technology Incorporated, USA. 8/97
Information contained in this publication regarding device applications and the like is intended for suggestion only and may be superseded by updates. No representation or
warranty is given and no liability is assumed by Microchip Technology Incorporated with respect to the accuracy or use of such information, or infringement of patents or other
intellectual property rights arising from such use or otherwise. Use of Microchip’s products as critical components in life support systems is not authorized except with express
written approval by Microchip. No licenses are conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any intellectual property rights.The Microchip logo and name are registered trademarks
of Microchip Technology Inc. in the U.S.A. and other countries. All rights reserved. All other trademarks mentioned herein are the property of their respective companies.
DS30444E-page 189
1997 Microchip Technology Inc.
相关型号:
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明